]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - man/gnus.texi
(Useless Whitespace): `indicate-unused-lines' is now called
[gnu-emacs] / man / gnus.texi
1 \input texinfo
2
3 @setfilename ../info/gnus
4 @settitle Gnus Manual
5 @syncodeindex fn cp
6 @syncodeindex vr cp
7 @syncodeindex pg cp
8
9 @copying
10 Copyright (c) 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
11 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
12 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
13
14 @quotation
15 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
16 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
17 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
18 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
19 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
20 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
21 License'' in the Emacs manual.
22
23 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
24 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
25 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
26
27 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
28 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
29 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
30 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
31 @end quotation
32 @end copying
33
34 @iftex
35 @iflatex
36 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
37 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
38 \usepackage{pagestyle}
39 \usepackage{epsfig}
40 \usepackage{pixidx}
41 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
42
43 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
44 \else
45 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
46 \usepackage{thumbpdf}
47 \pdfcompresslevel=9
48 \fi
49
50 \makeindex
51 \begin{document}
52
53 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.10.6}
54 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
55 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
56
57 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
58
59 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
60 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
61 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
62 \else
63 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
64 \fi
65 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
66 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
67
68 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
69 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
70
71 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
72 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73 \newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
74 \newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
75 \newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
76 \newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
77 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
78 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
79 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
80 \newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
81 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
82 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
83 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
84 \newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
85 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
86 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
87 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
88 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
89 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
90 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
91 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
92 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
93 \newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
94 \newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
95
96 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
97 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
98 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
99 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
100 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
101 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
102 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
103 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
104 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
105 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
106 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
107 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
108 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
109
110 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
111 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
112 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
113 }
114
115 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
116
117 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
118 {\mbox{}}
119 }
120
121 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
122 \gnusdimen 0pt
123
124 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
125 \gnuscleardoublepage
126 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
127 \chapter{#2}
128 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
129 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
130 \thispagestyle{empty}
131 \hspace*{-2cm}
132 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
133 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
134 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
135 \end{picture}
136 \clearpage
137 }
138
139 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
140 \begin{figure}
141 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
142 #3
143 \end{picture}
144 \caption{#1}
145 \end{figure}
146 }
147
148 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
149 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
150 }
151
152 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
153 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
154 }
155
156 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
157 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
158 }
159
160 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
161 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
162 }
163
164 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
165
166 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
167 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
168 \section{#1}
169 }
170
171 \newenvironment{codelist}%
172 {\begin{list}{}{
173 }
174 }{\end{list}}
175
176 \newenvironment{asislist}%
177 {\begin{list}{}{
178 }
179 }{\end{list}}
180
181 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
182 {\begin{list}{}{
183 \labelwidth=0cm
184 }
185 }{\end{list}}
186
187 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
188 {\begin{list}{}{
189 }
190 }{\end{list}}
191
192 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
193 {\begin{list}{}{
194 }
195 }{\end{list}}
196
197 \newenvironment{samplist}%
198 {\begin{list}{}{
199 }
200 }{\end{list}}
201
202 \newenvironment{varlist}%
203 {\begin{list}{}{
204 }
205 }{\end{list}}
206
207 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
208 {\begin{list}{}{
209 }
210 }{\end{list}}
211
212 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
213 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
214 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
215
216 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
217 {
218 {
219 \ifodd\count0
220 {
221 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
222 }
223 \else
224 {
225 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
226 }
227 }
228 \fi
229 }
230 }
231 {
232 \ifodd\count0
233 \mbox{} \hfill
234 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
235 \else
236 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
237 \hfill \mbox{}
238 \fi
239 }
240
241 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
242 {
243 {
244 \ifodd\count0
245 {
246 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
247 }
248 \else
249 {
250 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
251 }
252 \fi
253 }
254 }
255 {
256 \ifodd\count0
257 \mbox{} \hfill
258 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
259 \else
260 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
261 \hfill \mbox{}
262 \fi
263 }
264
265 \newpagestyle{gnus}%
266 {
267 {
268 \ifodd\count0
269 {
270 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
271 }
272 \else
273 {
274 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
275 }
276 \fi
277 }
278 }
279 {
280 \ifodd\count0
281 \mbox{} \hfill
282 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
283 \else
284 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
285 \hfill \mbox{}
286 \fi
287 }
288
289 \pagenumbering{roman}
290 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
291
292 @end iflatex
293 @end iftex
294
295 @iftex
296 @iflatex
297
298 \begin{titlepage}
299 {
300
301 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
302 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
303 \parindent=0cm
304 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
305
306 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
307 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
308 \vfill
309 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
310 \vfill
311 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
312 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
313 \newpage
314 }
315
316 \mbox{}
317 \vfill
318
319 \thispagestyle{empty}
320
321 @c @insertcopying
322 \newpage
323 \end{titlepage}
324 @end iflatex
325 @end iftex
326
327 @ifnottex
328 @insertcopying
329 @end ifnottex
330
331 @dircategory Emacs
332 @direntry
333 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
334 @end direntry
335 @iftex
336 @finalout
337 @end iftex
338 @setchapternewpage odd
339
340
341
342 @titlepage
343 @title Gnus Manual
344
345 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
346 @page
347 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
348 @insertcopying
349 @end titlepage
350
351
352 @node Top
353 @top The Gnus Newsreader
354
355 @ifinfo
356
357 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
358 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
359 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
360 luck.
361
362 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.10.6.
363
364 @end ifinfo
365
366 @iftex
367
368 @iflatex
369 \tableofcontents
370 \gnuscleardoublepage
371 @end iflatex
372
373 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
374 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
375
376 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
377 being accused of plagiarism:
378
379 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
380 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
381 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
382 can even read news with it!
383
384 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
385 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
386 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
387 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
388 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
389 the program.
390
391 @end iftex
392
393 @menu
394 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
395 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
396 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
397 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
398 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
399 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
400 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
401 * Various:: General purpose settings.
402 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
403 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
404 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
405 * Key Index:: Key Index.
406
407 Other related manuals
408
409 * Message:(message). Composing messages.
410 * Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
411 * Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
412 * PGG:(pgg). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
413
414 @detailmenu
415 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
416
417 Starting Gnus
418
419 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
420 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
421 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
422 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
423 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
424 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
425 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
426 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
427 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
428 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
429 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
430
431 New Groups
432
433 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
434 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
435 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
436
437 Group Buffer
438
439 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
440 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
441 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
442 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
443 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
444 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
445 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
446 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
447 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
448 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
449 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
450 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
451 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
452 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
453 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
454 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
455 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
456
457 Group Buffer Format
458
459 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
460 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
461 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
462
463 Group Topics
464
465 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
466 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
467 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
468 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
469 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
470
471 Misc Group Stuff
472
473 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
474 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
475 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
476 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
477 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
478
479 Summary Buffer
480
481 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
482 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
483 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
484 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
485 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
486 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
487 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
488 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
489 * Threading:: How threads are made.
490 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
491 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
492 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
493 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
494 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
495 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
496 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
497 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
498 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
499 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
500 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
501 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
502 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
503 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
504 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
505 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
506 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
507 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
508 or reselecting the current group.
509 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
510 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
511 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
512 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
513
514 Summary Buffer Format
515
516 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
517 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
518 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
519 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
520
521 Choosing Articles
522
523 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
524 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
525
526 Reply, Followup and Post
527
528 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
529 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
530 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
531 * Canceling and Superseding::
532
533 Marking Articles
534
535 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
536 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
537 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
538 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
539 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
540 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
541
542 Threading
543
544 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
545 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
546
547 Customizing Threading
548
549 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
550 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
551 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
552 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
553
554 Decoding Articles
555
556 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
557 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
558 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
559 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
560 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
561 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
562
563 Decoding Variables
564
565 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
566 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
567 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
568
569 Article Treatment
570
571 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
572 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
573 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
574 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
575 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
576 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
577 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
578 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
579 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
580 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
581 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
582
583 Alternative Approaches
584
585 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
586 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
587
588 Various Summary Stuff
589
590 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
591 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
592 * Summary Generation Commands::
593 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
594
595 Article Buffer
596
597 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
598 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
599 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
600 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
601 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
602
603 Composing Messages
604
605 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
606 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
607 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
608 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
609 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
610 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
611 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
612 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
613 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
614
615 Select Methods
616
617 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
618 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
619 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
620 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
621 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
622 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
623 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
624 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
625
626 Server Buffer
627
628 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
629 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
630 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
631 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
632 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
633 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
634 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
635
636 Getting News
637
638 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
639 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
640
641 @acronym{NNTP}
642
643 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
644 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
645 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
646
647 Getting Mail
648
649 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
650 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
651 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
652 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
653 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
654 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
655 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
656 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
657 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
658 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
659 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
660 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
661 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
662
663 Mail Sources
664
665 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
666 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
667 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
668
669 Choosing a Mail Back End
670
671 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
672 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
673 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
674 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
675 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
676 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
677 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
678
679 Browsing the Web
680
681 * Archiving Mail::
682 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
683 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
684 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
685 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
686 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
687 * Customizing w3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/w3 from Gnus.
688
689 @acronym{IMAP}
690
691 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
692 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
693 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
694 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
695 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
696 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
697
698 Other Sources
699
700 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
701 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
702 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
703 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
704 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
705
706 Document Groups
707
708 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
709
710 SOUP
711
712 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
713 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
714 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
715
716 Combined Groups
717
718 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
719 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
720
721 Gnus Unplugged
722
723 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
724 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
725 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
726 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
727 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
728 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
729 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
730 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
731 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
732 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
733 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
734 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
735 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
736
737 Agent Categories
738
739 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
740 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
741 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
742
743 Agent Commands
744
745 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
746 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
747 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
748
749 Scoring
750
751 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
752 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
753 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
754 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
755 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
756 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
757 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
758 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
759 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
760 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
761 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
762 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
763 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
764 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
765 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
766 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
767 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
768
769 GroupLens
770
771 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
772 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
773 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
774 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
775
776 Advanced Scoring
777
778 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
779 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
780 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
781
782 Various
783
784 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
785 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
786 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
787 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
788 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
789 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
790 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
791 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
792 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
793 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
794 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
795 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
796 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
797 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
798 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
799 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
800 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
801 * Thwarting Email Spam:: A how-to on avoiding unsolicited commercial email.
802 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
803 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
804
805 Formatting Variables
806
807 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
808 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
809 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
810 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
811 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
812 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
813 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
814 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
815
816 Image Enhancements
817
818 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
819 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
820 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
821 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
822 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
823
824 Thwarting Email Spam
825
826 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
827 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
828 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
829 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
830 * Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package::
831 * Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat::
832
833 Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package
834
835 * Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events::
836 * Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail::
837 * Spam ELisp Package Global Variables::
838 * Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples::
839 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
840 * BBDB Whitelists::
841 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
842 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
843 * Blackholes::
844 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
845 * Bogofilter::
846 * ifile spam filtering::
847 * spam-stat spam filtering::
848 * SpamOracle::
849 * Extending the Spam ELisp package::
850
851 Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat
852
853 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
854 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
855 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
856
857 Appendices
858
859 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
860 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
861 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
862 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
863 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
864 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
865 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
866 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
867 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
868
869 History
870
871 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
872 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
873 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
874 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
875 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
876 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
877 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
878 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
879 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
880
881 New Features
882
883 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
884 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
885 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
886 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
887 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
888 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
889
890 Customization
891
892 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
893 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
894 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
895 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
896
897 Gnus Reference Guide
898
899 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
900 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
901 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
902 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
903 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
904 * Group Info:: The group info format.
905 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
906 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
907 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
908
909 Back End Interface
910
911 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
912 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
913 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
914 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
915 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
916 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
917
918 Various File Formats
919
920 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
921 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
922
923 Emacs for Heathens
924
925 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
926 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
927
928 @end detailmenu
929 @end menu
930
931 @node Starting Up
932 @chapter Starting Gnus
933 @cindex starting up
934
935 @kindex M-x gnus
936 @findex gnus
937 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
938 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
939 your Emacs.
940
941 @findex gnus-other-frame
942 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
943 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
944 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
945
946 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
947 variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
948 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
949
950 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
951 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
952
953 @menu
954 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
955 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
956 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
957 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
958 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
959 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
960 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
961 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
962 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
963 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
964 @end menu
965
966
967 @node Finding the News
968 @section Finding the News
969 @cindex finding news
970
971 @vindex gnus-select-method
972 @c @head
973 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
974 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
975 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
976 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
977 foreign groups.
978
979 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
980 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
981
982 @lisp
983 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
984 @end lisp
985
986 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
987
988 @lisp
989 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
990 @end lisp
991
992 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
993 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
994 server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
995 server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
996
997 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
998 @cindex NNTPSERVER
999 @cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1000 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1001 @env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1002 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1003 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1004 If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1005 as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1006
1007 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1008 If @code{gnus-nntp-server} is set, this variable will override
1009 @code{gnus-select-method}. You should therefore set
1010 @code{gnus-nntp-server} to @code{nil}, which is what it is by default.
1011
1012 @vindex gnus-secondary-servers
1013 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1014 You can also make Gnus prompt you interactively for the name of an
1015 @acronym{NNTP} server. If you give a non-numerical prefix to @code{gnus}
1016 (i.e., @kbd{C-u M-x gnus}), Gnus will let you choose between the servers
1017 in the @code{gnus-secondary-servers} list (if any). You can also just
1018 type in the name of any server you feel like visiting. (Note that this
1019 will set @code{gnus-nntp-server}, which means that if you then @kbd{M-x
1020 gnus} later in the same Emacs session, Gnus will contact the same
1021 server.)
1022
1023 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1024 @kindex B (Group)
1025 However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1026 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1027 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1028 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1029 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1030 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1031
1032 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1033 @c @head
1034 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1035 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1036 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1037 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1038 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1039 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1040 groups are.
1041
1042 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1043 you would typically set this variable to
1044
1045 @lisp
1046 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1047 @end lisp
1048
1049
1050 @node The First Time
1051 @section The First Time
1052 @cindex first time usage
1053
1054 If no startup files exist (@pxref{Startup Files}), Gnus will try to
1055 determine what groups should be subscribed by default.
1056
1057 @vindex gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups
1058 If the variable @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is set, Gnus
1059 will subscribe you to just those groups in that list, leaving the rest
1060 killed. Your system administrator should have set this variable to
1061 something useful.
1062
1063 Since she hasn't, Gnus will just subscribe you to a few arbitrarily
1064 picked groups (i.e., @samp{*.newusers}). (@dfn{Arbitrary} is defined
1065 here as @dfn{whatever Lars thinks you should read}.)
1066
1067 You'll also be subscribed to the Gnus documentation group, which should
1068 help you with most common problems.
1069
1070 If @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is @code{t}, Gnus will just
1071 use the normal functions for handling new groups, and not do anything
1072 special.
1073
1074
1075 @node The Server is Down
1076 @section The Server is Down
1077 @cindex server errors
1078
1079 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1080 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1081 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1082
1083 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1084 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1085 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1086 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1087 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1088 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1089 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1090
1091 @findex gnus-no-server
1092 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1093 @c @head
1094 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1095 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1096 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1097 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1098 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1099 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1100 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1101
1102
1103 @node Slave Gnusae
1104 @section Slave Gnusae
1105 @cindex slave
1106
1107 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1108 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1109 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1110 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1111
1112 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1113 @file{.newsrc} file.
1114
1115 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1116 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1117 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1118 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1119 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1120 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1121 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1122
1123 @findex gnus-slave
1124 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1125 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1126 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1127 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1128 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1129 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1130 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1131 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1132
1133 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1134 information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1135
1136 If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1137 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1138 file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1139 incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1140 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1141
1142
1143
1144 @node New Groups
1145 @section New Groups
1146 @cindex new groups
1147 @cindex subscription
1148
1149 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1150 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1151 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1152 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1153 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1154 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1155 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1156 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1157 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1158
1159 @menu
1160 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1161 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1162 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1163 @end menu
1164
1165
1166 @node Checking New Groups
1167 @subsection Checking New Groups
1168
1169 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing the
1170 list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of subscribed and
1171 dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method. If
1172 @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will ask the
1173 server for new groups since the last time. This is both faster and
1174 cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list of killed
1175 groups altogether, so you may set @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to
1176 @code{nil}, which will save time both at startup, at exit, and all over.
1177 Saves disk space, too. Why isn't this the default, then?
1178 Unfortunately, not all servers support this command.
1179
1180 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1181 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1182 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1183 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1184 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1185 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1186 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1187 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1188 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1189 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1190 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1191
1192 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1193 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1194 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1195 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1196 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1197 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1198
1199
1200 @node Subscription Methods
1201 @subsection Subscription Methods
1202
1203 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1204 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1205 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1206
1207 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1208 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1209
1210 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1211
1212 @table @code
1213
1214 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1215 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1216 Make all new groups zombies. This is the default. You can browse the
1217 zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either kill them all off properly
1218 (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them (with @kbd{u}).
1219
1220 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1221 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1222 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1223 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1224
1225 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1226 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1227 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1228
1229 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1230 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1231 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1232 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1233 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1234 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1235 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1236 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1237 up. Or something like that.
1238
1239 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1240 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1241 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1242 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1243 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1244
1245 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1246 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1247 Kill all new groups.
1248
1249 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1250 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1251 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1252 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1253 topic parameter that looks like
1254
1255 @example
1256 "nnslashdot"
1257 @end example
1258
1259 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1260 that topic.
1261
1262 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1263 top-level topic.
1264
1265 @end table
1266
1267 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1268 A closely related variable is
1269 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1270 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1271 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1272 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1273 hierarchy or not.
1274
1275 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1276 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1277 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1278 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1279
1280
1281 @node Filtering New Groups
1282 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1283
1284 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1285 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1286 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1287
1288 @example
1289 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1290 @end example
1291
1292 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1293 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1294 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1295 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1296 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1297 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1298 subscribing these groups.
1299 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1300 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1301
1302 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1303 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1304 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1305 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1306 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1307 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1308 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1309 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1310
1311 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1312 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1313 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1314 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1315 but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1316 more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1317 used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1318 groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1319 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, and @code{nnmaildir})
1320 subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this variable to
1321 @code{nil}.
1322
1323 New groups that match this regexp are subscribed using
1324 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1325
1326
1327 @node Changing Servers
1328 @section Changing Servers
1329 @cindex changing servers
1330
1331 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1332 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1333 very flaky and you want to use another.
1334
1335 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1336 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1337
1338 @emph{Wrong!}
1339
1340 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1341 @acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1342 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1343 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1344 worthless.
1345
1346 Gnus provides a few functions to attempt to translate a @file{.newsrc}
1347 file from one server to another. They all have one thing in
1348 common---they take a looong time to run. You don't want to use these
1349 functions more than absolutely necessary.
1350
1351 @kindex M-x gnus-change-server
1352 @findex gnus-change-server
1353 If you have access to both servers, Gnus can request the headers for all
1354 the articles you have read and compare @code{Message-ID}s and map the
1355 article numbers of the read articles and article marks. The @kbd{M-x
1356 gnus-change-server} command will do this for all your native groups. It
1357 will prompt for the method you want to move to.
1358
1359 @kindex M-x gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1360 @findex gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1361 You can also move individual groups with the @kbd{M-x
1362 gnus-group-move-group-to-server} command. This is useful if you want to
1363 move a (foreign) group from one server to another.
1364
1365 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1366 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1367 If you don't have access to both the old and new server, all your marks
1368 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use the @kbd{M-x
1369 gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} command to clear out all data
1370 that you have on your native groups. Use with caution.
1371
1372 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1373 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1374 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1375 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1376
1377 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1378 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1379 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1380 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1381 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1382 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1383 cache for all groups).
1384
1385
1386 @node Startup Files
1387 @section Startup Files
1388 @cindex startup files
1389 @cindex .newsrc
1390 @cindex .newsrc.el
1391 @cindex .newsrc.eld
1392
1393 Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1394 @file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1395 groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1396 read.
1397
1398 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1399 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1400 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1401 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1402 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1403 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1404 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1405
1406 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1407 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1408 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1409 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1410 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1411 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1412
1413 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1414 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1415 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1416 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1417 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1418 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1419 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1420 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1421 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1422 convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1423 want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1424 news reader.
1425
1426 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1427 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1428 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1429 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1430 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1431 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1432 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1433 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1434 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1435 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1436 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1437 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1438
1439 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1440 @vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1441 @vindex version-control
1442 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1443 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1444 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1445 If you want version control for this file, set
1446 @code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1447 @code{version-control} variable.
1448
1449 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1450 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1451 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1452 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1453 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1454 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1455 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1456 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1457 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1458 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1459
1460 @lisp
1461 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1462 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1463
1464 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1465 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1466 @end lisp
1467
1468 @vindex gnus-init-file
1469 @vindex gnus-site-init-file
1470 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1471 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1472 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1473 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1474 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1475 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1476 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1477 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1478 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order).
1479
1480
1481
1482 @node Auto Save
1483 @section Auto Save
1484 @cindex dribble file
1485 @cindex auto-save
1486
1487 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1488 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1489 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1490 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1491 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1492 this file.
1493
1494 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1495 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1496 saved.
1497
1498 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1499 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1500 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1501
1502 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1503 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1504 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1505 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1506 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1507 file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1508
1509 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1510 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1511 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1512
1513
1514 @node The Active File
1515 @section The Active File
1516 @cindex active file
1517 @cindex ignored groups
1518
1519 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1520 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1521 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1522
1523 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1524 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1525 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1526 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1527 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1528 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1529 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1530
1531 @c This variable is
1532 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1533 @c if you set it to anything else.
1534
1535 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1536 @c @head
1537 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1538 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1539 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1540
1541 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1542 you actually subscribe to.
1543
1544 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1545 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1546 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1547 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1548
1549 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1550 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1551 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1552 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1553 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1554 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1555
1556 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1557 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1558 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1559 variable.
1560
1561 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1562 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1563 @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1564 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1565 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1566 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1567
1568 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1569 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1570
1571 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1572 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1573
1574 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1575 secondary select methods.
1576
1577
1578 @node Startup Variables
1579 @section Startup Variables
1580
1581 @table @code
1582
1583 @item gnus-load-hook
1584 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1585 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1586 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1587 times you start Gnus.
1588
1589 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1590 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1591 A hook run after starting up Gnus successfully.
1592
1593 @item gnus-startup-hook
1594 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1595 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1596
1597 @item gnus-started-hook
1598 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1599 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1600 successfully.
1601
1602 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1603 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1604 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1605 generating the group buffer.
1606
1607 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1608 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1609 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1610 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1611 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1612 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1613 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1614 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1615
1616 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1617 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1618 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1619 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1620 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1621 @file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1622
1623 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1624 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1625 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1626
1627 @item gnus-play-startup-jingle
1628 @vindex gnus-play-startup-jingle
1629 If non-@code{nil}, play the Gnus jingle at startup.
1630
1631 @item gnus-startup-jingle
1632 @vindex gnus-startup-jingle
1633 Jingle to be played if the above variable is non-@code{nil}. The
1634 default is @samp{Tuxedomoon.Jingle4.au}.
1635
1636 @end table
1637
1638
1639 @node Group Buffer
1640 @chapter Group Buffer
1641 @cindex group buffer
1642
1643 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1644 @c
1645 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1646 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1647 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1648 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1649 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1650 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1651 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1652 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1653 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1654 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1655 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1656 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1657 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1658 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1659 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1660 @c human rights at 9...
1661
1662
1663 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1664 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1665 long as Gnus is active.
1666
1667 @iftex
1668 @iflatex
1669 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1670 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1671 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1672 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1673 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1674 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1675 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1676 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1677 }
1678 @end iflatex
1679 @end iftex
1680
1681 @menu
1682 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1683 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1684 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1685 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1686 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1687 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1688 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1689 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1690 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1691 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1692 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1693 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1694 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1695 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1696 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1697 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1698 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1699 @end menu
1700
1701
1702 @node Group Buffer Format
1703 @section Group Buffer Format
1704
1705 @menu
1706 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1707 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1708 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1709 @end menu
1710
1711
1712 @node Group Line Specification
1713 @subsection Group Line Specification
1714 @cindex group buffer format
1715
1716 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1717 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1718
1719 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1720
1721 @example
1722 25: news.announce.newusers
1723 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1724 @end example
1725
1726 Quite simple, huh?
1727
1728 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1729 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1730 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1731 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1732
1733 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1734 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1735 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1736 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1737 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C.
1738 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1739
1740 @samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1741
1742 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1743 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1744 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1745 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1746 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1747
1748 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1749 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1750 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1751
1752 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1753
1754 @table @samp
1755
1756 @item M
1757 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1758
1759 @item S
1760 Whether the group is subscribed.
1761
1762 @item L
1763 Level of subscribedness.
1764
1765 @item N
1766 Number of unread articles.
1767
1768 @item I
1769 Number of dormant articles.
1770
1771 @item T
1772 Number of ticked articles.
1773
1774 @item R
1775 Number of read articles.
1776
1777 @item U
1778 Number of unseen articles.
1779
1780 @item t
1781 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1782 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1783
1784 Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1785 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1786 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1787 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1788 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1789 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1790 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job. If you
1791 want to work on this, please contact the Gnus mailing list.
1792
1793 @item y
1794 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1795
1796 @item i
1797 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1798
1799 @item g
1800 Full group name.
1801
1802 @item G
1803 Group name.
1804
1805 @item C
1806 Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1807 comment element in the group parameters.
1808
1809 @item D
1810 Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1811 before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1812 @code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1813 command.
1814
1815 @item o
1816 @samp{m} if moderated.
1817
1818 @item O
1819 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1820
1821 @item s
1822 Select method.
1823
1824 @item B
1825 If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1826
1827 @item n
1828 Select from where.
1829
1830 @item z
1831 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1832 used.
1833
1834 @item P
1835 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1836
1837 @item c
1838 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1839 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1840 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1841 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1842 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1843
1844 @item m
1845 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1846 @cindex %
1847 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1848 the group lately.
1849
1850 @item p
1851 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1852
1853 @item d
1854 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1855 Timestamp}).
1856
1857 @item u
1858 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1859 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1860 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1861 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1862 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1863 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1864 specifier.
1865 @end table
1866
1867 @cindex *
1868 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1869 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1870 group, or a bogus native group.
1871
1872
1873 @node Group Mode Line Specification
1874 @subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1875 @cindex group mode line
1876
1877 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1878 The mode line can be changed by setting
1879 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1880 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1881
1882 @table @samp
1883 @item S
1884 The native news server.
1885 @item M
1886 The native select method.
1887 @end table
1888
1889
1890 @node Group Highlighting
1891 @subsection Group Highlighting
1892 @cindex highlighting
1893 @cindex group highlighting
1894
1895 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1896 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1897 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1898 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1899 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1900
1901 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1902 background is dark:
1903
1904 @lisp
1905 (cond (window-system
1906 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1907 (defface my-group-face-1
1908 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1909 (defface my-group-face-2
1910 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1911 "Second group face")
1912 (defface my-group-face-3
1913 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1914 (defface my-group-face-4
1915 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1916 (defface my-group-face-5
1917 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1918
1919 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1920 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1921 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1922 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1923 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1924 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1925 @end lisp
1926
1927 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1928
1929 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1930 include:
1931
1932 @table @code
1933 @item group
1934 The group name.
1935 @item unread
1936 The number of unread articles in the group.
1937 @item method
1938 The select method.
1939 @item mailp
1940 Whether the group is a mail group.
1941 @item level
1942 The level of the group.
1943 @item score
1944 The score of the group.
1945 @item ticked
1946 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1947 @item total
1948 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1949 @var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1950 @item topic
1951 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1952 topic being inserted.
1953 @end table
1954
1955 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1956 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1957 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1958
1959 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1960 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1961 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1962 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}. This hook
1963 calls @code{gnus-group-highlight-line} by default.
1964
1965
1966 @node Group Maneuvering
1967 @section Group Maneuvering
1968 @cindex group movement
1969
1970 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1971 expected, hopefully.
1972
1973 @table @kbd
1974
1975 @item n
1976 @kindex n (Group)
1977 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1978 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1979 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1980
1981 @item p
1982 @itemx DEL
1983 @kindex DEL (Group)
1984 @kindex p (Group)
1985 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
1986 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
1987 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
1988
1989 @item N
1990 @kindex N (Group)
1991 @findex gnus-group-next-group
1992 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
1993
1994 @item P
1995 @kindex P (Group)
1996 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
1997 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
1998
1999 @item M-n
2000 @kindex M-n (Group)
2001 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2002 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2003 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2004
2005 @item M-p
2006 @kindex M-p (Group)
2007 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2008 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2009 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2010 @end table
2011
2012 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2013
2014 @table @kbd
2015
2016 @item j
2017 @kindex j (Group)
2018 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2019 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2020 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2021 like living groups.
2022
2023 @item ,
2024 @kindex , (Group)
2025 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2026 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2027 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2028
2029 @item .
2030 @kindex . (Group)
2031 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2032 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2033 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2034 @end table
2035
2036 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2037 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2038 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2039 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2040 is @code{t}.
2041
2042
2043 @node Selecting a Group
2044 @section Selecting a Group
2045 @cindex group selection
2046
2047 @table @kbd
2048
2049 @item SPACE
2050 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2051 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2052 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2053 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2054 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2055 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2056 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2057 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2058 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2059 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2060
2061 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2062 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2063 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2064
2065 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2066 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2067 ones.
2068
2069 @item RET
2070 @kindex RET (Group)
2071 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2072 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2073 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2074 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2075 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2076 entry.
2077
2078 @item M-RET
2079 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2080 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2081 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2082 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2083 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2084 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2085 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2086 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2087 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2088 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2089
2090 @item M-SPACE
2091 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2092 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2093 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2094 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2095 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2096
2097 @item C-M-RET
2098 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2099 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2100 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2101 doing any processing of its contents
2102 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2103 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2104 manner will have no permanent effects.
2105
2106 @end table
2107
2108 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2109 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2110 consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2111 considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2112 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2113 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2114 articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2115 negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2116 fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2117 most recently will be fetched.
2118
2119 @vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2120 @code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2121 @code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2122 newsgroups.
2123
2124 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2125 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2126 @vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2127 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2128 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2129 Which article this is is controlled by the
2130 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2131 variable is:
2132
2133 @table @code
2134
2135 @item unread
2136 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2137
2138 @item first
2139 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2140
2141 @item unseen
2142 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2143
2144 @item unseen-or-unread
2145 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2146 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2147 unread article.
2148
2149 @item best
2150 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2151
2152 @end table
2153
2154 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2155 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2156
2157 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2158 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2159 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2160 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2161 selected.
2162
2163
2164 @node Subscription Commands
2165 @section Subscription Commands
2166 @cindex subscription
2167
2168 @table @kbd
2169
2170 @item S t
2171 @itemx u
2172 @kindex S t (Group)
2173 @kindex u (Group)
2174 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2175 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2176 Toggle subscription to the current group
2177 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2178
2179 @item S s
2180 @itemx U
2181 @kindex S s (Group)
2182 @kindex U (Group)
2183 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2184 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2185 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2186 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2187
2188 @item S k
2189 @itemx C-k
2190 @kindex S k (Group)
2191 @kindex C-k (Group)
2192 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2193 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2194 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2195
2196 @item S y
2197 @itemx C-y
2198 @kindex S y (Group)
2199 @kindex C-y (Group)
2200 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2201 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2202
2203 @item C-x C-t
2204 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2205 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2206 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2207 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2208 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2209
2210 @item S w
2211 @itemx C-w
2212 @kindex S w (Group)
2213 @kindex C-w (Group)
2214 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2215 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2216
2217 @item S z
2218 @kindex S z (Group)
2219 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2220 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2221
2222 @item S C-k
2223 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2224 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2225 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2226 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2227 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2228 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2229 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2230 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2231 @file{.newsrc} file.
2232
2233 @end table
2234
2235 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2236
2237
2238 @node Group Data
2239 @section Group Data
2240
2241 @table @kbd
2242
2243 @item c
2244 @kindex c (Group)
2245 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2246 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2247 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2248 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2249 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2250 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2251 the group buffer.
2252
2253 @item C
2254 @kindex C (Group)
2255 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2256 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2257 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2258
2259 @item M-c
2260 @kindex M-c (Group)
2261 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2262 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2263 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2264
2265 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2266 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2267 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2268 If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2269 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2270 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2271 caution.
2272
2273 @end table
2274
2275
2276 @node Group Levels
2277 @section Group Levels
2278 @cindex group level
2279 @cindex level
2280
2281 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2282 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2283 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2284 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2285 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2286
2287 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2288
2289 @table @kbd
2290
2291 @item S l
2292 @kindex S l (Group)
2293 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2294 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2295 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2296 prompted for a level.
2297 @end table
2298
2299 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2300 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2301 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2302 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2303 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2304 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2305 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2306 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2307 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2308 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2309 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2310 same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2311 you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2312 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2313 reasons of efficiency.
2314
2315 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2316 low levels (e.g. 1 or 2).
2317
2318 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2319 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2320 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2321 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2322 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2323 groups are hidden, in a way.
2324
2325 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2326 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2327 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2328 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2329 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2330 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2331
2332 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2333 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2334 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2335 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2336 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2337 list of killed groups.)
2338
2339 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2340 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2341 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2342
2343 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2344 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2345 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2346 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2347 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2348 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2349 relevant valid ranges.
2350
2351 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2352 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2353 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2354 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2355 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2356 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2357 rest.
2358
2359 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2360 one with the best level.
2361
2362 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2363 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2364 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2365 by default.
2366
2367 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2368 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2369 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2370 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2371 listed.
2372
2373 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2374 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2375 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2376 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2377
2378 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2379 Gnus will normally just activate (i. e., query the server about) groups
2380 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2381 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2382 to 5. The default is 6.
2383
2384
2385 @node Group Score
2386 @section Group Score
2387 @cindex group score
2388 @cindex group rank
2389 @cindex rank
2390
2391 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2392 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2393 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2394 reason?
2395
2396 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2397 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2398 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2399 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2400 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2401 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2402 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2403 least significant part.))
2404
2405 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2406 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2407 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2408 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2409 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2410 action after each summary exit, you can add
2411 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2412 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2413 slow things down somewhat.
2414
2415
2416 @node Marking Groups
2417 @section Marking Groups
2418 @cindex marking groups
2419
2420 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2421 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2422 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2423 bidding on those groups.
2424
2425 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2426 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2427 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2428
2429 @table @kbd
2430
2431 @item #
2432 @kindex # (Group)
2433 @itemx M m
2434 @kindex M m (Group)
2435 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2436 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2437
2438 @item M-#
2439 @kindex M-# (Group)
2440 @itemx M u
2441 @kindex M u (Group)
2442 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2443 Remove the mark from the current group
2444 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2445
2446 @item M U
2447 @kindex M U (Group)
2448 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2449 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2450
2451 @item M w
2452 @kindex M w (Group)
2453 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2454 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2455
2456 @item M b
2457 @kindex M b (Group)
2458 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2459 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2460
2461 @item M r
2462 @kindex M r (Group)
2463 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2464 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2465 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2466 @end table
2467
2468 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2469
2470 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2471 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2472 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2473 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2474 the command to be executed.
2475
2476
2477 @node Foreign Groups
2478 @section Foreign Groups
2479 @cindex foreign groups
2480
2481 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2482 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2483 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2484 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2485 consulted.
2486
2487 @table @kbd
2488
2489 @item G m
2490 @kindex G m (Group)
2491 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2492 @cindex making groups
2493 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2494 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2495 to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2496
2497 @item G M
2498 @kindex G M (Group)
2499 @findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2500 Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2501 will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2502
2503 @item G r
2504 @kindex G r (Group)
2505 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2506 @cindex renaming groups
2507 Rename the current group to something else
2508 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2509 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2510 on some back ends.
2511
2512 @item G c
2513 @kindex G c (Group)
2514 @cindex customizing
2515 @findex gnus-group-customize
2516 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2517
2518 @item G e
2519 @kindex G e (Group)
2520 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2521 @cindex renaming groups
2522 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2523 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2524
2525 @item G p
2526 @kindex G p (Group)
2527 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2528 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2529 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2530
2531 @item G E
2532 @kindex G E (Group)
2533 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2534 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2535 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2536
2537 @item G d
2538 @kindex G d (Group)
2539 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2540 @cindex nndir
2541 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2542 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2543
2544 @item G h
2545 @kindex G h (Group)
2546 @cindex help group
2547 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2548 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2549
2550 @item G a
2551 @kindex G a (Group)
2552 @cindex (ding) archive
2553 @cindex archive group
2554 @findex gnus-group-make-archive-group
2555 @vindex gnus-group-archive-directory
2556 @vindex gnus-group-recent-archive-directory
2557 Make a Gnus archive group (@code{gnus-group-make-archive-group}). By
2558 default a group pointing to the most recent articles will be created
2559 (@code{gnus-group-recent-archive-directory}), but given a prefix, a full
2560 group will be created from @code{gnus-group-archive-directory}.
2561
2562 @item G k
2563 @kindex G k (Group)
2564 @findex gnus-group-make-kiboze-group
2565 @cindex nnkiboze
2566 Make a kiboze group. You will be prompted for a name, for a regexp to
2567 match groups to be ``included'' in the kiboze group, and a series of
2568 strings to match on headers (@code{gnus-group-make-kiboze-group}).
2569 @xref{Kibozed Groups}.
2570
2571 @item G D
2572 @kindex G D (Group)
2573 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2574 @cindex nneething
2575 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2576 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2577 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2578
2579 @item G f
2580 @kindex G f (Group)
2581 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2582 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2583 @cindex nndoc
2584 Make a group based on some file or other
2585 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2586 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2587 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2588 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2589 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2590 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2591 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2592 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2593 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2594
2595 @item G u
2596 @kindex G u (Group)
2597 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2598 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2599 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2600 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2601
2602 @item G w
2603 @kindex G w (Group)
2604 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2605 @cindex Google
2606 @cindex nnweb
2607 @cindex gmane
2608 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2609 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2610 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2611 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2612 include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2613 @xref{Web Searches}.
2614
2615 If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2616 to a particular group by using a match string like
2617 @samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2618
2619 @item G R
2620 @kindex G R (Group)
2621 @findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2622 Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2623 (@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL.
2624 @xref{RSS}.
2625
2626 @item G DEL
2627 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2628 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2629 This function will delete the current group
2630 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2631 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2632 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2633 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2634 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2635
2636 @item G V
2637 @kindex G V (Group)
2638 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2639 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2640 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2641
2642 @item G v
2643 @kindex G v (Group)
2644 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2645 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2646 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2647 @end table
2648
2649 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2650 methods.
2651
2652 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2653 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2654 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2655 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2656 groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2657 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2658 newsgroups.
2659
2660
2661 @node Group Parameters
2662 @section Group Parameters
2663 @cindex group parameters
2664
2665 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2666 Here's an example group parameter list:
2667
2668 @example
2669 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2670 (auto-expire . t))
2671 @end example
2672
2673 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2674 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2675 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2676 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2677
2678 Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2679 is an alist of regexps and values.
2680
2681 The following group parameters can be used:
2682
2683 @table @code
2684 @item to-address
2685 @cindex to-address
2686 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2687
2688 @example
2689 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2690 @end example
2691
2692 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2693 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2694 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2695 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2696 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2697
2698 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2699 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2700 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2701 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2702 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2703 list address instead.
2704
2705 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2706
2707 @item to-list
2708 @cindex to-list
2709 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2710
2711 @example
2712 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2713 @end example
2714
2715 It is totally ignored
2716 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2717 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2718
2719 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2720 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2721 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2722 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2723 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2724
2725 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2726 @cindex mail list groups
2727 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2728 entering summary buffer.
2729
2730 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2731
2732 @anchor{subscribed}
2733 @item subscribed
2734 @cindex subscribed
2735 @cindex Mail-Followup-To
2736 @findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2737 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2738 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2739 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2740 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2741 headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2742 following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2743
2744 @lisp
2745 (setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2746 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2747 @end lisp
2748
2749 @xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2750 a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2751
2752 @item visible
2753 @cindex visible
2754 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2755 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2756 of whether it has any unread articles.
2757
2758 @item broken-reply-to
2759 @cindex broken-reply-to
2760 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2761 headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2762 if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2763 can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2764 has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2765 itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2766
2767 @item to-group
2768 @cindex to-group
2769 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2770 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2771
2772 @item newsgroup
2773 @cindex newsgroup
2774 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2775 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2776 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2777 news group.
2778
2779 @item gcc-self
2780 @cindex gcc-self
2781 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2782 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2783 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2784 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2785 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2786 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2787 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
2788
2789 @strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2790 @code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2791 doesn't accept articles.
2792
2793 @item auto-expire
2794 @cindex auto-expire
2795 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2796 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2797 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2798
2799 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2800
2801 @item total-expire
2802 @cindex total-expire
2803 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2804 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2805 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2806 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2807 expiry.
2808
2809 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2810
2811 @item expiry-wait
2812 @cindex expiry-wait
2813 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2814 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2815 @code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2816 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2817 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2818 can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2819 symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2820
2821 @item expiry-target
2822 @cindex expiry-target
2823 Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2824 @code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2825
2826 @item score-file
2827 @cindex score file group parameter
2828 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2829 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2830 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2831
2832 @item adapt-file
2833 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2834 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2835 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2836 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2837
2838 @item admin-address
2839 @cindex admin-address
2840 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2841 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2842 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2843 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2844
2845 @item display
2846 @cindex display
2847 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2848 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2849
2850 @table @code
2851 @item all
2852 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2853
2854 @item an integer
2855 Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2856 entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2857
2858 @item default
2859 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2860 ticked articles.
2861
2862 @item an array
2863 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2864
2865 Here are some examples:
2866
2867 @table @code
2868 @item [unread]
2869 Display only unread articles.
2870
2871 @item [not expire]
2872 Display everything except expirable articles.
2873
2874 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2875 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2876 responded to.
2877 @end table
2878
2879 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2880 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2881 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2882 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2883 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, @code{unseen} and @code{recent}.
2884
2885 @end table
2886
2887 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2888 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2889 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2890
2891 @item comment
2892 @cindex comment
2893 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2894 arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
2895 group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
2896
2897 @item charset
2898 @cindex charset
2899 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
2900 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
2901 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
2902
2903 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
2904
2905 @item ignored-charsets
2906 @cindex ignored-charset
2907 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
2908 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
2909 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
2910
2911 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
2912
2913 @item posting-style
2914 @cindex posting-style
2915 You can store additional posting style information for this group
2916 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
2917 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
2918 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
2919 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
2920
2921 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
2922 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
2923 like this in the group parameters:
2924
2925 @example
2926 (posting-style
2927 (name "Funky Name")
2928 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
2929 (signature "Funky Signature"))
2930 @end example
2931
2932 @item post-method
2933 @cindex post-method
2934 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
2935 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
2936
2937 @item banner
2938 @cindex banner
2939 An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
2940 that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
2941 @var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
2942 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
2943 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
2944
2945 @item sieve
2946 @cindex sieve
2947 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
2948 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
2949 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
2950 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
2951
2952 For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
2953 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
2954 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
2955 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
2956
2957 @example
2958 if address \"sender\" \"sieve-admin@@extundo.com\" @{
2959 fileinto \"INBOX.list.sieve\";
2960 @}
2961 @end example
2962
2963 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
2964 Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
2965
2966 @item (agent parameters)
2967 If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of the its parameters
2968 to control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
2969 Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
2970 agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
2971 minimize the configuration effort.
2972
2973 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
2974 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
2975 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
2976 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
2977 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
2978 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
2979 @code{eval}ed there.
2980
2981 Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer.
2982 But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
2983 message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
2984 message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
2985 question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
2986 Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
2987 parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
2988 @file{~/.gnus} file:
2989
2990 @lisp
2991 (add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
2992 @end lisp
2993
2994 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
2995 A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
2996 the subject fields of articles. E.g. if the news group
2997
2998 @example
2999 nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3000 @end example
3001
3002 has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3003 tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3004 the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3005 into the group parameters for the group.
3006
3007 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3008 hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
3009 @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group.
3010 @code{dummy-variable} will be set to the (meaningless) result of the
3011 @code{(ding)} form.
3012
3013 Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3014 pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3015 following is added to a group parameter
3016
3017 @lisp
3018 (gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3019 '(lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3020 @end lisp
3021
3022 when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3023 expired.
3024
3025 @end table
3026
3027 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
3028 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
3029 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
3030 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
3031 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
3032
3033 @vindex gnus-parameters
3034 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3035 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect. For
3036 example:
3037
3038 @lisp
3039 (setq gnus-parameters
3040 '(("mail\\..*"
3041 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3042 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3043 (gnus-summary-line-format
3044 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3045 (gcc-self . t)
3046 (display . all))
3047
3048 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3049 (to-group . "\\1"))
3050
3051 ("mail\\.me"
3052 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3053
3054 ("list\\..*"
3055 (total-expire . t)
3056 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3057 @end lisp
3058
3059 String value of parameters will be subjected to regexp substitution, as
3060 the @code{to-group} example shows.
3061
3062
3063 @node Listing Groups
3064 @section Listing Groups
3065 @cindex group listing
3066
3067 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3068
3069 @table @kbd
3070
3071 @item l
3072 @itemx A s
3073 @kindex A s (Group)
3074 @kindex l (Group)
3075 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
3076 List all groups that have unread articles
3077 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3078 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3079 only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3080 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3081 groups).
3082
3083 @item L
3084 @itemx A u
3085 @kindex A u (Group)
3086 @kindex L (Group)
3087 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3088 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3089 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3090 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3091 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3092 unsubscribed groups).
3093
3094 @item A l
3095 @kindex A l (Group)
3096 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3097 List all unread groups on a specific level
3098 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3099 with no unread articles.
3100
3101 @item A k
3102 @kindex A k (Group)
3103 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3104 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3105 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3106 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3107 from the server.
3108
3109 @item A z
3110 @kindex A z (Group)
3111 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3112 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3113
3114 @item A m
3115 @kindex A m (Group)
3116 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3117 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3118 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3119
3120 @item A M
3121 @kindex A M (Group)
3122 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3123 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3124
3125 @item A A
3126 @kindex A A (Group)
3127 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3128 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3129 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3130 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3131 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3132 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3133 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3134 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3135
3136 @item A a
3137 @kindex A a (Group)
3138 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3139 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3140 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3141
3142 @item A d
3143 @kindex A d (Group)
3144 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3145 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3146 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3147
3148 @item A c
3149 @kindex A c (Group)
3150 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3151 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3152
3153 @item A ?
3154 @kindex A ? (Group)
3155 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3156 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3157
3158 @item A /
3159 @kindex A / (Group)
3160 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3161 List groups limited within the current selection
3162 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}).
3163
3164 @item A f
3165 @kindex A f (Group)
3166 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3167 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3168
3169 @item A p
3170 @kindex A p (Group)
3171 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3172 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3173
3174 @end table
3175
3176 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3177 @cindex visible group parameter
3178 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3179 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3180 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3181 get the same effect.
3182
3183 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3184 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3185 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3186 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3187 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3188
3189
3190 @node Sorting Groups
3191 @section Sorting Groups
3192 @cindex sorting groups
3193
3194 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3195 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3196 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3197 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3198 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3199 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3200 include:
3201
3202 @table @code
3203
3204 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3205 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3206 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3207
3208 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3209 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3210 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3211
3212 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3213 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3214 Sort by group level.
3215
3216 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3217 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3218 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3219
3220 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3221 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3222 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3223 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3224
3225 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3226 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3227 Sort by number of unread articles.
3228
3229 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3230 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3231 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3232
3233 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3234 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3235 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3236
3237
3238 @end table
3239
3240 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3241 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3242 the last one.
3243
3244
3245 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3246 some sorting criteria:
3247
3248 @table @kbd
3249 @item G S a
3250 @kindex G S a (Group)
3251 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3252 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3253 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3254
3255 @item G S u
3256 @kindex G S u (Group)
3257 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3258 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3259 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3260
3261 @item G S l
3262 @kindex G S l (Group)
3263 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3264 Sort the group buffer by group level
3265 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3266
3267 @item G S v
3268 @kindex G S v (Group)
3269 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3270 Sort the group buffer by group score
3271 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3272
3273 @item G S r
3274 @kindex G S r (Group)
3275 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3276 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3277 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3278
3279 @item G S m
3280 @kindex G S m (Group)
3281 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3282 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3283 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3284
3285 @item G S n
3286 @kindex G S n (Group)
3287 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3288 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3289 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3290
3291 @end table
3292
3293 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3294 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3295
3296 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3297 commands will sort in reverse order.
3298
3299 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3300
3301 @table @kbd
3302 @item G P a
3303 @kindex G P a (Group)
3304 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3305 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3306 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3307
3308 @item G P u
3309 @kindex G P u (Group)
3310 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3311 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3312 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3313
3314 @item G P l
3315 @kindex G P l (Group)
3316 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3317 Sort the groups by group level
3318 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3319
3320 @item G P v
3321 @kindex G P v (Group)
3322 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3323 Sort the groups by group score
3324 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3325
3326 @item G P r
3327 @kindex G P r (Group)
3328 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3329 Sort the groups by group rank
3330 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3331
3332 @item G P m
3333 @kindex G P m (Group)
3334 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3335 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3336 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3337
3338 @item G P n
3339 @kindex G P n (Group)
3340 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3341 Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3342 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3343
3344 @item G P s
3345 @kindex G P s (Group)
3346 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3347 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3348
3349 @end table
3350
3351 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3352 move groups around.
3353
3354
3355 @node Group Maintenance
3356 @section Group Maintenance
3357 @cindex bogus groups
3358
3359 @table @kbd
3360 @item b
3361 @kindex b (Group)
3362 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3363 Find bogus groups and delete them
3364 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3365
3366 @item F
3367 @kindex F (Group)
3368 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3369 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3370 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3371 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3372 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3373 zombies.
3374
3375 @item C-c C-x
3376 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3377 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3378 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3379 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3380 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3381 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3382
3383 @item C-c C-M-x
3384 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3385 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3386 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3387 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3388
3389 @end table
3390
3391
3392 @node Browse Foreign Server
3393 @section Browse Foreign Server
3394 @cindex foreign servers
3395 @cindex browsing servers
3396
3397 @table @kbd
3398 @item B
3399 @kindex B (Group)
3400 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3401 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3402 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3403 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3404 @end table
3405
3406 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3407 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3408 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3409 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3410
3411 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3412
3413 @table @kbd
3414 @item n
3415 @kindex n (Browse)
3416 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3417 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3418
3419 @item p
3420 @kindex p (Browse)
3421 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3422 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3423
3424 @item SPACE
3425 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3426 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3427 Enter the current group and display the first article
3428 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3429
3430 @item RET
3431 @kindex RET (Browse)
3432 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3433 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3434
3435 @item u
3436 @kindex u (Browse)
3437 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3438 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3439 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}).
3440
3441 @item l
3442 @itemx q
3443 @kindex q (Browse)
3444 @kindex l (Browse)
3445 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3446 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3447
3448 @item d
3449 @kindex d (Browse)
3450 @findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3451 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3452
3453 @item ?
3454 @kindex ? (Browse)
3455 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3456 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3457 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3458 @end table
3459
3460
3461 @node Exiting Gnus
3462 @section Exiting Gnus
3463 @cindex exiting Gnus
3464
3465 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3466
3467 @table @kbd
3468 @item z
3469 @kindex z (Group)
3470 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3471 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3472 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3473 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3474
3475 @item q
3476 @kindex q (Group)
3477 @findex gnus-group-exit
3478 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3479 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3480
3481 @item Q
3482 @kindex Q (Group)
3483 @findex gnus-group-quit
3484 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3485 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3486 @end table
3487
3488 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3489 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3490 @vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3491 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3492 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3493 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3494 exiting Gnus.
3495
3496 Note:
3497
3498 @quotation
3499 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3500 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3501 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3502 plastic chair.
3503 @end quotation
3504
3505
3506 @node Group Topics
3507 @section Group Topics
3508 @cindex topics
3509
3510 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3511 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3512 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3513 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3514 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3515 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3516
3517 @iftex
3518 @iflatex
3519 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3520 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3521 }
3522 @end iflatex
3523 @end iftex
3524
3525 Here's an example:
3526
3527 @example
3528 Gnus
3529 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3530 3: comp.emacs
3531 2: alt.religion.emacs
3532 Naughty Emacs
3533 452: alt.sex.emacs
3534 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3535 Misc
3536 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3537 13: comp.sources.unix
3538 @end example
3539
3540 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3541 @kindex t (Group)
3542 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3543 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3544 is a toggling command.)
3545
3546 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3547 dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3548 Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3549 under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3550 Hot and bothered?
3551
3552 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3553 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3554 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3555
3556 @lisp
3557 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3558 @end lisp
3559
3560 @menu
3561 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3562 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3563 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3564 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3565 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3566 @end menu
3567
3568
3569 @node Topic Commands
3570 @subsection Topic Commands
3571 @cindex topic commands
3572
3573 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3574 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3575 definitions slightly.
3576
3577 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3578 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3579 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3580 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3581 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3582 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3583
3584 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3585 the way you like.
3586
3587 @table @kbd
3588
3589 @item T n
3590 @kindex T n (Topic)
3591 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3592 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3593 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3594
3595 @item T TAB
3596 @itemx TAB
3597 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3598 @kindex TAB (Topic)
3599 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3600 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3601 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3602 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3603
3604 @item M-TAB
3605 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3606 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3607 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3608 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3609
3610 @end table
3611
3612 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3613 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3614 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3615 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3616
3617 @table @kbd
3618
3619 @item C-k
3620 @kindex C-k (Topic)
3621 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3622 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3623 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3624
3625 @item C-y
3626 @kindex C-y (Topic)
3627 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3628 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3629 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3630 before all groups.
3631
3632 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3633 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3634 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3635 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3636 paste. Like I said -- E-Z.
3637
3638 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3639 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3640
3641 @end table
3642
3643 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3644 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3645 key.
3646
3647 @table @kbd
3648
3649 @item RET
3650 @kindex RET (Topic)
3651 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3652 @itemx SPACE
3653 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3654 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3655 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3656 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3657 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3658 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3659
3660 @end table
3661
3662 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3663
3664 @table @kbd
3665
3666 @item T m
3667 @kindex T m (Topic)
3668 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3669 Move the current group to some other topic
3670 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3671 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3672
3673 @item T j
3674 @kindex T j (Topic)
3675 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3676 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3677
3678 @item T c
3679 @kindex T c (Topic)
3680 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3681 Copy the current group to some other topic
3682 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3683 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3684
3685 @item T h
3686 @kindex T h (Topic)
3687 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3688 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3689 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3690
3691 @item T s
3692 @kindex T s (Topic)
3693 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3694 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3695 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3696
3697 @item T D
3698 @kindex T D (Topic)
3699 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3700 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3701 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3702 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3703 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3704 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3705 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3706 topic.
3707
3708 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3709 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3710
3711 @item T M
3712 @kindex T M (Topic)
3713 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3714 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3715 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3716
3717 @item T C
3718 @kindex T C (Topic)
3719 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3720 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3721 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3722
3723 @item T H
3724 @kindex T H (Topic)
3725 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3726 Toggle hiding empty topics
3727 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3728
3729 @item T #
3730 @kindex T # (Topic)
3731 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3732 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3733 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3734 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3735
3736 @item T M-#
3737 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3738 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3739 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3740 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3741 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3742
3743 @item C-c C-x
3744 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3745 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3746 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3747 expiry process (if any)
3748 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3749
3750 @item T r
3751 @kindex T r (Topic)
3752 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3753 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3754
3755 @item T DEL
3756 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3757 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3758 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3759
3760 @item A T
3761 @kindex A T (Topic)
3762 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3763 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3764 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3765
3766 @item T M-n
3767 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3768 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3769 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3770
3771 @item T M-p
3772 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3773 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3774 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3775
3776 @item G p
3777 @kindex G p (Topic)
3778 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3779 @cindex group parameters
3780 @cindex topic parameters
3781 @cindex parameters
3782 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3783 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3784
3785 @end table
3786
3787
3788 @node Topic Variables
3789 @subsection Topic Variables
3790 @cindex topic variables
3791
3792 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
3793 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
3794
3795 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3796 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3797 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3798 Valid elements are:
3799
3800 @table @samp
3801 @item i
3802 Indentation.
3803 @item n
3804 Topic name.
3805 @item v
3806 Visibility.
3807 @item l
3808 Level.
3809 @item g
3810 Number of groups in the topic.
3811 @item a
3812 Number of unread articles in the topic.
3813 @item A
3814 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
3815 @end table
3816
3817 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
3818 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
3819 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
3820 The default is 2.
3821
3822 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
3823 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
3824
3825 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
3826 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
3827 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
3828
3829
3830 @node Topic Sorting
3831 @subsection Topic Sorting
3832 @cindex topic sorting
3833
3834 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
3835 commands:
3836
3837
3838 @table @kbd
3839 @item T S a
3840 @kindex T S a (Topic)
3841 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3842 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
3843 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3844
3845 @item T S u
3846 @kindex T S u (Topic)
3847 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
3848 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
3849 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3850
3851 @item T S l
3852 @kindex T S l (Topic)
3853 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
3854 Sort the current topic by group level
3855 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
3856
3857 @item T S v
3858 @kindex T S v (Topic)
3859 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
3860 Sort the current topic by group score
3861 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3862
3863 @item T S r
3864 @kindex T S r (Topic)
3865 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
3866 Sort the current topic by group rank
3867 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3868
3869 @item T S m
3870 @kindex T S m (Topic)
3871 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
3872 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
3873 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
3874
3875 @item T S e
3876 @kindex T S e (Topic)
3877 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
3878 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
3879 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
3880
3881 @item T S s
3882 @kindex T S s (Topic)
3883 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
3884 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
3885 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
3886 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
3887
3888 @end table
3889
3890 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
3891 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
3892 sorting.
3893
3894
3895 @node Topic Topology
3896 @subsection Topic Topology
3897 @cindex topic topology
3898 @cindex topology
3899
3900 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
3901
3902 @example
3903 @group
3904 Gnus
3905 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3906 3: comp.emacs
3907 2: alt.religion.emacs
3908 Naughty Emacs
3909 452: alt.sex.emacs
3910 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3911 Misc
3912 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3913 13: comp.sources.unix
3914 @end group
3915 @end example
3916
3917 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
3918 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
3919 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
3920 follows:
3921
3922 @lisp
3923 (("Gnus" visible)
3924 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
3925 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
3926 (("Misc" visible)))
3927 @end lisp
3928
3929 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
3930 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
3931 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
3932 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
3933 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
3934 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
3935
3936 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
3937 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
3938 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
3939
3940
3941 @node Topic Parameters
3942 @subsection Topic Parameters
3943 @cindex topic parameters
3944
3945 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
3946 (and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
3947 topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
3948 enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
3949 Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
3950
3951 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
3952 parameters:
3953
3954 @table @code
3955 @item subscribe
3956 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
3957 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
3958 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
3959 topic.
3960
3961 @item subscribe-level
3962 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
3963 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
3964 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
3965
3966 @end table
3967
3968 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
3969 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
3970 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
3971 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
3972
3973 @example
3974 @group
3975 Gnus
3976 Emacs
3977 3: comp.emacs
3978 2: alt.religion.emacs
3979 452: alt.sex.emacs
3980 Relief
3981 452: alt.sex.emacs
3982 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3983 Misc
3984 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3985 13: comp.sources.unix
3986 452: alt.sex.emacs
3987 @end group
3988 @end example
3989
3990 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
3991 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
3992 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
3993 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
3994 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
3995 . "religion.SCORE")}.
3996
3997 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
3998 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
3999 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4000 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4001 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4002
4003 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4004 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4005 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4006 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4007 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4008 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4009 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4010 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4011
4012
4013 @node Misc Group Stuff
4014 @section Misc Group Stuff
4015
4016 @menu
4017 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4018 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4019 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4020 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4021 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
4022 @end menu
4023
4024 @table @kbd
4025
4026 @item ^
4027 @kindex ^ (Group)
4028 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4029 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4030 @xref{Server Buffer}.
4031
4032 @item a
4033 @kindex a (Group)
4034 @findex gnus-group-post-news
4035 Start composing a message (a news by default)
4036 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4037 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4038 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4039 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4040 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4041
4042 @item m
4043 @kindex m (Group)
4044 @findex gnus-group-mail
4045 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4046 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4047 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4048 @xref{Composing Messages}.
4049
4050 @item i
4051 @kindex i (Group)
4052 @findex gnus-group-news
4053 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4054 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4055 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4056
4057 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4058 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4059 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4060 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4061 for this to work though.
4062
4063 @end table
4064
4065 Variables for the group buffer:
4066
4067 @table @code
4068
4069 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
4070 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4071 is called after the group buffer has been
4072 created.
4073
4074 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4075 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4076 is called after the group buffer is
4077 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4078 unnatural way.
4079
4080 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4081 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4082 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4083 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
4084
4085 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4086 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4087 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4088 whether they are empty or not.
4089
4090 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4091 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4092 An alist of method and the charset for group names. It is used to show
4093 non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4094
4095 For example:
4096 @lisp
4097 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4098 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4099 @end lisp
4100
4101 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4102 @cindex UTF-8 group names
4103 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4104 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names. It
4105 is used to show non-@acronym{ASCII} group names. @code{((".*"
4106 utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported, otherwise the
4107 default is @code{nil}.
4108
4109 For example:
4110 @lisp
4111 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4112 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)))
4113 @end lisp
4114
4115 @end table
4116
4117 @node Scanning New Messages
4118 @subsection Scanning New Messages
4119 @cindex new messages
4120 @cindex scanning new news
4121
4122 @table @kbd
4123
4124 @item g
4125 @kindex g (Group)
4126 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4127 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4128 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4129 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4130 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4131 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4132 back end(s).
4133
4134 @item M-g
4135 @kindex M-g (Group)
4136 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4137 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4138 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4139 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4140 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4141 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4142 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4143
4144 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4145 @cindex activating groups
4146 @item C-c M-g
4147 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4148 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4149
4150 @item R
4151 @kindex R (Group)
4152 @cindex restarting
4153 @findex gnus-group-restart
4154 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4155 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4156 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
4157
4158 @end table
4159
4160 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4161 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4162
4163 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4164 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4165 news.
4166
4167
4168 @node Group Information
4169 @subsection Group Information
4170 @cindex group information
4171 @cindex information on groups
4172
4173 @table @kbd
4174
4175
4176 @item H f
4177 @kindex H f (Group)
4178 @findex gnus-group-fetch-faq
4179 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
4180 @cindex FAQ
4181 @cindex ange-ftp
4182 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} for the current group
4183 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the @acronym{FAQ}
4184 from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory on
4185 a remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories.
4186 In that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
4187 between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} (or @code{efs}) will be
4188 used for fetching the file.
4189
4190 If fetching from the first site is unsuccessful, Gnus will attempt to go
4191 through @code{gnus-group-faq-directory} and try to open them one by one.
4192
4193 @item H c
4194 @kindex H c (Group)
4195 @findex gnus-group-fetch-charter
4196 @vindex gnus-group-charter-alist
4197 @cindex charter
4198 Try to open the charter for the current group in a web browser
4199 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-charter}). Query for a group if given a
4200 prefix argument.
4201
4202 Gnus will use @code{gnus-group-charter-alist} to find the location of
4203 the charter. If no location is known, Gnus will fetch the control
4204 messages for the group, which in some cases includes the charter.
4205
4206 @item H C
4207 @kindex H C (Group)
4208 @findex gnus-group-fetch-control
4209 @vindex gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url
4210 @cindex control message
4211 Fetch the control messages for the group from the archive at
4212 @code{ftp.isc.org} (@code{gnus-group-fetch-control}). Query for a
4213 group if given a prefix argument.
4214
4215 If @code{gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url} is non-@code{nil},
4216 Gnus will open the control messages in a browser using
4217 @code{browse-url}. Otherwise they are fetched using @code{ange-ftp}
4218 and displayed in an ephemeral group.
4219
4220 Note that the control messages are compressed. To use this command
4221 you need to turn on @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed
4222 Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
4223
4224 @item H d
4225 @itemx C-c C-d
4226 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4227 @kindex H d (Group)
4228 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4229 @cindex describing groups
4230 @cindex group description
4231 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
4232 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4233 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4234
4235 @item M-d
4236 @kindex M-d (Group)
4237 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4238 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4239 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4240
4241 @item H v
4242 @itemx V
4243 @kindex V (Group)
4244 @kindex H v (Group)
4245 @cindex version
4246 @findex gnus-version
4247 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4248
4249 @item ?
4250 @kindex ? (Group)
4251 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4252 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4253
4254 @item C-c C-i
4255 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4256 @cindex info
4257 @cindex manual
4258 @findex gnus-info-find-node
4259 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4260 @end table
4261
4262
4263 @node Group Timestamp
4264 @subsection Group Timestamp
4265 @cindex timestamps
4266 @cindex group timestamps
4267
4268 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4269 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4270 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4271
4272 @lisp
4273 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4274 @end lisp
4275
4276 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4277
4278 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4279 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4280
4281 @lisp
4282 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4283 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4284 @end lisp
4285
4286 This will result in lines looking like:
4287
4288 @example
4289 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4290 0: custom 19961002T012713
4291 @end example
4292
4293 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4294 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4295 something like:
4296
4297 @lisp
4298 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4299 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4300 @end lisp
4301
4302 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4303 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4304 trick:
4305
4306 @lisp
4307 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4308 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4309 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4310 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4311 (if time
4312 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4313 "")))
4314 @end lisp
4315
4316
4317 @node File Commands
4318 @subsection File Commands
4319 @cindex file commands
4320
4321 @table @kbd
4322
4323 @item r
4324 @kindex r (Group)
4325 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4326 @vindex gnus-init-file
4327 @cindex reading init file
4328 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4329 @file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4330
4331 @item s
4332 @kindex s (Group)
4333 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4334 @cindex saving .newsrc
4335 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4336 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4337 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4338
4339 @c @item Z
4340 @c @kindex Z (Group)
4341 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4342 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4343
4344 @end table
4345
4346
4347 @node Sieve Commands
4348 @subsection Sieve Commands
4349 @cindex group sieve commands
4350
4351 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4352 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4353 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4354 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4355 script that can be transfered to the server somehow.
4356
4357 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4358 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4359 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4360 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4361 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4362 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4363 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4364 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4365 regenerate the Sieve script.
4366
4367 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4368 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4369 is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4370 placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4371 is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4372 example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4373 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4374 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4375 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4376 except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4377
4378 @example
4379 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4380 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4381 stop;
4382 @}
4383 @end example
4384
4385 @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4386
4387 @table @kbd
4388
4389 @item D g
4390 @kindex D g (Group)
4391 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
4392 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4393 @cindex generating sieve script
4394 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4395 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4396
4397 @item D u
4398 @kindex D u (Group)
4399 @findex gnus-sieve-update
4400 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4401 @cindex updating sieve script
4402 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4403 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4404 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4405
4406 @end table
4407
4408
4409 @node Summary Buffer
4410 @chapter Summary Buffer
4411 @cindex summary buffer
4412
4413 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4414 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4415
4416 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4417 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4418
4419 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4420
4421 @menu
4422 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4423 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4424 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4425 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4426 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4427 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4428 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4429 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4430 * Threading:: How threads are made.
4431 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4432 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4433 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4434 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4435 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4436 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4437 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4438 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4439 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4440 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
4441 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4442 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4443 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4444 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4445 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4446 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4447 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4448 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4449 or reselecting the current group.
4450 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4451 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4452 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4453 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4454 @end menu
4455
4456
4457 @node Summary Buffer Format
4458 @section Summary Buffer Format
4459 @cindex summary buffer format
4460
4461 @iftex
4462 @iflatex
4463 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4464 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4465 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4466 }
4467 @end iflatex
4468 @end iftex
4469
4470 @menu
4471 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4472 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4473 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4474 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4475 @end menu
4476
4477 @findex mail-extract-address-components
4478 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
4479 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4480 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4481 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4482 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4483 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4484 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4485 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4486 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4487 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
4488
4489 @lisp
4490 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
4491 'mail-extract-address-components)
4492 @end lisp
4493
4494 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4495 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4496 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4497 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4498
4499
4500 @node Summary Buffer Lines
4501 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4502
4503 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4504 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4505 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4506 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4507 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4508
4509 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4510 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4511 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4512 possible to change this. Just write a new function
4513 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4514 @xref{Positioning Point}.
4515
4516 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4517
4518 The following format specification characters and extended format
4519 specification(s) are understood:
4520
4521 @table @samp
4522 @item N
4523 Article number.
4524 @item S
4525 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4526 @code{gnus-list-identifies}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4527 @item s
4528 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4529 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4530 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4531 @item F
4532 Full @code{From} header.
4533 @item n
4534 The name (from the @code{From} header).
4535 @item f
4536 The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4537 From Newsgroups}).
4538 @item a
4539 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4540 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4541 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4542 may be more thorough.
4543 @item A
4544 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4545 the @code{a} spec.
4546 @item L
4547 Number of lines in the article.
4548 @item c
4549 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4550 in some methods (like nnfolder).
4551 @item k
4552 Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4553 for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4554 @item I
4555 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4556 @item B
4557 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4558 lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
4559
4560 @example
4561 >
4562 +->
4563 | +->
4564 | | \->
4565 | | \->
4566 | \->
4567 +->
4568 \->
4569 @end example
4570
4571 You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4572 that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4573 replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4574 line-drawing glyphs.
4575 @table @code
4576 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4577 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4578 Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4579 instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4580
4581 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4582 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4583 Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4584 @code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4585
4586 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4587 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4588 Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4589 instead. The default is @samp{}.
4590
4591 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4592 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4593 Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
4594
4595 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4596 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4597 Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
4598
4599 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4600 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4601 Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
4602
4603 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4604 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4605 Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
4606
4607 @end table
4608
4609 @item T
4610 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4611 pushes everything after it off the screen).
4612 @item [
4613 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4614 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4615 @item ]
4616 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4617 for adopted articles.
4618 @item >
4619 One space for each thread level.
4620 @item <
4621 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4622 @item U
4623 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4624
4625 @item R
4626 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4627 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4628 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4629
4630 @item i
4631 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4632 @item z
4633 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4634 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4635 default level. If the difference between
4636 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4637 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4638 @item V
4639 Total thread score.
4640 @item x
4641 @code{Xref}.
4642 @item D
4643 @code{Date}.
4644 @item d
4645 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4646 @item o
4647 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4648 @item M
4649 @code{Message-ID}.
4650 @item r
4651 @code{References}.
4652 @item t
4653 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4654 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4655 @item e
4656 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4657 article has any children.
4658 @item P
4659 The line number.
4660 @item O
4661 Download mark.
4662 @item &user-date;
4663 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4664 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4665 @item u
4666 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4667 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4668 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4669 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4670 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4671 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4672 @end table
4673
4674 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4675 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4676 There can only be one such area.
4677
4678 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4679 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4680 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4681 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4682 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4683 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4684
4685 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4686 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4687
4688 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
4689
4690
4691 @node To From Newsgroups
4692 @subsection To From Newsgroups
4693 @cindex To
4694 @cindex Newsgroups
4695
4696 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4697 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
4698 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
4699 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
4700 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4701
4702 @enumerate
4703 @item
4704 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
4705 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
4706 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
4707 instance:
4708
4709 @lisp
4710 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4711 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
4712 @end lisp
4713
4714 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
4715 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
4716
4717 @item
4718 @findex gnus-extra-header
4719 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
4720 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
4721 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
4722
4723 @example
4724 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
4725 @end example
4726
4727 @item
4728 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4729 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
4730 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
4731 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
4732 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
4733 headers are used instead.
4734
4735 @end enumerate
4736
4737 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
4738 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
4739 to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
4740 If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
4741 changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
4742 and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g. nnml) to cause
4743 regeneration.
4744
4745 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4746 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
4747 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
4748 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
4749
4750 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
4751 @file{~/.gnus.el}:
4752
4753 @lisp
4754 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4755 '(To Newsgroups))
4756 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
4757 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
4758 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
4759 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4760 "Your Name Here")
4761 @end lisp
4762
4763 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
4764 to fit your needs.)
4765
4766 A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
4767 convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
4768 support:
4769
4770 The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
4771 the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
4772 nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
4773
4774 @example
4775 Newsgroups:full
4776 @end example
4777
4778 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
4779 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
4780
4781
4782 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
4783 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
4784
4785 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
4786 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
4787 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
4788 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
4789
4790 Here are the elements you can play with:
4791
4792 @table @samp
4793 @item G
4794 Group name.
4795 @item p
4796 Unprefixed group name.
4797 @item A
4798 Current article number.
4799 @item z
4800 Current article score.
4801 @item V
4802 Gnus version.
4803 @item U
4804 Number of unread articles in this group.
4805 @item e
4806 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
4807 summary buffer.
4808 @item Z
4809 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
4810 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
4811 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
4812 and no unselected ones.
4813 @item g
4814 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
4815 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
4816 @item S
4817 Subject of the current article.
4818 @item u
4819 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
4820 @item s
4821 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
4822 @item d
4823 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4824 @item t
4825 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4826 @item r
4827 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
4828 @item E
4829 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
4830 @end table
4831
4832
4833 @node Summary Highlighting
4834 @subsection Summary Highlighting
4835
4836 @table @code
4837
4838 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4839 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4840 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
4841 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
4842 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4843
4844 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
4845 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
4846 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
4847 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4848
4849 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
4850 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
4851 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
4852 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
4853
4854 @item gnus-summary-highlight
4855 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
4856 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
4857 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
4858 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
4859 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
4860 to something like
4861 @lisp
4862 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
4863 ((> score default) . bold))
4864 @end lisp
4865 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
4866 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
4867 @end table
4868
4869
4870 @node Summary Maneuvering
4871 @section Summary Maneuvering
4872 @cindex summary movement
4873
4874 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
4875 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
4876
4877 None of these commands select articles.
4878
4879 @table @kbd
4880 @item G M-n
4881 @itemx M-n
4882 @kindex M-n (Summary)
4883 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
4884 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
4885 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
4886 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
4887
4888 @item G M-p
4889 @itemx M-p
4890 @kindex M-p (Summary)
4891 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
4892 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
4893 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
4894 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
4895
4896 @item G g
4897 @kindex G g (Summary)
4898 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
4899 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
4900 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
4901 @end table
4902
4903 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
4904 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
4905 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
4906 to the group buffer.
4907
4908 Variables related to summary movement:
4909
4910 @table @code
4911
4912 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
4913 @item gnus-auto-select-next
4914 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
4915 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
4916 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
4917 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
4918 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
4919 next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
4920 is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
4921 confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
4922 will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
4923 Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
4924 command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
4925 @pxref{Group Levels}.
4926
4927 @item gnus-auto-select-same
4928 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
4929 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
4930 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
4931 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
4932 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
4933 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
4934
4935 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
4936
4937 @item gnus-summary-check-current
4938 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
4939 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
4940 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
4941 Instead, they will choose the current article.
4942
4943 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
4944 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
4945 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
4946 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
4947 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
4948 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
4949 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
4950 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
4951 threads.
4952
4953 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
4954 the given number of lines from the top.
4955
4956 @end table
4957
4958
4959 @node Choosing Articles
4960 @section Choosing Articles
4961 @cindex selecting articles
4962
4963 @menu
4964 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
4965 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
4966 @end menu
4967
4968
4969 @node Choosing Commands
4970 @subsection Choosing Commands
4971
4972 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
4973 and they all select and display an article.
4974
4975 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
4976 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
4977
4978 @table @kbd
4979 @item SPACE
4980 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
4981 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
4982 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
4983 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
4984
4985 If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
4986 again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
4987 @kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
4988
4989 @item G n
4990 @itemx n
4991 @kindex n (Summary)
4992 @kindex G n (Summary)
4993 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
4994 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
4995 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
4996
4997 @item G p
4998 @itemx p
4999 @kindex p (Summary)
5000 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5001 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5002 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
5003
5004 @item G N
5005 @itemx N
5006 @kindex N (Summary)
5007 @kindex G N (Summary)
5008 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
5009 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
5010
5011 @item G P
5012 @itemx P
5013 @kindex P (Summary)
5014 @kindex G P (Summary)
5015 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5016 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
5017
5018 @item G C-n
5019 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
5020 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5021 Go to the next article with the same subject
5022 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
5023
5024 @item G C-p
5025 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
5026 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5027 Go to the previous article with the same subject
5028 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
5029
5030 @item G f
5031 @itemx .
5032 @kindex G f (Summary)
5033 @kindex . (Summary)
5034 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5035 Go to the first unread article
5036 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
5037
5038 @item G b
5039 @itemx ,
5040 @kindex G b (Summary)
5041 @kindex , (Summary)
5042 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5043 Go to the unread article with the highest score
5044 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5045 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
5046
5047 @item G l
5048 @itemx l
5049 @kindex l (Summary)
5050 @kindex G l (Summary)
5051 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5052 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
5053
5054 @item G o
5055 @kindex G o (Summary)
5056 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5057 @cindex history
5058 @cindex article history
5059 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5060 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5061 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5062 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5063 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5064 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
5065
5066 @item G j
5067 @itemx j
5068 @kindex j (Summary)
5069 @kindex G j (Summary)
5070 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5071 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5072 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
5073
5074 @end table
5075
5076
5077 @node Choosing Variables
5078 @subsection Choosing Variables
5079
5080 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
5081
5082 @table @code
5083 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5084 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5085 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5086 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5087 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5088 the server and display it in the article buffer.
5089
5090 @item gnus-select-article-hook
5091 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5092 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. By default it
5093 exposes any threads hidden under the selected article. If you would
5094 like each article to be saved in the Agent as you read it, putting
5095 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this hook will do so.
5096
5097 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
5098 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5099 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5100 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5101 @findex gnus-unread-mark
5102 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5103 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5104 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5105 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-unread-mark}. The
5106 only articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5107 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5108 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5109 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5110 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
5111
5112 @end table
5113
5114
5115 @node Paging the Article
5116 @section Scrolling the Article
5117 @cindex article scrolling
5118
5119 @table @kbd
5120
5121 @item SPACE
5122 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5123 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5124 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5125 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5126 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5127
5128 @vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5129 @vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5130 If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5131 the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5132 skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5133 what is considered uninteresting with
5134 @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5135 pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
5136
5137 @item DEL
5138 @kindex DEL (Summary)
5139 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5140 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
5141
5142 @item RET
5143 @kindex RET (Summary)
5144 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5145 Scroll the current article one line forward
5146 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
5147
5148 @item M-RET
5149 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
5150 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5151 Scroll the current article one line backward
5152 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
5153
5154 @item A g
5155 @itemx g
5156 @kindex A g (Summary)
5157 @kindex g (Summary)
5158 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
5159 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5160 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5161 given a prefix, fetch the current article, but don't run any of the
5162 article treatment functions. This will give you a ``raw'' article, just
5163 the way it came from the server.
5164
5165 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5166 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5167 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
5168
5169 @lisp
5170 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5171 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
5172 (2 . big5)))
5173 @end lisp
5174
5175 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
5176
5177 @item A <
5178 @itemx <
5179 @kindex < (Summary)
5180 @kindex A < (Summary)
5181 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5182 Scroll to the beginning of the article
5183 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
5184
5185 @item A >
5186 @itemx >
5187 @kindex > (Summary)
5188 @kindex A > (Summary)
5189 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5190 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
5191
5192 @item A s
5193 @itemx s
5194 @kindex A s (Summary)
5195 @kindex s (Summary)
5196 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5197 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5198 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
5199
5200 @item h
5201 @kindex h (Summary)
5202 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5203 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5204
5205 @end table
5206
5207
5208 @node Reply Followup and Post
5209 @section Reply, Followup and Post
5210
5211 @menu
5212 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5213 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5214 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5215 * Canceling and Superseding::
5216 @end menu
5217
5218
5219 @node Summary Mail Commands
5220 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
5221 @cindex mail
5222 @cindex composing mail
5223
5224 Commands for composing a mail message:
5225
5226 @table @kbd
5227
5228 @item S r
5229 @itemx r
5230 @kindex S r (Summary)
5231 @kindex r (Summary)
5232 @findex gnus-summary-reply
5233 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5234 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5235 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5236 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5237
5238 @item S R
5239 @itemx R
5240 @kindex R (Summary)
5241 @kindex S R (Summary)
5242 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5243 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5244 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5245 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5246 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5247
5248 @item S w
5249 @kindex S w (Summary)
5250 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5251 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5252 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5253 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5254 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5255 present, that's used instead.
5256
5257 @item S W
5258 @kindex S W (Summary)
5259 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5260 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5261 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5262 the process/prefix convention.
5263
5264 @item S v
5265 @kindex S v (Summary)
5266 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5267 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5268 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5269 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5270 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5271 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5272
5273 @item S V
5274 @kindex S V (Summary)
5275 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5276 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5277 original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5278 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5279
5280 @item S B r
5281 @kindex S B r (Summary)
5282 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5283 Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5284 @code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5285 If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5286 @code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5287 the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5288 correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5289
5290 @item S B R
5291 @kindex S B R (Summary)
5292 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5293 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5294 original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5295 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5296
5297 @item S o m
5298 @itemx C-c C-f
5299 @kindex S o m (Summary)
5300 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5301 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5302 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5303 Forward the current article to some other person
5304 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5305 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5306 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5307 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5308 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5309 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5310 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5311 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5312 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5313 section.
5314
5315 @item S m
5316 @itemx m
5317 @kindex m (Summary)
5318 @kindex S m (Summary)
5319 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5320 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5321 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5322 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5323 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5324
5325 @item S i
5326 @itemx i
5327 @kindex i (Summary)
5328 @kindex S i (Summary)
5329 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5330 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5331 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5332 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5333
5334 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5335 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5336 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5337 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5338 for this to work though.
5339
5340 @item S D b
5341 @kindex S D b (Summary)
5342 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5343 @cindex bouncing mail
5344 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5345 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5346 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5347 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5348 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5349 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5350 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5351 very well fail, though.
5352
5353 @item S D r
5354 @kindex S D r (Summary)
5355 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5356 Not to be confused with the previous command,
5357 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5358 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5359 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5360 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5361 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5362 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5363 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5364
5365 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5366 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5367 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5368 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5369 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5370
5371 This command understands the process/prefix convention
5372 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5373
5374 @item S D e
5375 @kindex S D e (Summary)
5376 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5377
5378 Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5379 if it were a new message before resending.
5380
5381 @item S O m
5382 @kindex S O m (Summary)
5383 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5384 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5385 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5386 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5387
5388 @item S M-c
5389 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
5390 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5391 @cindex crossposting
5392 @cindex excessive crossposting
5393 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5394 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5395
5396 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5397 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5398 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5399 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5400 command understands the process/prefix convention
5401 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5402
5403 @end table
5404
5405 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5406 Manual}, for more information.
5407
5408
5409 @node Summary Post Commands
5410 @subsection Summary Post Commands
5411 @cindex post
5412 @cindex composing news
5413
5414 Commands for posting a news article:
5415
5416 @table @kbd
5417 @item S p
5418 @itemx a
5419 @kindex a (Summary)
5420 @kindex S p (Summary)
5421 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
5422 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5423 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5424 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5425 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5426
5427 @item S f
5428 @itemx f
5429 @kindex f (Summary)
5430 @kindex S f (Summary)
5431 @findex gnus-summary-followup
5432 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5433 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5434
5435 @item S F
5436 @itemx F
5437 @kindex S F (Summary)
5438 @kindex F (Summary)
5439 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5440 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5441 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5442 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5443 process/prefix convention.
5444
5445 @item S n
5446 @kindex S n (Summary)
5447 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5448 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5449 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5450
5451 @item S N
5452 @kindex S N (Summary)
5453 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5454 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5455 message through mail and include the original message
5456 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5457 the process/prefix convention.
5458
5459 @item S o p
5460 @kindex S o p (Summary)
5461 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5462 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5463 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5464 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5465 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5466 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5467 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5468 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5469 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5470 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5471 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5472 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
5473
5474 @item S O p
5475 @kindex S O p (Summary)
5476 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5477 @cindex digests
5478 @cindex making digests
5479 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5480 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command uses the
5481 process/prefix convention.
5482
5483 @item S u
5484 @kindex S u (Summary)
5485 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
5486 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5487 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5488 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5489 @end table
5490
5491 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5492 Manual}, for more information.
5493
5494
5495 @node Summary Message Commands
5496 @subsection Summary Message Commands
5497
5498 @table @kbd
5499 @item S y
5500 @kindex S y (Summary)
5501 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5502 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5503 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5504 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5505 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5506
5507 @end table
5508
5509
5510 @node Canceling and Superseding
5511 @subsection Canceling Articles
5512 @cindex canceling articles
5513 @cindex superseding articles
5514
5515 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5516 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5517
5518 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5519
5520 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5521 @kindex C (Summary)
5522 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5523 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5524 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5525 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5526 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5527 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5528
5529 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5530 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5531 question.
5532
5533 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5534 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5535 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5536
5537 Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5538 @code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5539 message, Message Manual}).
5540
5541 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5542 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5543 your original article.
5544
5545 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5546 @kindex S (Summary)
5547 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5548 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5549 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5550 usual way.
5551
5552 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5553 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5554 have posted almost the same article twice.
5555
5556 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5557 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5558 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5559 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5560 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5561 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5562 header by substituting one of those words for the word
5563 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5564 you would do normally. The previous article will be
5565 canceled/superseded.
5566
5567 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5568
5569 @node Delayed Articles
5570 @section Delayed Articles
5571 @cindex delayed sending
5572 @cindex send delayed
5573
5574 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5575 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5576 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5577 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5578
5579 @lisp
5580 (gnus-delay-initialize)
5581 @end lisp
5582
5583 @findex gnus-delay-article
5584 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5585 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5586 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5587 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5588
5589 @itemize @bullet
5590 @item
5591 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5592 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5593 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5594 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
5595
5596 @item
5597 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5598 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5599 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5600
5601 @item
5602 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5603 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5604 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5605 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5606 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5607 that means a time tomorrow.
5608 @end itemize
5609
5610 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5611 couple of variables:
5612
5613 @table @code
5614 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
5615 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5616 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5617 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5618
5619 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
5620 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5621 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5622 formats described above.
5623
5624 @item gnus-delay-group
5625 @vindex gnus-delay-group
5626 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5627 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5628 value is @code{"delayed"}.
5629
5630 @item gnus-delay-header
5631 @vindex gnus-delay-header
5632 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5633 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5634 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5635 @end table
5636
5637 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5638 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5639 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5640 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5641 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5642
5643 @findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5644 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5645 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5646 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5647 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5648 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5649 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5650
5651 @table @code
5652 @item gnus-delay-initialize
5653 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
5654 By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5655 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5656 argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5657 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5658 argument is ignored.
5659
5660 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5661 Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5662 Just don't forget to set that up :-)
5663 @end table
5664
5665
5666 @node Marking Articles
5667 @section Marking Articles
5668 @cindex article marking
5669 @cindex article ticking
5670 @cindex marks
5671
5672 There are several marks you can set on an article.
5673
5674 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
5675 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
5676 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
5677
5678 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
5679
5680 @ifinfo
5681 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
5682 @end ifinfo
5683
5684 @menu
5685 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
5686 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
5687 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
5688 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
5689 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
5690 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
5691 @end menu
5692
5693
5694 @node Unread Articles
5695 @subsection Unread Articles
5696
5697 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
5698 other.
5699
5700 @table @samp
5701 @item !
5702 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
5703 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
5704
5705 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
5706 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
5707 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
5708 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
5709 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
5710 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
5711 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
5712
5713 @item ?
5714 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
5715 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
5716
5717 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
5718 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
5719 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
5720 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
5721 messages.
5722
5723 @item SPACE
5724 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
5725 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
5726
5727 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
5728 @end table
5729
5730
5731 @node Read Articles
5732 @subsection Read Articles
5733 @cindex expirable mark
5734
5735 All the following marks mark articles as read.
5736
5737 @table @samp
5738
5739 @item r
5740 @vindex gnus-del-mark
5741 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
5742 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
5743
5744 @item R
5745 @vindex gnus-read-mark
5746 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
5747
5748 @item O
5749 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
5750 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
5751 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
5752
5753 @item K
5754 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
5755 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
5756
5757 @item X
5758 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
5759 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
5760
5761 @item Y
5762 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
5763 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
5764
5765 @item C
5766 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
5767 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
5768
5769 @item G
5770 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
5771 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
5772
5773 @item F
5774 @vindex gnus-souped-mark
5775 @sc{soup}ed article (@code{gnus-souped-mark}). @xref{SOUP}.
5776
5777 @item Q
5778 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
5779 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
5780 Threading}.
5781
5782 @item M
5783 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
5784 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
5785 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
5786
5787 @end table
5788
5789 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
5790 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
5791
5792 One more special mark, though:
5793
5794 @table @samp
5795 @item E
5796 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
5797 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
5798
5799 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
5800 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
5801 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
5802 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
5803 any time.
5804 @end table
5805
5806
5807 @node Other Marks
5808 @subsection Other Marks
5809 @cindex process mark
5810 @cindex bookmarks
5811
5812 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
5813 read or not.
5814
5815 @itemize @bullet
5816
5817 @item
5818 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
5819 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
5820 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
5821 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
5822 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
5823
5824 @item
5825 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
5826 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
5827 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
5828 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
5829
5830 @item
5831 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
5832 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
5833 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
5834
5835 @item
5836 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
5837 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
5838 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5839
5840 @item
5841 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
5842 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
5843 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
5844 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
5845
5846 @item
5847 @vindex gnus-recent-mark
5848 Articles that according to the server haven't been shown to the user
5849 before are marked with a @samp{N} in the second column
5850 (@code{gnus-recent-mark}). Note that not all servers support this
5851 mark, in which case it simply never appears. Compare with
5852 @code{gnus-unseen-mark}.
5853
5854 @item
5855 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
5856 Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
5857 with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
5858 Compare with @code{gnus-recent-mark}.
5859
5860 @item
5861 @vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
5862 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
5863 downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
5864 @samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
5865 (The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
5866 use.)
5867
5868 @item
5869 @vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
5870 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
5871 not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
5872 are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
5873 articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
5874 @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
5875
5876 @item
5877 @vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
5878 The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
5879 automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
5880 download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
5881 explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
5882 (The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
5883 use.)
5884
5885 @item
5886 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
5887 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
5888 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
5889 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
5890 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
5891
5892 @item
5893 @vindex gnus-process-mark
5894 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
5895 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
5896 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
5897 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
5898 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
5899
5900 @end itemize
5901
5902 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
5903 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
5904 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
5905
5906 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
5907 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
5908 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
5909
5910
5911 @node Setting Marks
5912 @subsection Setting Marks
5913 @cindex setting marks
5914
5915 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
5916
5917 @table @kbd
5918 @item M c
5919 @itemx M-u
5920 @kindex M c (Summary)
5921 @kindex M-u (Summary)
5922 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
5923 @cindex mark as unread
5924 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
5925 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
5926 article as unread.
5927
5928 @item M t
5929 @itemx !
5930 @kindex ! (Summary)
5931 @kindex M t (Summary)
5932 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
5933 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
5934 @xref{Article Caching}.
5935
5936 @item M ?
5937 @itemx ?
5938 @kindex ? (Summary)
5939 @kindex M ? (Summary)
5940 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
5941 Mark the current article as dormant
5942 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5943
5944 @item M d
5945 @itemx d
5946 @kindex M d (Summary)
5947 @kindex d (Summary)
5948 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
5949 Mark the current article as read
5950 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
5951
5952 @item D
5953 @kindex D (Summary)
5954 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
5955 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
5956 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
5957
5958 @item M k
5959 @itemx k
5960 @kindex k (Summary)
5961 @kindex M k (Summary)
5962 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
5963 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
5964 and then select the next unread article
5965 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
5966
5967 @item M K
5968 @itemx C-k
5969 @kindex M K (Summary)
5970 @kindex C-k (Summary)
5971 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
5972 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
5973 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
5974
5975 @item M C
5976 @kindex M C (Summary)
5977 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
5978 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
5979 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
5980
5981 @item M C-c
5982 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
5983 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
5984 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
5985 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
5986
5987 @item M H
5988 @kindex M H (Summary)
5989 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
5990 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
5991 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
5992
5993 @item M h
5994 @kindex M h (Summary)
5995 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
5996 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
5997 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
5998
5999 @item C-w
6000 @kindex C-w (Summary)
6001 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6002 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6003 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
6004
6005 @item M V k
6006 @kindex M V k (Summary)
6007 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6008 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6009 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
6010
6011 @item M e
6012 @itemx E
6013 @kindex M e (Summary)
6014 @kindex E (Summary)
6015 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6016 Mark the current article as expirable
6017 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
6018
6019 @item M b
6020 @kindex M b (Summary)
6021 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6022 Set a bookmark in the current article
6023 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
6024
6025 @item M B
6026 @kindex M B (Summary)
6027 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6028 Remove the bookmark from the current article
6029 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
6030
6031 @item M V c
6032 @kindex M V c (Summary)
6033 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6034 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6035 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6036
6037 @item M V u
6038 @kindex M V u (Summary)
6039 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6040 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6041 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
6042
6043 @item M V m
6044 @kindex M V m (Summary)
6045 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6046 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6047 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6048 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6049 @end table
6050
6051 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6052 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6053 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6054 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6055 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6056 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6057 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6058 The default is @code{t}.
6059
6060
6061 @node Generic Marking Commands
6062 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
6063
6064 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
6065 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6066 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
6067 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
6068 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6069 well.
6070
6071 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6072 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6073 command should do.
6074
6075 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6076 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6077 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6078 to list in this manual.
6079
6080 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6081 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6082 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6083 article, you could say something like:
6084
6085 @lisp
6086 @group
6087 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6088 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6089 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6090 @end group
6091 @end lisp
6092
6093 @noindent
6094 or
6095
6096 @lisp
6097 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6098 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6099 @end lisp
6100
6101
6102 @node Setting Process Marks
6103 @subsection Setting Process Marks
6104 @cindex setting process marks
6105
6106 Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6107 used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6108 process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6109 articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6110 commands into the cache. For more information,
6111 @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
6112
6113 @table @kbd
6114
6115 @item M P p
6116 @itemx #
6117 @kindex # (Summary)
6118 @kindex M P p (Summary)
6119 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6120 Mark the current article with the process mark
6121 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6122 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
6123
6124 @item M P u
6125 @itemx M-#
6126 @kindex M P u (Summary)
6127 @kindex M-# (Summary)
6128 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6129 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
6130
6131 @item M P U
6132 @kindex M P U (Summary)
6133 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6134 Remove the process mark from all articles
6135 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
6136
6137 @item M P i
6138 @kindex M P i (Summary)
6139 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6140 Invert the list of process marked articles
6141 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
6142
6143 @item M P R
6144 @kindex M P R (Summary)
6145 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6146 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6147 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
6148
6149 @item M P G
6150 @kindex M P G (Summary)
6151 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6152 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6153 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
6154
6155 @item M P r
6156 @kindex M P r (Summary)
6157 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6158 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
6159
6160 @item M P g
6161 @kindex M P g (Summary)
6162 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6163 Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
6164
6165 @item M P t
6166 @kindex M P t (Summary)
6167 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6168 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6169 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6170
6171 @item M P T
6172 @kindex M P T (Summary)
6173 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6174 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6175 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6176
6177 @item M P v
6178 @kindex M P v (Summary)
6179 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6180 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6181 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
6182
6183 @item M P s
6184 @kindex M P s (Summary)
6185 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6186 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6187
6188 @item M P S
6189 @kindex M P S (Summary)
6190 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6191 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6192 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
6193
6194 @item M P a
6195 @kindex M P a (Summary)
6196 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6197 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6198
6199 @item M P b
6200 @kindex M P b (Summary)
6201 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6202 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6203 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6204
6205 @item M P k
6206 @kindex M P k (Summary)
6207 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6208 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6209 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6210
6211 @item M P y
6212 @kindex M P y (Summary)
6213 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6214 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6215 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
6216
6217 @item M P w
6218 @kindex M P w (Summary)
6219 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6220 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6221 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
6222
6223 @end table
6224
6225 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6226 set process marks based on article body contents.
6227
6228
6229 @node Limiting
6230 @section Limiting
6231 @cindex limiting
6232
6233 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6234 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6235 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6236 buffer.
6237
6238 All limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched
6239 from the servers. None of these commands query the server for
6240 additional articles.
6241
6242 @table @kbd
6243
6244 @item / /
6245 @itemx / s
6246 @kindex / / (Summary)
6247 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6248 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6249 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6250 matching articles.
6251
6252 @item / a
6253 @kindex / a (Summary)
6254 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6255 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6256 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6257 matching articles.
6258
6259 @item / x
6260 @kindex / x (Summary)
6261 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6262 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6263 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6264 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6265 matching articles.
6266
6267 @item / u
6268 @itemx x
6269 @kindex / u (Summary)
6270 @kindex x (Summary)
6271 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6272 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6273 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6274 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6275 dormant articles will also be excluded.
6276
6277 @item / m
6278 @kindex / m (Summary)
6279 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6280 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6281 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
6282
6283 @item / t
6284 @kindex / t (Summary)
6285 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6286 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6287 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6288 articles younger than that number of days.
6289
6290 @item / n
6291 @kindex / n (Summary)
6292 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6293 Limit the summary buffer to the current article
6294 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}). Uses the process/prefix
6295 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
6296
6297 @item / w
6298 @kindex / w (Summary)
6299 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6300 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6301 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6302 the stack.
6303
6304 @item / .
6305 @kindex / . (Summary)
6306 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6307 Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6308 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
6309
6310 @item / v
6311 @kindex / v (Summary)
6312 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6313 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6314 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6315
6316 @item / p
6317 @kindex / p (Summary)
6318 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6319 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6320 group parameter predicate
6321 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6322 Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
6323
6324 @item / E
6325 @itemx M S
6326 @kindex M S (Summary)
6327 @kindex / E (Summary)
6328 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6329 Include all expunged articles in the limit
6330 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6331
6332 @item / D
6333 @kindex / D (Summary)
6334 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6335 Include all dormant articles in the limit
6336 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6337
6338 @item / *
6339 @kindex / * (Summary)
6340 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6341 Include all cached articles in the limit
6342 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6343
6344 @item / d
6345 @kindex / d (Summary)
6346 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6347 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6348 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6349
6350 @item / M
6351 @kindex / M (Summary)
6352 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6353 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6354
6355 @item / T
6356 @kindex / T (Summary)
6357 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6358 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6359
6360 @item / c
6361 @kindex / c (Summary)
6362 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6363 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6364 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6365
6366 @item / C
6367 @kindex / C (Summary)
6368 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6369 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6370 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6371 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6372
6373 @item / N
6374 @kindex / N (Summary)
6375 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6376 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6377 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6378
6379 @item / o
6380 @kindex / o (Summary)
6381 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6382 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6383 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6384
6385 @end table
6386
6387
6388 @node Threading
6389 @section Threading
6390 @cindex threading
6391 @cindex article threading
6392
6393 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6394 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6395 hierarchical fashion.
6396
6397 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6398 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6399 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6400 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6401 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6402 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6403 @ref{Customizing Threading}.
6404
6405 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6406
6407 @table @dfn
6408 @item root
6409 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6410
6411 @item thread
6412 A tree-like article structure.
6413
6414 @item sub-thread
6415 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6416
6417 @item loose threads
6418 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6419 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6420 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6421 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6422 called loose threads.
6423
6424 @item thread gathering
6425 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6426
6427 @item sparse threads
6428 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6429 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6430
6431 @end table
6432
6433
6434 @menu
6435 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6436 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6437 @end menu
6438
6439
6440 @node Customizing Threading
6441 @subsection Customizing Threading
6442 @cindex customizing threading
6443
6444 @menu
6445 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6446 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6447 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6448 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6449 @end menu
6450
6451
6452 @node Loose Threads
6453 @subsubsection Loose Threads
6454 @cindex <
6455 @cindex >
6456 @cindex loose threads
6457
6458 @table @code
6459 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6460 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6461 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6462 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6463 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6464 read or killed the root in a previous session.
6465
6466 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6467 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6468 There are four possible values:
6469
6470 @iftex
6471 @iflatex
6472 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6473 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6474 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6475 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6476 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6477 }
6478 @end iflatex
6479 @end iftex
6480
6481 @cindex adopting articles
6482
6483 @table @code
6484
6485 @item adopt
6486 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6487 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6488 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6489 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6490
6491 @item dummy
6492 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6493 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6494 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6495 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6496 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6497 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6498 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6499 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6500 If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6501 ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
6502
6503 @item empty
6504 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6505 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6506 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6507 Buffer Format}).)
6508
6509 @item none
6510 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6511 display them after one another.
6512
6513 @item nil
6514 Don't gather loose threads.
6515 @end table
6516
6517 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6518 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6519 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6520 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6521 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6522 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6523 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6524 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6525 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6526 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6527 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6528
6529 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
6530 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6531 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6532 Matching}).
6533
6534 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6535 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6536 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6537 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6538 simplification is used.
6539
6540 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6541 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6542 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6543 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6544
6545 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6546 @lisp
6547 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6548 (concat
6549 "\\`\\[?\\("
6550 (mapconcat
6551 'identity
6552 '("looking"
6553 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6554 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6555 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6556 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6557 ;; ...
6558 )
6559 "\\|")
6560 "\\)\\s *\\("
6561 (mapconcat 'identity
6562 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6563 "\\|")
6564 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6565 @end lisp
6566
6567 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6568 subjects.
6569
6570 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6571 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6572 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6573 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6574 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6575 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6576
6577 Useful functions to put in this list include:
6578
6579 @table @code
6580 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6581 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6582 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6583
6584 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6585 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6586 Simplify fuzzily.
6587
6588 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6589 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6590 Remove excessive whitespace.
6591
6592 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6593 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6594 Remove all whitespace.
6595 @end table
6596
6597 You may also write your own functions, of course.
6598
6599
6600 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6601 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6602 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6603 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6604 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6605 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6606 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6607 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6608
6609 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6610 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6611 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6612 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6613 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6614 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6615 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6616 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6617 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6618 cholera:
6619
6620 @table @code
6621 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6622 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6623 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6624 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
6625
6626 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6627 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6628 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
6629 @end table
6630
6631 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
6632 something like:
6633
6634 @lisp
6635 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6636 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
6637 @end lisp
6638
6639 @end table
6640
6641
6642 @node Filling In Threads
6643 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
6644
6645 @table @code
6646 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
6647 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
6648 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
6649 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
6650 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
6651 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
6652 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
6653 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
6654 old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
6655 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
6656 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
6657 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
6658 do about that.
6659
6660 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
6661 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
6662 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
6663
6664 @item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6665 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6666 Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
6667 newsgroups.
6668
6669 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
6670 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
6671 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
6672 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
6673 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
6674 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
6675 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
6676 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
6677 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
6678 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
6679 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
6680 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
6681 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
6682 @code{nil} by default.
6683
6684 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
6685 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
6686 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
6687 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
6688 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
6689 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
6690 web-based groups, like the @code{nnultimate} groups.
6691
6692 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
6693 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
6694 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
6695
6696 @end table
6697
6698
6699 @node More Threading
6700 @subsubsection More Threading
6701
6702 @table @code
6703 @item gnus-show-threads
6704 @vindex gnus-show-threads
6705 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
6706 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
6707 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
6708 slower and more awkward.
6709
6710 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6711 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6712 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
6713 generated.
6714
6715 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
6716 Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
6717 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
6718
6719 Here's an example:
6720
6721 @lisp
6722 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6723 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
6724 gnus-article-unseen-p))
6725 @end lisp
6726
6727 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
6728 unread, but you get my drift.)
6729
6730
6731 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
6732 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
6733 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
6734 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
6735 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
6736 threads are expunged.
6737
6738 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
6739 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
6740 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
6741 will be hidden.
6742
6743 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6744 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6745 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
6746 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
6747 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
6748 result in a new thread.
6749
6750 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
6751 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
6752 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
6753 The default is 4.
6754
6755 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6756 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6757 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
6758 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
6759 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
6760 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
6761 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
6762 Setting this variable to an alternate value
6763 (e.g. @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
6764 appropriate hook (e.g. @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
6765 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
6766
6767 @end table
6768
6769
6770 @node Low-Level Threading
6771 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
6772
6773 @table @code
6774
6775 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
6776 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
6777 Hook run before parsing any headers.
6778
6779 @item gnus-alter-header-function
6780 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
6781 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
6782 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
6783 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
6784 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
6785 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
6786 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
6787 meaningful. Here's one example:
6788
6789 @lisp
6790 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
6791
6792 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
6793 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
6794 (when (string-match
6795 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
6796 (mail-header-set-id
6797 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
6798 header))))
6799 @end lisp
6800
6801 @end table
6802
6803
6804 @node Thread Commands
6805 @subsection Thread Commands
6806 @cindex thread commands
6807
6808 @table @kbd
6809
6810 @item T k
6811 @itemx C-M-k
6812 @kindex T k (Summary)
6813 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
6814 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
6815 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
6816 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
6817 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
6818 articles instead.
6819
6820 @item T l
6821 @itemx C-M-l
6822 @kindex T l (Summary)
6823 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
6824 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
6825 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
6826 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
6827
6828 @item T i
6829 @kindex T i (Summary)
6830 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
6831 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
6832 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
6833
6834 @item T #
6835 @kindex T # (Summary)
6836 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6837 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
6838 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6839
6840 @item T M-#
6841 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
6842 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6843 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
6844 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6845
6846 @item T T
6847 @kindex T T (Summary)
6848 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
6849 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
6850
6851 @item T s
6852 @kindex T s (Summary)
6853 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
6854 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
6855 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
6856
6857 @item T h
6858 @kindex T h (Summary)
6859 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
6860 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
6861
6862 @item T S
6863 @kindex T S (Summary)
6864 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
6865 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
6866
6867 @item T H
6868 @kindex T H (Summary)
6869 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
6870 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
6871
6872 @item T t
6873 @kindex T t (Summary)
6874 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
6875 Re-thread the current article's thread
6876 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
6877 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
6878
6879 @item T ^
6880 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
6881 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
6882 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
6883 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
6884
6885 @end table
6886
6887 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
6888 understand the numeric prefix.
6889
6890 @table @kbd
6891
6892 @item T n
6893 @kindex T n (Summary)
6894 @itemx C-M-f
6895 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
6896 @itemx M-down
6897 @kindex M-down (Summary)
6898 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
6899 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
6900
6901 @item T p
6902 @kindex T p (Summary)
6903 @itemx C-M-b
6904 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
6905 @itemx M-up
6906 @kindex M-up (Summary)
6907 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
6908 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
6909
6910 @item T d
6911 @kindex T d (Summary)
6912 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
6913 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
6914
6915 @item T u
6916 @kindex T u (Summary)
6917 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
6918 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
6919
6920 @item T o
6921 @kindex T o (Summary)
6922 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
6923 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
6924 @end table
6925
6926 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
6927 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
6928 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
6929 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
6930 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
6931 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
6932 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
6933 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
6934 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
6935 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
6936 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
6937 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
6938 Matching}).
6939
6940
6941 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
6942 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
6943
6944 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
6945 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
6946 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
6947 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
6948 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
6949 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
6950 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
6951 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
6952 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
6953 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
6954 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
6955 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
6956 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
6957 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
6958
6959 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
6960 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
6961 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
6962 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
6963 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
6964 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
6965 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
6966 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
6967
6968 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
6969 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
6970 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread.
6971
6972 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
6973 last function in the list. You should probably always include
6974 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
6975 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
6976 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
6977 ascending article order.
6978
6979 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
6980 by number, you could do something like:
6981
6982 @lisp
6983 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
6984 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
6985 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
6986 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
6987 @end lisp
6988
6989 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
6990 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
6991 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
6992 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
6993 which the articles arrived.
6994
6995 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
6996 say something like:
6997
6998 @lisp
6999 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7000 '((lambda (t1 t2)
7001 (not (gnus-thread-sort-by-number t1 t2)))
7002 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7003 @end lisp
7004
7005 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7006 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7007 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7008 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7009 tickles your fancy.
7010
7011 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7012 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7013 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7014 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7015 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7016 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7017 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7018 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7019 other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7020 variable. It is very similar to the
7021 @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7022 different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7023 predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7024 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7025 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7026 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7027 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
7028
7029 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7030 say something like:
7031
7032 @lisp
7033 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7034 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7035 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7036 @end lisp
7037
7038
7039
7040 @node Asynchronous Fetching
7041 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7042 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
7043 @cindex article pre-fetch
7044 @cindex pre-fetch
7045
7046 If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7047 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7048 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7049 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7050 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
7051
7052 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7053 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
7054
7055 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7056 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7057 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7058 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7059 connection is blocked.
7060
7061 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7062 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7063 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7064 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
7065
7066 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7067 the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7068 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7069 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7070 extra connection.
7071
7072 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7073 you really want to.
7074
7075 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
7076 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7077 happen automatically.
7078
7079 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7080 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7081 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7082 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7083 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7084 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7085 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7086
7087 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7088 @findex gnus-async-read-p
7089 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7090 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7091 variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7092 function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7093 to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-read-p}, which
7094 returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7095 article data structure as the only parameter.
7096
7097 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7098 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
7099
7100 @lisp
7101 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7102 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7103 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7104 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7105 100)))
7106
7107 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7108 @end lisp
7109
7110 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7111 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7112 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
7113
7114 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7115 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7116 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7117 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
7118
7119 @table @code
7120 @item read
7121 Remove articles when they are read.
7122
7123 @item exit
7124 Remove articles when exiting the group.
7125 @end table
7126
7127 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
7128
7129 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7130 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7131 @c from the next group.
7132
7133
7134 @node Article Caching
7135 @section Article Caching
7136 @cindex article caching
7137 @cindex caching
7138
7139 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7140 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7141 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7142 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7143 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
7144
7145 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
7146
7147 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7148 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
7149 @vindex gnus-use-cache
7150 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7151 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7152 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7153 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7154 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
7155
7156 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7157 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7158 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7159 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7160 as dormant, and don't worry.
7161
7162 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
7163
7164 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7165 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7166 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7167 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7168 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7169 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7170 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7171 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7172 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7173 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
7174
7175 @findex gnus-jog-cache
7176 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7177 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7178 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7179 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7180 command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7181 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7182 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7183 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7184 not then be downloaded by this command.
7185
7186 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7187 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7188 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7189 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7190 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7191 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
7192
7193 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7194 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7195 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7196 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7197 variables, the group is not cached.
7198
7199 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7200 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7201 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7202 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7203 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7204 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7205 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7206 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7207 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7208 file.
7209
7210 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7211 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7212 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7213 where, isn't that cool?
7214
7215 @node Persistent Articles
7216 @section Persistent Articles
7217 @cindex persistent articles
7218
7219 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7220 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7221 useful in my opinion.
7222
7223 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7224 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7225 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7226 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7227 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7228 the expiry going on at the news server.
7229
7230 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7231 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7232 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
7233
7234 @table @kbd
7235
7236 @item *
7237 @kindex * (Summary)
7238 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7239 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7240
7241 @item M-*
7242 @kindex M-* (Summary)
7243 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7244 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7245 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7246 article.
7247 @end table
7248
7249 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7250
7251 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7252 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7253 interested in persistent articles:
7254
7255 @lisp
7256 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
7257 @end lisp
7258
7259
7260 @node Article Backlog
7261 @section Article Backlog
7262 @cindex backlog
7263 @cindex article backlog
7264
7265 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7266 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7267 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7268 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7269 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7270 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7271 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7272 increase memory usage some.
7273
7274 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7275 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7276 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7277 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7278 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7279 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7280 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
7281
7282 The default value is 20.
7283
7284
7285 @node Saving Articles
7286 @section Saving Articles
7287 @cindex saving articles
7288
7289 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7290 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7291 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7292 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7293 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
7294
7295 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7296 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7297 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
7298
7299 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7300 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7301 unwanted headers before saving the article.
7302
7303 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
7304 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7305 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7306 deleted before saving.
7307
7308 @table @kbd
7309
7310 @item O o
7311 @itemx o
7312 @kindex O o (Summary)
7313 @kindex o (Summary)
7314 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
7315 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7316 Save the current article using the default article saver
7317 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7318
7319 @item O m
7320 @kindex O m (Summary)
7321 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7322 Save the current article in mail format
7323 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7324
7325 @item O r
7326 @kindex O r (Summary)
7327 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7328 Save the current article in Rmail format
7329 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}).
7330
7331 @item O f
7332 @kindex O f (Summary)
7333 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7334 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7335 Save the current article in plain file format
7336 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7337
7338 @item O F
7339 @kindex O F (Summary)
7340 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7341 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7342 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7343
7344 @item O b
7345 @kindex O b (Summary)
7346 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7347 Save the current article body in plain file format
7348 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7349
7350 @item O h
7351 @kindex O h (Summary)
7352 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7353 Save the current article in mh folder format
7354 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7355
7356 @item O v
7357 @kindex O v (Summary)
7358 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7359 Save the current article in a VM folder
7360 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7361
7362 @item O p
7363 @itemx |
7364 @kindex O p (Summary)
7365 @kindex | (Summary)
7366 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7367 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7368 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7369 If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7370 complete headers in the piped output.
7371
7372 @item O P
7373 @kindex O P (Summary)
7374 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7375 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7376 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7377 external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7378 Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7379 variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7380 (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7381
7382 @end table
7383
7384 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7385 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7386 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7387 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7388 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7389 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7390 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7391 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7392 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7393 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7394 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7395 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7396 files.
7397
7398
7399 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7400 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7401 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the six ready-made
7402 functions below, or you can create your own.
7403
7404 @table @code
7405
7406 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7407 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7408 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7409 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7410 This is the default format, @dfn{Babyl}. Uses the function in the
7411 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7412 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7413
7414 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7415 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7416 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7417 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7418 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7419 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7420
7421 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7422 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7423 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
7424 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7425 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7426 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7427 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7428
7429 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7430 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7431 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7432 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7433 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7434 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7435
7436 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7437 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7438 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7439 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7440 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7441
7442 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7443 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7444 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
7445 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7446 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7447 @cindex rcvstore
7448 @cindex MH folders
7449 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7450 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7451 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7452 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7453 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7454
7455 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7456 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7457 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7458 reader to use this setting.
7459 @end table
7460
7461 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7462 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7463 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7464 @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7465 default.
7466
7467 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7468 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7469 available functions that generate names:
7470
7471 @table @code
7472
7473 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7474 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
7475 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7476
7477 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
7478 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7479 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7480
7481 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
7482 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
7483 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7484
7485 @item gnus-plain-save-name
7486 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7487 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7488
7489 @item gnus-sender-save-name
7490 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
7491 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
7492 @end table
7493
7494 @vindex gnus-split-methods
7495 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
7496 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
7497 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
7498 related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
7499 like:
7500
7501 @lisp
7502 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
7503 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
7504 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
7505 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
7506 @end lisp
7507
7508 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
7509 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
7510 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
7511 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
7512 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
7513 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
7514 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
7515 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
7516 called returns a string or a list of strings.
7517
7518 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
7519 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
7520 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
7521 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
7522
7523 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
7524 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
7525 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
7526 name.
7527
7528 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
7529 lots of mail groups called things like
7530 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
7531 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
7532 following will do just that:
7533
7534 @lisp
7535 (defun my-save-name (group)
7536 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
7537 (substring group (match-end 0))))
7538
7539 (setq gnus-split-methods
7540 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
7541 (my-save-name)))
7542 @end lisp
7543
7544
7545 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7546 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
7547 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
7548 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
7549 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
7550 all the files in the top level directory
7551 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
7552 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
7553 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
7554 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
7555
7556 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
7557 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
7558 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
7559 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
7560 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
7561 for kill files.
7562
7563 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
7564 a spool, you could
7565
7566 @lisp
7567 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
7568 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
7569 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
7570 @end lisp
7571
7572 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
7573 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
7574 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
7575 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
7576
7577
7578 @node Decoding Articles
7579 @section Decoding Articles
7580 @cindex decoding articles
7581
7582 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
7583 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
7584
7585 @menu
7586 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
7587 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
7588 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
7589 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
7590 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
7591 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
7592 @end menu
7593
7594 @cindex series
7595 @cindex article series
7596 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
7597 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
7598 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
7599 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
7600 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
7601
7602 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
7603 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
7604 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
7605
7606 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
7607 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
7608 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
7609
7610 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
7611 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
7612 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
7613
7614
7615 @node Uuencoded Articles
7616 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
7617 @cindex uudecode
7618 @cindex uuencoded articles
7619
7620 @table @kbd
7621
7622 @item X u
7623 @kindex X u (Summary)
7624 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
7625 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
7626 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
7627
7628 @item X U
7629 @kindex X U (Summary)
7630 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
7631 Uudecodes and saves the current series
7632 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7633
7634 @item X v u
7635 @kindex X v u (Summary)
7636 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
7637 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
7638
7639 @item X v U
7640 @kindex X v U (Summary)
7641 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
7642 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
7643 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
7644
7645 @end table
7646
7647 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
7648 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
7649 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
7650 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
7651 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7652
7653 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
7654 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
7655 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
7656 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
7657 @kbd{X u}.
7658
7659 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
7660 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
7661 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
7662 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
7663 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
7664 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
7665 off.
7666
7667
7668 @node Shell Archives
7669 @subsection Shell Archives
7670 @cindex unshar
7671 @cindex shell archives
7672 @cindex shared articles
7673
7674 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
7675 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
7676 some commands to deal with these:
7677
7678 @table @kbd
7679
7680 @item X s
7681 @kindex X s (Summary)
7682 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
7683 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
7684
7685 @item X S
7686 @kindex X S (Summary)
7687 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
7688 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
7689
7690 @item X v s
7691 @kindex X v s (Summary)
7692 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
7693 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
7694
7695 @item X v S
7696 @kindex X v S (Summary)
7697 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
7698 Unshars, views and saves the current series
7699 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
7700 @end table
7701
7702
7703 @node PostScript Files
7704 @subsection PostScript Files
7705 @cindex PostScript
7706
7707 @table @kbd
7708
7709 @item X p
7710 @kindex X p (Summary)
7711 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
7712 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
7713
7714 @item X P
7715 @kindex X P (Summary)
7716 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
7717 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
7718 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
7719
7720 @item X v p
7721 @kindex X v p (Summary)
7722 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
7723 View the current PostScript series
7724 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
7725
7726 @item X v P
7727 @kindex X v P (Summary)
7728 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
7729 View and save the current PostScript series
7730 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
7731 @end table
7732
7733
7734 @node Other Files
7735 @subsection Other Files
7736
7737 @table @kbd
7738 @item X o
7739 @kindex X o (Summary)
7740 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
7741 Save the current series
7742 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
7743
7744 @item X b
7745 @kindex X b (Summary)
7746 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
7747 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
7748 doesn't really work yet.
7749 @end table
7750
7751
7752 @node Decoding Variables
7753 @subsection Decoding Variables
7754
7755 Adjective, not verb.
7756
7757 @menu
7758 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
7759 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
7760 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
7761 @end menu
7762
7763
7764 @node Rule Variables
7765 @subsubsection Rule Variables
7766 @cindex rule variables
7767
7768 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
7769 variables are of the form
7770
7771 @lisp
7772 (list '(regexp1 command2)
7773 '(regexp2 command2)
7774 ...)
7775 @end lisp
7776
7777 @table @code
7778
7779 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7780 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7781 @cindex sox
7782 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
7783 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
7784 say something like:
7785 @lisp
7786 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7787 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
7788 @end lisp
7789
7790 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7791 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7792 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
7793 user and default view rules.
7794
7795 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7796 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7797 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
7798 archives.
7799 @end table
7800
7801
7802 @node Other Decode Variables
7803 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
7804
7805 @table @code
7806 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7807
7808 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7809 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
7810 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
7811 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
7812 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
7813
7814 @table @code
7815
7816 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
7817 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
7818 View the file.
7819
7820 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
7821 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
7822 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
7823 @end table
7824
7825 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7826 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7827 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
7828 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
7829 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
7830 time.
7831
7832 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7833 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7834 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
7835
7836 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7837 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7838 Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
7839 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
7840 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
7841 kludgey.
7842
7843 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7844 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7845 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
7846
7847 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7848 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7849 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
7850 looking for files to display.
7851
7852 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
7853 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
7854 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
7855 after viewing it.
7856
7857 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7858 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7859 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
7860 rules.
7861
7862 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7863 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7864 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
7865 unpacking commands.
7866
7867 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7868 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7869 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
7870 from articles.
7871
7872 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7873 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7874 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
7875 decoded articles as unread.
7876
7877 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7878 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7879 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
7880 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
7881
7882 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
7883 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
7884 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
7885
7886 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
7887 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
7888 @cindex metamail
7889 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
7890 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
7891 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
7892 @code{metamail} for viewing.
7893
7894 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
7895 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
7896 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
7897 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
7898 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
7899 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
7900 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
7901 simply dropped them.
7902
7903 @end table
7904
7905
7906 @node Uuencoding and Posting
7907 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
7908
7909 @table @code
7910
7911 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
7912 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
7913 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
7914 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
7915 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
7916 for you when you post the article.
7917
7918 @item gnus-uu-post-length
7919 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
7920 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
7921 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
7922
7923 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
7924 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
7925 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
7926 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
7927 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
7928 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
7929 think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
7930
7931 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
7932 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
7933 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
7934 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
7935 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
7936 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
7937 Default is @code{t}.
7938
7939 @end table
7940
7941
7942 @node Viewing Files
7943 @subsection Viewing Files
7944 @cindex viewing files
7945 @cindex pseudo-articles
7946
7947 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
7948 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
7949 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
7950 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
7951 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
7952 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
7953 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
7954
7955 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
7956 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
7957 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
7958 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
7959
7960 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
7961 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
7962 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
7963
7964 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
7965 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
7966 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
7967 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
7968 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
7969
7970 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
7971 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
7972 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
7973 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
7974 a list of parameters to that command.
7975
7976 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
7977 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
7978 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
7979
7980 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
7981 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
7982 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
7983
7984
7985 @node Article Treatment
7986 @section Article Treatment
7987
7988 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
7989 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
7990 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
7991 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
7992 these articles easier.
7993
7994 @menu
7995 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
7996 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
7997 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
7998 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
7999 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8000 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8001 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8002 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8003 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
8004 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8005 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8006 @end menu
8007
8008
8009 @node Article Highlighting
8010 @subsection Article Highlighting
8011 @cindex highlighting
8012
8013 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8014 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
8015
8016 @table @kbd
8017
8018 @item W H a
8019 @kindex W H a (Summary)
8020 @findex gnus-article-highlight
8021 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8022 Do much highlighting of the current article
8023 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8024 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
8025
8026 @item W H h
8027 @kindex W H h (Summary)
8028 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8029 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8030 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8031 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8032 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8033 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8034 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8035 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8036 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8037 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8038 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
8039
8040 @item W H c
8041 @kindex W H c (Summary)
8042 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8043 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
8044
8045 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
8046
8047 @table @code
8048 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8049
8050 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8051 If the article size if bigger than this variable (which is 25000 by
8052 default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
8053
8054 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8055 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8056 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
8057
8058 @item gnus-cite-face-list
8059 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8060 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8061 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8062 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8063 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
8064
8065 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
8066 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8067 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
8068
8069 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8070 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8071 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
8072
8073 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8074 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8075 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8076 that it's a citation.
8077
8078 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8079 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8080 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
8081
8082 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8083 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8084 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
8085
8086 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8087 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8088 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8089 cited text belonging to the attribution.
8090
8091 @item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8092 @vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8093 If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8094 beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8095 in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8096 is @code{t}.
8097
8098 @end table
8099
8100
8101 @item W H s
8102 @kindex W H s (Summary)
8103 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
8104 @vindex gnus-signature-face
8105 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8106 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8107 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8108 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8109 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8110 default.
8111
8112 @end table
8113
8114 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
8115
8116
8117 @node Article Fontisizing
8118 @subsection Article Fontisizing
8119 @cindex emphasis
8120 @cindex article emphasis
8121
8122 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
8123 @kindex W e (Summary)
8124 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8125 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8126 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8127 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
8128
8129 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8130 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8131 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8132 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8133 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8134 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8135 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8136 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8137 highlighting.
8138
8139 @lisp
8140 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8141 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8142 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
8143 @end lisp
8144
8145 @cindex slash
8146 @cindex asterisk
8147 @cindex underline
8148 @cindex /
8149 @cindex *
8150
8151 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8152 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8153 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8154 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8155 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8156 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8157 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8158 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8159 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8160 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8161 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8162 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8163 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
8164
8165 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8166 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8167 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8168 say something like:
8169
8170 @lisp
8171 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
8172 @end lisp
8173
8174 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
8175
8176 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8177 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8178 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8179 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
8180
8181 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
8182
8183
8184 @node Article Hiding
8185 @subsection Article Hiding
8186 @cindex article hiding
8187
8188 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8189 too much cruft in most articles.
8190
8191 @table @kbd
8192
8193 @item W W a
8194 @kindex W W a (Summary)
8195 @findex gnus-article-hide
8196 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8197 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8198 headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
8199
8200 @item W W h
8201 @kindex W W h (Summary)
8202 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8203 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8204 Headers}.
8205
8206 @item W W b
8207 @kindex W W b (Summary)
8208 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8209 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8210 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
8211
8212 @item W W s
8213 @kindex W W s (Summary)
8214 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8215 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8216 Signature}.
8217
8218 @item W W l
8219 @kindex W W l (Summary)
8220 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8221 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8222 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8223 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8224 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8225 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8226 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
8227
8228 @table @code
8229
8230 @item gnus-list-identifiers
8231 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8232 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8233 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
8234
8235 @end table
8236
8237 @item W W P
8238 @kindex W W P (Summary)
8239 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8240 Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8241 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
8242
8243 @item W W B
8244 @kindex W W B (Summary)
8245 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8246 @vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8247 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8248 @cindex banner
8249 @cindex OneList
8250 @cindex stripping advertisements
8251 @cindex advertisements
8252 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8253 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8254 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8255 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8256 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8257 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8258 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8259 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8260 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8261 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8262 used.
8263
8264 Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8265 the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8266 @code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
8267
8268 @table @code
8269
8270 @item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8271 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8272 Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8273 @code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8274 matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8275 symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8276 a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8277 address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8278 sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8279 banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8280 sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
8281
8282 @lisp
8283 ("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8284 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8285 @end lisp
8286
8287 @end table
8288
8289 @item W W c
8290 @kindex W W c (Summary)
8291 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8292 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8293 customizing the hiding:
8294
8295 @table @code
8296
8297 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8298 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8299 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8300 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8301 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8302 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8303 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8304 specs are valid:
8305
8306 @table @samp
8307 @item b
8308 Starting point of the hidden text.
8309 @item e
8310 Ending point of the hidden text.
8311 @item l
8312 Number of characters in the hidden region.
8313 @item n
8314 Number of lines of hidden text.
8315 @end table
8316
8317 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8318 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8319 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8320 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8321 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
8322
8323 @end table
8324
8325 @item W W C-c
8326 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8327 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
8328
8329 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8330 following two variables:
8331
8332 @table @code
8333 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8334 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8335 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
8336 50), hide the cited text.
8337
8338 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8339 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8340 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8341 is hidden.
8342 @end table
8343
8344 @item W W C
8345 @kindex W W C (Summary)
8346 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8347 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8348 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8349 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8350 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8351
8352 @end table
8353
8354 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8355 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8356 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8357
8358 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8359 citation customization.
8360
8361 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8362 automatically.
8363
8364
8365 @node Article Washing
8366 @subsection Article Washing
8367 @cindex washing
8368 @cindex article washing
8369
8370 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8371 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8372
8373 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8374 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8375 Cleaner, perhaps.
8376
8377 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8378 articles by default.
8379
8380 @table @kbd
8381
8382 @item C-u g
8383 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8384 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8385 the server.
8386
8387 @item g
8388 Force redisplaying of the current article
8389 (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8390 If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8391 interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8392 (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8393
8394 @item W l
8395 @kindex W l (Summary)
8396 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8397 Remove page breaks from the current article
8398 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8399 delimiters.
8400
8401 @item W r
8402 @kindex W r (Summary)
8403 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8404 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8405 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8406 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8407 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8408 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8409
8410 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8411 positions in the alphabet, e. g. @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8412 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8413 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8414
8415 @item W m
8416 @kindex W m (Summary)
8417 @findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8418 Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
8419
8420 @item W t
8421 @item t
8422 @kindex W t (Summary)
8423 @kindex t (Summary)
8424 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8425 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8426 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8427
8428 @item W v
8429 @kindex W v (Summary)
8430 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8431 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8432 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8433
8434 @item W o
8435 @kindex W o (Summary)
8436 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8437 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8438
8439 @item W d
8440 @kindex W d (Summary)
8441 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8442 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8443 @cindex Smartquotes
8444 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8445 @cindex Latin 1
8446 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8447 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8448 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8449 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8450 interactively.
8451
8452 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
8453 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
8454 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
8455 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
8456
8457 @item W Y f
8458 @kindex W Y f (Summary)
8459 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
8460 @cindex Outlook Express
8461 Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
8462 unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
8463 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
8464
8465 @item W Y u
8466 @kindex W Y u (Summary)
8467 @findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
8468 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
8469 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
8470 Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
8471 what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
8472 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
8473 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
8474 maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
8475 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
8476
8477 @item W Y a
8478 @kindex W Y a (Summary)
8479 @findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
8480 Repair a broken attribution line.@*
8481 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
8482
8483 @item W Y c
8484 @kindex W Y c (Summary)
8485 @findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
8486 Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
8487 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
8488
8489 @item W w
8490 @kindex W w (Summary)
8491 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
8492 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
8493
8494 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
8495 when filling.
8496
8497 @item W Q
8498 @kindex W Q (Summary)
8499 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
8500 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
8501
8502 @item W C
8503 @kindex W C (Summary)
8504 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
8505 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
8506 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
8507
8508 @item W c
8509 @kindex W c (Summary)
8510 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
8511 Translate CRLF pairs (i. e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
8512 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
8513 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
8514 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
8515
8516 @item W q
8517 @kindex W q (Summary)
8518 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
8519 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
8520 Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
8521 sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
8522 makes strings like @samp{déjà vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu}, which
8523 doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually done
8524 automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8525 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8526 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8527
8528 @item W 6
8529 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
8530 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
8531 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
8532 one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
8533 non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
8534 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8535 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8536 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8537
8538 @item W Z
8539 @kindex W Z (Summary)
8540 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
8541 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
8542 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
8543 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
8544
8545 @item W u
8546 @kindex W u (Summary)
8547 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
8548 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
8549 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
8550 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
8551 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
8552
8553 @item W h
8554 @kindex W h (Summary)
8555 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
8556 Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
8557 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8558 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
8559
8560 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8561
8562 @vindex gnus-article-wash-function
8563 The default is to use the function specified by
8564 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
8565 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
8566 @acronym{HTML}, but this is controlled by the
8567 @code{gnus-article-wash-function} variable. Pre-defined functions you
8568 can use include:
8569
8570 @table @code
8571 @item w3
8572 Use Emacs/w3.
8573
8574 @item w3m
8575 Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
8576
8577 @item links
8578 Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
8579
8580 @item lynx
8581 Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
8582
8583 @item html2text
8584 Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
8585
8586 @end table
8587
8588 @item W b
8589 @kindex W b (Summary)
8590 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
8591 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
8592 @xref{Article Buttons}.
8593
8594 @item W B
8595 @kindex W B (Summary)
8596 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
8597 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
8598 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
8599
8600 @item W p
8601 @kindex W p (Summary)
8602 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
8603 Verify a signed control message
8604 (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
8605 @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
8606 hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
8607 the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
8608 message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
8609 available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
8610
8611 @item W s
8612 @kindex W s (Summary)
8613 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
8614 Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
8615 @acronym{S/MIME}) message
8616 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
8617
8618 @item W a
8619 @kindex W a (Summary)
8620 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
8621 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
8622 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
8623
8624 @item W E l
8625 @kindex W E l (Summary)
8626 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
8627 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
8628 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
8629
8630 @item W E m
8631 @kindex W E m (Summary)
8632 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
8633 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
8634 lines with a single empty line.
8635 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
8636
8637 @item W E t
8638 @kindex W E t (Summary)
8639 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
8640 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
8641 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
8642
8643 @item W E a
8644 @kindex W E a (Summary)
8645 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
8646 Do all the three commands above
8647 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
8648
8649 @item W E A
8650 @kindex W E A (Summary)
8651 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
8652 Remove all blank lines
8653 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
8654
8655 @item W E s
8656 @kindex W E s (Summary)
8657 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
8658 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
8659 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
8660
8661 @item W E e
8662 @kindex W E e (Summary)
8663 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
8664 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
8665 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
8666
8667 @end table
8668
8669 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
8670
8671
8672 @node Article Header
8673 @subsection Article Header
8674
8675 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
8676
8677 @table @kbd
8678
8679 @item W G u
8680 @kindex W G u (Summary)
8681 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
8682 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
8683
8684 @item W G n
8685 @kindex W G n (Summary)
8686 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
8687 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
8688 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
8689
8690 @item W G f
8691 @kindex W G f (Summary)
8692 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
8693 Fold all the message headers
8694 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
8695
8696 @item W E w
8697 @kindex W E w (Summary)
8698 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
8699 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
8700 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
8701
8702 @end table
8703
8704
8705 @node Article Buttons
8706 @subsection Article Buttons
8707 @cindex buttons
8708
8709 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
8710 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
8711 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
8712 button on these references.
8713
8714 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8715 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
8716 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
8717 Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
8718 one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
8719
8720 @table @code
8721
8722 @item gnus-button-alist
8723 @vindex gnus-button-alist
8724 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
8725
8726 @lisp
8727 (@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8728 @end lisp
8729
8730 @table @var
8731
8732 @item regexp
8733 All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
8734 considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
8735 embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
8736 variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
8737 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
8738
8739 @item button-par
8740 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
8741 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
8742 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
8743
8744 @item use-p
8745 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
8746 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
8747 avoid false matches. Often variables named
8748 @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
8749 Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
8750
8751 @c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
8752
8753 @item function
8754 This function will be called when you click on this button.
8755
8756 @item data-par
8757 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
8758 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
8759
8760 @end table
8761
8762 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
8763
8764 @lisp
8765 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
8766 @end lisp
8767
8768 @item gnus-header-button-alist
8769 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
8770 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
8771 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
8772 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
8773
8774 @lisp
8775 (@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8776 @end lisp
8777
8778 @var{header} is a regular expression.
8779 @end table
8780
8781 @subsubsection Related variables and functions
8782
8783 @table @code
8784 @item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
8785 @xref{Article Button Levels}.
8786
8787 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
8788
8789 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
8790 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
8791 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
8792 default values of the variables above.
8793
8794 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
8795
8796 @item gnus-button-man-handler
8797 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8798 The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
8799 argument with a string naming the man page.
8800
8801 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
8802
8803 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8804 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8805 Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
8806
8807 @item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8808 @vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8809 This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
8810 @samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
8811 message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
8812 @code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
8813 a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
8814 @code{ask}, always query the user what do do. If it is a function, this
8815 function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
8816 function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
8817 @code{ask}. The default value is the function
8818 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8819
8820 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8821 @findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8822 Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
8823 address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
8824 it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
8825 string is invalid.
8826
8827 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8828 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8829 An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
8830 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8831
8832 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-tex-level
8833
8834 @item gnus-button-ctan-handler
8835 @findex gnus-button-ctan-handler
8836 The function to use for displaying CTAN links. It must take one
8837 argument, the string naming the URL.
8838
8839 @item gnus-ctan-url
8840 @vindex gnus-ctan-url
8841 Top directory of a CTAN (Comprehensive TeX Archive Network) archive used
8842 by @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler}.
8843
8844 @c Misc stuff
8845
8846 @item gnus-article-button-face
8847 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
8848 Face used on buttons.
8849
8850 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
8851 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
8852 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
8853
8854 @end table
8855
8856 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
8857
8858
8859 @node Article Button Levels
8860 @subsection Article button levels
8861 @cindex button levels
8862 The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
8863 the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
8864 buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
8865 already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
8866 more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
8867 you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
8868 specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
8869 variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
8870
8871 @lisp
8872 ;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
8873 (setq gnus-parameters
8874 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
8875 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
8876 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
8877 @end lisp
8878
8879 @table @code
8880
8881 @item gnus-button-browse-level
8882 @vindex gnus-button-browse-level
8883 Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
8884 news URLs. Related variables and functions include
8885 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
8886 @code{browse-url-browser-function}.
8887
8888 @item gnus-button-emacs-level
8889 @vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
8890 Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
8891 @code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
8892 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
8893 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
8894 @code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
8895 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
8896 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
8897 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
8898 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
8899 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
8900 @code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
8901
8902 @item gnus-button-man-level
8903 @vindex gnus-button-man-level
8904 Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
8905 See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
8906
8907 @item gnus-button-message-level
8908 @vindex gnus-button-message-level
8909 Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
8910 Related variables and functions include
8911 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
8912 @code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
8913 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
8914 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
8915
8916 @item gnus-button-tex-level
8917 @vindex gnus-button-tex-level
8918 Controls the display of references to @TeX{} or LaTeX stuff, e.g. for CTAN
8919 URLs. See the variables @code{gnus-ctan-url},
8920 @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler},
8921 @code{gnus-button-ctan-directory-regexp}, and
8922 @code{gnus-button-handle-ctan-bogus-regexp}.
8923
8924 @end table
8925
8926
8927 @node Article Date
8928 @subsection Article Date
8929
8930 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
8931 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
8932 when the article was sent.
8933
8934 @table @kbd
8935
8936 @item W T u
8937 @kindex W T u (Summary)
8938 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
8939 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
8940 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
8941
8942 @item W T i
8943 @kindex W T i (Summary)
8944 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
8945 @cindex ISO 8601
8946 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
8947 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
8948
8949 @item W T l
8950 @kindex W T l (Summary)
8951 @findex gnus-article-date-local
8952 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
8953
8954 @item W T p
8955 @kindex W T p (Summary)
8956 @findex gnus-article-date-english
8957 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
8958 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
8959
8960 @item W T s
8961 @kindex W T s (Summary)
8962 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
8963 @findex gnus-article-date-user
8964 @findex format-time-string
8965 Display the date using a user-defined format
8966 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
8967 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
8968 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
8969 for a list of possible format specs.
8970
8971 @item W T e
8972 @kindex W T e (Summary)
8973 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
8974 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
8975 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
8976 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
8977 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
8978
8979 @example
8980 X-Sent: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
8981 @end example
8982
8983 @vindex gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header
8984 The value of @code{gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header} determines
8985 whether this header will just be added below the old Date one, or will
8986 replace it.
8987
8988 An advantage of using Gnus to read mail is that it converts simple bugs
8989 into wonderful absurdities.
8990
8991 If you want to have this line updated continually, you can put
8992
8993 @lisp
8994 (gnus-start-date-timer)
8995 @end lisp
8996
8997 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, or you can run it off of some hook. If
8998 you want to stop the timer, you can use the @code{gnus-stop-date-timer}
8999 command.
9000
9001 @item W T o
9002 @kindex W T o (Summary)
9003 @findex gnus-article-date-original
9004 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9005 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9006 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9007 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9008 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
9009
9010 @end table
9011
9012 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9013 preferred format automatically.
9014
9015
9016 @node Article Display
9017 @subsection Article Display
9018 @cindex picons
9019 @cindex x-face
9020 @cindex smileys
9021
9022 These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9023 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
9024
9025 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9026 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
9027
9028 @code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9029 headers (@pxref{Face}).
9030
9031 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9032 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
9033
9034 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9035 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
9036
9037 All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9038 they'll be removed.
9039
9040 @table @kbd
9041 @item W D x
9042 @kindex W D x (Summary)
9043 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9044 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9045 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
9046
9047 @item W D d
9048 @kindex W D d (Summary)
9049 @findex gnus-article-display-face
9050 Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9051 (@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
9052
9053 @item W D s
9054 @kindex W D s (Summary)
9055 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
9056 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
9057
9058 @item W D f
9059 @kindex W D f (Summary)
9060 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9061 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
9062
9063 @item W D m
9064 @kindex W D m (Summary)
9065 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
9066 Piconify all mail headers (i. e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9067 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
9068
9069 @item W D n
9070 @kindex W D n (Summary)
9071 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
9072 Piconify all news headers (i. e., @code{Newsgroups} and
9073 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
9074
9075 @item W D D
9076 @kindex W D D (Summary)
9077 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
9078 Remove all images from the article buffer
9079 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
9080
9081 @end table
9082
9083
9084
9085 @node Article Signature
9086 @subsection Article Signature
9087 @cindex signatures
9088 @cindex article signature
9089
9090 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
9091 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9092 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9093 that says what is to be considered a signature is
9094 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9095 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9096 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9097 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9098 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
9099
9100 @lisp
9101 (setq gnus-signature-separator
9102 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9103 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9104 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9105 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9106 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9107 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9108 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9109 @end lisp
9110
9111 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9112 positives.
9113
9114 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
9115 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9116 signature when displaying articles.
9117
9118 @enumerate
9119 @item
9120 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9121 that integer.
9122 @item
9123 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9124 than that number.
9125 @item
9126 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9127 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9128 @item
9129 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9130 in question is not a signature.
9131 @end enumerate
9132
9133 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9134 listed above. Here's an example:
9135
9136 @lisp
9137 (setq gnus-signature-limit
9138 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9139 @end lisp
9140
9141 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9142 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9143 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9144 signature after all.
9145
9146
9147 @node Article Miscellanea
9148 @subsection Article Miscellanea
9149
9150 @table @kbd
9151 @item A t
9152 @kindex A t (Summary)
9153 @findex gnus-article-babel
9154 Translate the article from one language to another
9155 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
9156
9157 @end table
9158
9159
9160 @node MIME Commands
9161 @section MIME Commands
9162 @cindex MIME decoding
9163 @cindex attachments
9164 @cindex viewing attachments
9165
9166 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9167 instance, @kbd{3 b} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
9168
9169 @table @kbd
9170 @item b
9171 @itemx K v
9172 @kindex b (Summary)
9173 @kindex K v (Summary)
9174 View the @acronym{MIME} part.
9175
9176 @item K o
9177 @kindex K o (Summary)
9178 Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
9179
9180 @item K c
9181 @kindex K c (Summary)
9182 Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
9183
9184 @item K e
9185 @kindex K e (Summary)
9186 View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
9187
9188 @item K i
9189 @kindex K i (Summary)
9190 View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
9191
9192 @item K |
9193 @kindex K | (Summary)
9194 Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9195 @end table
9196
9197 The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9198 the same manner:
9199
9200 @table @kbd
9201 @item K b
9202 @kindex K b (Summary)
9203 Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9204 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9205 parts.
9206
9207 @item K m
9208 @kindex K m (Summary)
9209 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9210 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9211 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9212 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9213 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
9214
9215 @item X m
9216 @kindex X m (Summary)
9217 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9218 Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9219 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9220 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9221
9222 @item M-t
9223 @kindex M-t (Summary)
9224 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9225 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9226 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
9227
9228 @item W M w
9229 @kindex W M w (Summary)
9230 @findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9231 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9232 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
9233
9234 @item W M c
9235 @kindex W M c (Summary)
9236 @findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9237 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9238 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
9239
9240 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9241 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9242 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9243 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9244 include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9245 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9246
9247 @item W M v
9248 @kindex W M v (Summary)
9249 @findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9250 View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9251 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
9252
9253 @end table
9254
9255 Relevant variables:
9256
9257 @table @code
9258 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9259 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9260 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9261 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9262 @code{nil}.
9263
9264 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
9265
9266 @lisp
9267 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9268 '("text/x-vcard"))
9269 @end lisp
9270
9271 @item gnus-article-loose-mime
9272 @vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9273 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9274 before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9275 when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9276 default is @code{nil}.
9277
9278 @item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9279 @vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9280 There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9281 is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9282 this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9283 see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9284 Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}.
9285
9286 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9287 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9288 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9289 this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9290 displayed or this variable is overridden by
9291 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9292 @code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9293 @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
9294
9295 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9296 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9297 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9298 this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9299 displayed. This variable overrides
9300 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9301 This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9302 is @code{nil}.
9303
9304 To see e.g. security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
9305 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9306 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
9307
9308 @item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9309 @vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9310 If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9311 default value is @code{nil}.
9312
9313 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9314 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9315 For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9316 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
9317 users to gather information from the article (e. g., add Vcard info to
9318 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e. g., automatically
9319 save all jpegs into some directory).
9320
9321 Here's an example function the does the latter:
9322
9323 @lisp
9324 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9325 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9326 (with-temp-buffer
9327 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9328 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9329 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9330 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9331 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
9332 @end lisp
9333
9334 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9335 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9336 Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
9337
9338 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9339 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9340 Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9341
9342 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9343 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9344 Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9345
9346 If displaying "text/html" is discouraged, see
9347 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} in @ref{Display Customization,
9348 Display Customization, , emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}. Images or
9349 other material inside a "multipart/related" part might be overlooked
9350 when this variable is nil.
9351
9352 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9353 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9354 Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If t, it overrides nil
9355 values of @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9356 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
9357
9358 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9359 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9360 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9361 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
9362
9363 Ready-made functions include@*
9364 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9365 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9366 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9367 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9368 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9369 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9370 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9371 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9372 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9373 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9374 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9375 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9376
9377 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
9378 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
9379
9380 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
9381 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
9382 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
9383
9384 @lisp
9385 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9386 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9387 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9388 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
9389 @end lisp
9390
9391 @noindent
9392 to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9393
9394 @end table
9395
9396
9397 @node Charsets
9398 @section Charsets
9399 @cindex charsets
9400
9401 People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
9402 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
9403 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
9404 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
9405 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
9406 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
9407 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp-2}.
9408
9409 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
9410 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
9411 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
9412 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
9413
9414 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
9415 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
9416 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
9417 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
9418 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
9419 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
9420 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
9421 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
9422 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
9423
9424 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
9425 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
9426 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
9427 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
9428 quoted-printable header encoding.
9429
9430 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
9431 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
9432 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
9433
9434 @table @var
9435 @item test
9436 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
9437 variable to query,
9438 @item header
9439 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
9440 means encode all charsets),
9441 @item body-list
9442 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
9443 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
9444 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
9445 @end table
9446
9447 @cindex Russian
9448 @cindex koi8-r
9449 @cindex koi8-u
9450 @cindex iso-8859-5
9451 @cindex coding system aliases
9452 @cindex preferred charset
9453
9454 @xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
9455 The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
9456 MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
9457
9458 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
9459
9460 If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
9461 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
9462
9463 @lisp
9464 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
9465 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
9466 @end lisp
9467
9468 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
9469 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
9470
9471 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
9472
9473 @lisp
9474 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
9475 @end lisp
9476
9477 This will almost do the right thing.
9478
9479 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
9480 something like
9481
9482 @lisp
9483 (codepage-setup 1251)
9484 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
9485 @end lisp
9486
9487
9488 @node Article Commands
9489 @section Article Commands
9490
9491 @table @kbd
9492
9493 @item A P
9494 @cindex PostScript
9495 @cindex printing
9496 @kindex A P (Summary)
9497 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
9498 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
9499 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
9500 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
9501 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
9502 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
9503
9504 @end table
9505
9506
9507 @node Summary Sorting
9508 @section Summary Sorting
9509 @cindex summary sorting
9510
9511 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
9512 can't really see why you'd want that.
9513
9514 @table @kbd
9515
9516 @item C-c C-s C-n
9517 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
9518 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
9519 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
9520
9521 @item C-c C-s C-a
9522 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
9523 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
9524 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
9525
9526 @item C-c C-s C-s
9527 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
9528 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
9529 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
9530
9531 @item C-c C-s C-d
9532 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
9533 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
9534 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
9535
9536 @item C-c C-s C-l
9537 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
9538 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
9539 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
9540
9541 @item C-c C-s C-c
9542 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
9543 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
9544 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
9545
9546 @item C-c C-s C-i
9547 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
9548 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
9549 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
9550
9551 @item C-c C-s C-r
9552 @kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
9553 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
9554 Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
9555
9556 @item C-c C-s C-o
9557 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
9558 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
9559 Sort using the default sorting method
9560 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
9561 @end table
9562
9563 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
9564 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
9565 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
9566 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
9567 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
9568 Commands}).
9569
9570
9571 @node Finding the Parent
9572 @section Finding the Parent
9573 @cindex parent articles
9574 @cindex referring articles
9575
9576 @table @kbd
9577 @item ^
9578 @kindex ^ (Summary)
9579 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
9580 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
9581 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
9582 if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
9583 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
9584 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
9585 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
9586 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
9587 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
9588
9589 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
9590 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
9591 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
9592 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
9593 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
9594 article.
9595
9596 @item A R (Summary)
9597 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
9598 @kindex A R (Summary)
9599 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
9600 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
9601
9602 @item A T (Summary)
9603 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
9604 @kindex A T (Summary)
9605 Display the full thread where the current article appears
9606 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
9607 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
9608 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
9609 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
9610 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
9611 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
9612
9613 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
9614 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i. e.,
9615 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
9616 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
9617 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
9618 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
9619
9620 @item M-^ (Summary)
9621 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
9622 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
9623 @cindex Message-ID
9624 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
9625 You can also ask the @acronym{NNTP} server for an arbitrary article, no
9626 matter what group it belongs to. @kbd{M-^}
9627 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you for a
9628 @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read thingies
9629 that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}. You
9630 have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
9631 @end table
9632
9633 The current select method will be used when fetching by
9634 @code{Message-ID} from non-news select method, but you can override this
9635 by giving this command a prefix.
9636
9637 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
9638 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
9639 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
9640 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
9641 would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
9642 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
9643 necessary.
9644
9645 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
9646 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
9647 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
9648 match.
9649
9650 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
9651 then ask Google if that fails:
9652
9653 @lisp
9654 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
9655 '(current
9656 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
9657 @end lisp
9658
9659 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
9660 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
9661 @code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
9662 articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
9663 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
9664 group. (Anything else would be too time consuming.) @code{nnmh} does
9665 not support this at all.
9666
9667
9668 @node Alternative Approaches
9669 @section Alternative Approaches
9670
9671 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
9672 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
9673
9674 @menu
9675 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
9676 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
9677 @end menu
9678
9679
9680 @node Pick and Read
9681 @subsection Pick and Read
9682 @cindex pick and read
9683
9684 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
9685 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
9686 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
9687 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
9688
9689 @findex gnus-pick-mode
9690 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
9691 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
9692 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
9693 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
9694 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
9695
9696 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
9697
9698 @table @kbd
9699 @item .
9700 @kindex . (Pick)
9701 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
9702 Pick the article or thread on the current line
9703 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9704 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
9705 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
9706 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
9707 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
9708 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
9709
9710 @item SPACE
9711 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
9712 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
9713 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
9714 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
9715
9716 @item u
9717 @kindex u (Pick)
9718 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
9719 Unpick the thread or article
9720 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9721 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
9722 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
9723 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
9724 the thread or article at that line.
9725
9726 @item RET
9727 @kindex RET (Pick)
9728 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
9729 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
9730 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
9731 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
9732 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
9733 will still be visible when you are reading.
9734
9735 @end table
9736
9737 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
9738 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
9739 which is mapped to the same function
9740 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
9741
9742 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
9743
9744 @lisp
9745 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
9746 @end lisp
9747
9748 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
9749 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
9750
9751 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
9752 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
9753 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
9754
9755 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
9756 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
9757 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
9758 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
9759 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
9760 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
9761 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
9762
9763
9764 @node Binary Groups
9765 @subsection Binary Groups
9766 @cindex binary groups
9767
9768 @findex gnus-binary-mode
9769 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
9770 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
9771 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
9772 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
9773 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
9774 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
9775
9776 @kindex g (Binary)
9777 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
9778 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
9779 command, when you have turned on this mode
9780 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
9781
9782 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
9783 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
9784
9785
9786 @node Tree Display
9787 @section Tree Display
9788 @cindex trees
9789
9790 @vindex gnus-use-trees
9791 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
9792 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
9793 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
9794 in the tree buffer.
9795
9796 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
9797
9798 @table @code
9799 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
9800 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
9801 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
9802
9803 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9804 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9805 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
9806 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
9807 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
9808
9809 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
9810 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
9811 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
9812 default is @code{modeline}.
9813
9814 @item gnus-tree-line-format
9815 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
9816 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
9817 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
9818 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
9819 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
9820 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
9821
9822 Valid specs are:
9823
9824 @table @samp
9825 @item n
9826 The name of the poster.
9827 @item f
9828 The @code{From} header.
9829 @item N
9830 The number of the article.
9831 @item [
9832 The opening bracket.
9833 @item ]
9834 The closing bracket.
9835 @item s
9836 The subject.
9837 @end table
9838
9839 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
9840
9841 Variables related to the display are:
9842
9843 @table @code
9844 @item gnus-tree-brackets
9845 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
9846 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
9847 ``sparse'' articles. The format is
9848 @example
9849 ((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
9850 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
9851 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
9852 @end example
9853 and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
9854
9855 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9856 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9857 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
9858 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
9859
9860 @end table
9861
9862 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
9863 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
9864 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
9865 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
9866 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
9867 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
9868 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
9869 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
9870 other windows displayed next to it.
9871
9872 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
9873 at all times:
9874
9875 @lisp
9876 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
9877 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
9878 @end lisp
9879
9880 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
9881 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
9882 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
9883 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
9884 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
9885 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
9886 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
9887
9888 @end table
9889
9890 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
9891
9892 @example
9893 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
9894 | \[Jan]
9895 | \[odd]-[Eri]
9896 | \(***)-[Eri]
9897 | \[odd]-[Paa]
9898 \[Bjo]
9899 \[Gun]
9900 \[Gun]-[Jor]
9901 @end example
9902
9903 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
9904
9905 @example
9906 @group
9907 @{***@}
9908 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
9909 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
9910 |--\-----\-----\ |
9911 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
9912 | | |--\
9913 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
9914 |
9915 [Paa]
9916 @end group
9917 @end example
9918
9919 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
9920 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
9921 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
9922
9923 @lisp
9924 (setq gnus-use-trees t
9925 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
9926 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
9927 (gnus-add-configuration
9928 '(article
9929 (vertical 1.0
9930 (horizontal 0.25
9931 (summary 0.75 point)
9932 (tree 1.0))
9933 (article 1.0))))
9934 @end lisp
9935
9936 @xref{Window Layout}.
9937
9938
9939 @node Mail Group Commands
9940 @section Mail Group Commands
9941 @cindex mail group commands
9942
9943 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
9944 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
9945
9946 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
9947 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9948
9949 @table @kbd
9950
9951 @item B e
9952 @kindex B e (Summary)
9953 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
9954 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
9955 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
9956 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
9957 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
9958
9959 @item B C-M-e
9960 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
9961 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
9962 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
9963 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
9964 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
9965 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
9966
9967 @item B DEL
9968 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
9969 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
9970 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
9971 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
9972 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
9973 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
9974
9975 @item B m
9976 @kindex B m (Summary)
9977 @cindex move mail
9978 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
9979 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
9980 Move the article from one mail group to another
9981 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
9982 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
9983
9984 @item B c
9985 @kindex B c (Summary)
9986 @cindex copy mail
9987 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
9988 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
9989 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
9990 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
9991 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
9992
9993 @item B B
9994 @kindex B B (Summary)
9995 @cindex crosspost mail
9996 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
9997 Crosspost the current article to some other group
9998 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
9999 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10000 be properly updated.
10001
10002 @item B i
10003 @kindex B i (Summary)
10004 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
10005 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10006 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10007 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10008
10009 @item B I
10010 @kindex B I (Summary)
10011 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
10012 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10013 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10014 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10015
10016 @item B r
10017 @kindex B r (Summary)
10018 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10019 @vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10020 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10021 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10022 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10023 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10024 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10025 (which is the default).
10026
10027 @item B w
10028 @itemx e
10029 @kindex B w (Summary)
10030 @kindex e (Summary)
10031 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10032 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10033 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10034 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10035 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10036 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10037 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
10038
10039 @item B q
10040 @kindex B q (Summary)
10041 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10042 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10043 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10044 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
10045
10046 @item B t
10047 @kindex B t (Summary)
10048 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10049 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10050 when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
10051
10052 @item B p
10053 @kindex B p (Summary)
10054 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10055 Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10056 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10057 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10058 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10059 article from your news server (or rather, from
10060 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10061 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10062 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10063 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10064 just not have arrived yet.
10065
10066 @item K E
10067 @kindex K E (Summary)
10068 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10069 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10070 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10071 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10072 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
10073
10074 @end table
10075
10076 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10077 @cindex moving articles
10078 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10079 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10080 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10081 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10082 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10083 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10084 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
10085
10086 @lisp
10087 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
10088 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10089 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10090 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
10091 @end lisp
10092
10093
10094 @node Various Summary Stuff
10095 @section Various Summary Stuff
10096
10097 @menu
10098 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10099 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10100 * Summary Generation Commands::
10101 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10102 @end menu
10103
10104 @table @code
10105 @vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10106 @item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10107 If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10108 built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10109 If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10110 lines. The default is @code{nil}.
10111
10112 @vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10113 @item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10114 If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10115 current article.
10116
10117 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10118 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10119 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
10120
10121 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10122 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10123 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10124 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10125 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10126 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10127 have been set.
10128
10129 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10130 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10131 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10132 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10133 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
10134
10135 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10136 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10137 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10138 generated.
10139
10140 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10141 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10142 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10143 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10144 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10145 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10146 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10147 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10148 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10149 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
10150
10151 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10152 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10153 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10154 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10155 list of articles to be selected.
10156
10157 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10158 the list in one particular group:
10159
10160 @lisp
10161 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10162 (if (string= group "some.group")
10163 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10164 articles))
10165 @end lisp
10166
10167 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10168 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10169 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10170 variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10171 values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10172 buffer is active.
10173
10174 Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10175 @code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10176 assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10177 that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10178 variable will be used instead.
10179
10180 These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10181 while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10182 buffers. For example:
10183
10184 @lisp
10185 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10186 '(message-use-followup-to
10187 (gnus-visible-headers .
10188 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
10189 @end lisp
10190
10191 Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
10192 @end table
10193
10194
10195 @node Summary Group Information
10196 @subsection Summary Group Information
10197
10198 @table @kbd
10199
10200 @item H f
10201 @kindex H f (Summary)
10202 @findex gnus-summary-fetch-faq
10203 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
10204 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} (list of frequently asked questions)
10205 for the current group (@code{gnus-summary-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try
10206 to get the @acronym{FAQ} from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which
10207 is usually a directory on a remote machine. This variable can also be
10208 a list of directories. In that case, giving a prefix to this command
10209 will allow you to choose between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp}
10210 or @code{efs} will probably be used for fetching the file.
10211
10212 @item H d
10213 @kindex H d (Summary)
10214 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10215 Give a brief description of the current group
10216 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10217 rereading the description from the server.
10218
10219 @item H h
10220 @kindex H h (Summary)
10221 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10222 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10223 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
10224
10225 @item H i
10226 @kindex H i (Summary)
10227 @findex gnus-info-find-node
10228 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
10229 @end table
10230
10231
10232 @node Searching for Articles
10233 @subsection Searching for Articles
10234
10235 @table @kbd
10236
10237 @item M-s
10238 @kindex M-s (Summary)
10239 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10240 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10241 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
10242
10243 @item M-r
10244 @kindex M-r (Summary)
10245 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10246 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10247 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
10248
10249 @item &
10250 @kindex & (Summary)
10251 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10252 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10253 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10254 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10255 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10256 search backward instead.
10257
10258 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10259 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
10260
10261 @item M-&
10262 @kindex M-& (Summary)
10263 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10264 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10265 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10266 @end table
10267
10268 @node Summary Generation Commands
10269 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
10270
10271 @table @kbd
10272
10273 @item Y g
10274 @kindex Y g (Summary)
10275 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
10276 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
10277
10278 @item Y c
10279 @kindex Y c (Summary)
10280 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10281 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10282 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
10283
10284 @item Y d
10285 @kindex Y d (Summary)
10286 @findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10287 Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10288 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
10289
10290 @end table
10291
10292
10293 @node Really Various Summary Commands
10294 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
10295
10296 @table @kbd
10297
10298 @item A D
10299 @itemx C-d
10300 @kindex C-d (Summary)
10301 @kindex A D (Summary)
10302 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10303 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10304 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10305 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10306 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10307 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10308 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10309 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10310 fashion.
10311
10312 @item C-M-d
10313 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
10314 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
10315 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
10316 several documents into one biiig group
10317 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
10318 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
10319 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
10320 command understands the process/prefix convention
10321 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10322
10323 @item C-t
10324 @kindex C-t (Summary)
10325 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
10326 Toggle truncation of summary lines
10327 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
10328 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
10329 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
10330
10331 @item =
10332 @kindex = (Summary)
10333 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
10334 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
10335 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
10336
10337 @item C-M-e
10338 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
10339 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
10340 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10341 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
10342
10343 @item C-M-a
10344 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
10345 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
10346 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10347 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
10348
10349 @end table
10350
10351
10352 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
10353 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
10354 @cindex summary exit
10355 @cindex exiting groups
10356
10357 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
10358 group and return you to the group buffer.
10359
10360 @table @kbd
10361
10362 @item Z Z
10363 @itemx Z Q
10364 @itemx q
10365 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
10366 @kindex Z Q (Summary)
10367 @kindex q (Summary)
10368 @findex gnus-summary-exit
10369 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
10370 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
10371 @vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
10372 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
10373 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
10374 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
10375 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
10376 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
10377 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
10378 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
10379 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
10380
10381 @item Z E
10382 @itemx Q
10383 @kindex Z E (Summary)
10384 @kindex Q (Summary)
10385 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
10386 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
10387 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
10388
10389 @item Z c
10390 @itemx c
10391 @kindex Z c (Summary)
10392 @kindex c (Summary)
10393 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
10394 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
10395 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
10396 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
10397
10398 @item Z C
10399 @kindex Z C (Summary)
10400 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
10401 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
10402 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
10403
10404 @item Z n
10405 @kindex Z n (Summary)
10406 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
10407 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
10408 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
10409
10410 @item Z R
10411 @itemx C-x C-s
10412 @kindex Z R (Summary)
10413 @kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
10414 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
10415 Exit this group, and then enter it again
10416 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
10417 all articles, both read and unread.
10418
10419 @item Z G
10420 @itemx M-g
10421 @kindex Z G (Summary)
10422 @kindex M-g (Summary)
10423 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
10424 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
10425 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
10426 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
10427 articles, both read and unread.
10428
10429 @item Z N
10430 @kindex Z N (Summary)
10431 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
10432 Exit the group and go to the next group
10433 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
10434
10435 @item Z P
10436 @kindex Z P (Summary)
10437 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
10438 Exit the group and go to the previous group
10439 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
10440
10441 @item Z s
10442 @kindex Z s (Summary)
10443 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
10444 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
10445 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
10446 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
10447 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
10448 @end table
10449
10450 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
10451 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
10452 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
10453 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
10454
10455 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
10456 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
10457 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
10458 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
10459 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
10460 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
10461 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
10462 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
10463 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
10464 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
10465 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
10466 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
10467
10468 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
10469
10470 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
10471 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
10472 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
10473 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
10474 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
10475 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
10476 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
10477 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
10478 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
10479
10480
10481 @node Crosspost Handling
10482 @section Crosspost Handling
10483
10484 @cindex velveeta
10485 @cindex spamming
10486 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
10487 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
10488 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
10489 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
10490 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
10491 heinous crime. You may want to try NoCeM handling to filter out spam
10492 (@pxref{NoCeM}).
10493
10494 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
10495 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
10496 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
10497 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
10498 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
10499
10500 @cindex cross-posting
10501 @cindex Xref
10502 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
10503 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
10504 correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
10505 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
10506 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
10507 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
10508 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
10509 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
10510 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
10511 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
10512 the cross reference mechanism.
10513
10514 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
10515 @cindex overview.fmt
10516 To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
10517 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
10518 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
10519 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
10520 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
10521 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
10522 overview files.
10523
10524 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
10525 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
10526 set @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
10527 considerably.
10528
10529 C'est la vie.
10530
10531 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
10532
10533
10534 @node Duplicate Suppression
10535 @section Duplicate Suppression
10536
10537 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
10538 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
10539 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
10540 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
10541 reasons.
10542
10543 @enumerate
10544 @item
10545 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
10546 is evil and not very common.
10547
10548 @item
10549 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
10550 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
10551
10552 @item
10553 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
10554 different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
10555
10556 @item
10557 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
10558 @end enumerate
10559
10560 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
10561 well, but these four are the most common situations.
10562
10563 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
10564 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
10565 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
10566 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
10567 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
10568 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
10569 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
10570 once.
10571
10572 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
10573 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
10574 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
10575 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
10576 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
10577 saw the article in.
10578
10579 @table @code
10580 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
10581 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
10582 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
10583
10584 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
10585 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
10586 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
10587 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
10588 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
10589 session are suppressed.
10590
10591 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
10592 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
10593 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
10594 suppression list. The default is 10000.
10595
10596 @item gnus-duplicate-file
10597 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
10598 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
10599 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
10600 @end table
10601
10602 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
10603 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
10604 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
10605 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
10606 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
10607 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
10608 to you to figure out, I think.
10609
10610 @node Security
10611 @section Security
10612
10613 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
10614 The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
10615 and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
10616 things to work:
10617
10618 @enumerate
10619 @item
10620 To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
10621 install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG. The Lisp interface
10622 to GnuPG included with Gnus is called PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg, PGG
10623 Manual}), but Mailcrypt and gpg.el are also supported.
10624
10625 @item
10626 To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL. OpenSSL 0.9.6
10627 or newer is recommended.
10628
10629 @end enumerate
10630
10631 More information on how to set things up can be found in the message
10632 manual (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
10633
10634 @table @code
10635 @item mm-verify-option
10636 @vindex mm-verify-option
10637 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
10638 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
10639 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10640
10641 @item mm-decrypt-option
10642 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
10643 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
10644 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
10645 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10646
10647 @item mml1991-use
10648 @vindex mml1991-use
10649 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10650 @acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10651 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10652 deprecated.
10653
10654 @item mml2015-use
10655 @vindex mml2015-use
10656 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10657 @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10658 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10659 deprecated.
10660
10661 @end table
10662
10663 @cindex snarfing keys
10664 @cindex importing PGP keys
10665 @cindex PGP key ring import
10666 Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
10667 key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
10668 rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
10669 allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
10670 through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
10671 @file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
10672 Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
10673 Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
10674 (@pxref{Using MIME}).
10675
10676 @example
10677 application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
10678 @end example
10679 @noindent
10680 This happens to also be the default action defined in
10681 @code{mailcap-mime-data}.
10682
10683 @node Mailing List
10684 @section Mailing List
10685 @cindex mailing list
10686 @cindex RFC 2396
10687
10688 @kindex A M (summary)
10689 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
10690 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
10691 add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
10692 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
10693 summary buffer.
10694
10695 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
10696
10697 @table @kbd
10698
10699 @item C-c C-n h
10700 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
10701 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
10702 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
10703
10704 @item C-c C-n s
10705 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
10706 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
10707 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
10708
10709 @item C-c C-n u
10710 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
10711 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
10712 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
10713 field exists.
10714
10715 @item C-c C-n p
10716 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
10717 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
10718 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
10719
10720 @item C-c C-n o
10721 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
10722 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10723 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
10724
10725 @item C-c C-n a
10726 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
10727 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10728 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
10729
10730 @end table
10731
10732
10733 @node Article Buffer
10734 @chapter Article Buffer
10735 @cindex article buffer
10736
10737 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
10738 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
10739 tell Gnus otherwise.
10740
10741 @menu
10742 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
10743 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
10744 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
10745 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
10746 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
10747 @end menu
10748
10749
10750 @node Hiding Headers
10751 @section Hiding Headers
10752 @cindex hiding headers
10753 @cindex deleting headers
10754
10755 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
10756 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
10757
10758 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
10759 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
10760 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
10761 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
10762 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
10763 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
10764 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
10765 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
10766 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
10767
10768 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
10769
10770 @table @code
10771
10772 @item gnus-visible-headers
10773 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
10774 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
10775 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
10776 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
10777
10778 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
10779 the article and the subject, you'd say:
10780
10781 @lisp
10782 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
10783 @end lisp
10784
10785 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10786 remain visible.
10787
10788 @item gnus-ignored-headers
10789 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
10790 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
10791 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
10792 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
10793 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
10794
10795 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
10796 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
10797
10798 @lisp
10799 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
10800 @end lisp
10801
10802 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10803 be removed.
10804
10805 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
10806 variable will have no effect.
10807
10808 @end table
10809
10810 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
10811 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
10812 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
10813 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
10814 the headers are to be displayed.
10815
10816 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
10817 and then the subject, you might say something like:
10818
10819 @lisp
10820 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
10821 @end lisp
10822
10823 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
10824 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
10825
10826 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
10827 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
10828 You can hide further boring headers by setting
10829 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
10830 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
10831 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
10832 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
10833 from sight.
10834
10835 These conditions are:
10836 @table @code
10837 @item empty
10838 Remove all empty headers.
10839 @item followup-to
10840 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
10841 @code{Newsgroups} header.
10842 @item reply-to
10843 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
10844 the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
10845 parameter is set.
10846 @item newsgroups
10847 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
10848 name.
10849 @item to-address
10850 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
10851 the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
10852 @item to-list
10853 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
10854 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
10855 @item cc-list
10856 Remove the @code{CC} header if it only contains the address identical to
10857 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
10858 @item date
10859 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
10860 old.
10861 @item long-to
10862 Remove the @code{To} header if it is very long.
10863 @item many-to
10864 Remove all @code{To} headers if there are more than one.
10865 @end table
10866
10867 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
10868
10869 @lisp
10870 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
10871 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
10872 @end lisp
10873
10874 This is also the default value for this variable.
10875
10876
10877 @node Using MIME
10878 @section Using MIME
10879 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
10880
10881 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
10882 while people stand around yawning.
10883
10884 @acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
10885 while all newsreaders die of fear.
10886
10887 @acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
10888 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
10889 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
10890
10891 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
10892 @findex gnus-display-mime
10893 Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
10894 to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
10895 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
10896 display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
10897
10898 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
10899 @acronym{MIME} button:
10900
10901 @table @kbd
10902 @findex gnus-article-press-button
10903 @item RET (Article)
10904 @kindex RET (Article)
10905 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
10906 Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
10907 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
10908 the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
10909 files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
10910 object is displayed inline.
10911
10912 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
10913 @item M-RET (Article)
10914 @kindex M-RET (Article)
10915 @itemx v (Article)
10916 Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
10917 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
10918
10919 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
10920 @item t (Article)
10921 @kindex t (Article)
10922 View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
10923 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
10924
10925 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
10926 @item C (Article)
10927 @kindex C (Article)
10928 Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
10929 charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
10930
10931 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
10932 @item o (Article)
10933 @kindex o (Article)
10934 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
10935 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
10936
10937 @findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
10938 @item C-o (Article)
10939 @kindex C-o (Article)
10940 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
10941 the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
10942 suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
10943 like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
10944 message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
10945 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
10946
10947 @findex gnus-mime-delete-part
10948 @item d (Article)
10949 @kindex d (Article)
10950 Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
10951 information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
10952 (@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
10953
10954 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
10955 @item c (Article)
10956 @kindex c (Article)
10957 Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
10958 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
10959 @file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
10960 @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
10961 Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
10962
10963 @findex gnus-mime-print-part
10964 @item p (Article)
10965 @kindex p (Article)
10966 Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
10967 command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
10968 @file{.mailcap} file.
10969
10970 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
10971 @item i (Article)
10972 @kindex i (Article)
10973 Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
10974 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as text/plain. If given a prefix, insert
10975 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
10976 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
10977 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
10978 Article}).
10979
10980 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
10981 @item E (Article)
10982 @kindex E (Article)
10983 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
10984 viewer is available, use an external viewer
10985 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
10986
10987 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
10988 @item e (Article)
10989 @kindex e (Article)
10990 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
10991 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
10992
10993 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
10994 @item | (Article)
10995 @kindex | (Article)
10996 Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
10997
10998 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
10999 @item . (Article)
11000 @kindex . (Article)
11001 Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11002 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
11003
11004 @end table
11005
11006 Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11007 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11008 @acronym{MIME} manual.
11009
11010 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11011 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11012 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11013 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11014 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11015 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11016 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11017 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11018 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
11019
11020 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
11021
11022 Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
11023
11024
11025 @node Customizing Articles
11026 @section Customizing Articles
11027 @cindex article customization
11028
11029 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11030 exist. You can call these functions interactively
11031 (@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11032 called automatically when you select the articles.
11033
11034 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11035 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11036 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11037 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
11038
11039 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11040 for sensible values.
11041
11042 @enumerate
11043 @item
11044 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
11045
11046 @item
11047 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
11048
11049 @item
11050 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
11051
11052 @item
11053 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last part.
11054
11055 @item
11056 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11057 than this number.
11058
11059 @item
11060 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11061 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11062 regexps in the list.
11063
11064 @item
11065 A list where the first element is not a string:
11066
11067 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11068 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11069 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
11070
11071 @lisp
11072 (or last
11073 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11074 @end lisp
11075
11076 @end enumerate
11077
11078 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11079 to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11080 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11081 considered to contain just a single part.
11082
11083 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11084 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11085 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11086 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11087 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11088 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11089 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
11090
11091 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11092 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11093 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11094 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
11095
11096 @table @code
11097 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11098 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
11099
11100 @xref{Article Buttons}.
11101
11102 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11103 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11104 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11105 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11106 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, integer)
11107 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11108 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11109 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11110 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11111 @item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
11112
11113 @xref{Article Washing}.
11114
11115 @item gnus-treat-date-english (head)
11116 @item gnus-treat-date-iso8601 (head)
11117 @item gnus-treat-date-lapsed (head)
11118 @item gnus-treat-date-local (head)
11119 @item gnus-treat-date-original (head)
11120 @item gnus-treat-date-user-defined (head)
11121 @item gnus-treat-date-ut (head)
11122
11123 @xref{Article Date}.
11124
11125 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
11126 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
11127 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
11128
11129 @xref{Picons}.
11130
11131 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
11132
11133 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
11134
11135 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
11136 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
11137 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
11138
11139 @xref{Smileys}.
11140
11141 @item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
11142
11143 @xref{X-Face}.
11144
11145 @item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
11146
11147 @xref{Face}.
11148
11149 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
11150 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
11151 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
11152 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
11153 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
11154 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
11155 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
11156 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
11157 @item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
11158 @item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
11159
11160 @xref{Article Hiding}.
11161
11162 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
11163 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
11164 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
11165
11166 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
11167
11168 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
11169 @item gnus-treat-translate
11170 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
11171
11172 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
11173 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
11174 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
11175 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
11176
11177 @xref{Article Header}.
11178
11179
11180 @end table
11181
11182 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
11183 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
11184 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
11185 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
11186 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
11187 everything.
11188
11189
11190 @node Article Keymap
11191 @section Article Keymap
11192
11193 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
11194 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
11195 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
11196 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
11197 buffer.
11198
11199 A few additional keystrokes are available:
11200
11201 @table @kbd
11202
11203 @item SPACE
11204 @kindex SPACE (Article)
11205 @findex gnus-article-next-page
11206 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
11207 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
11208
11209 @item DEL
11210 @kindex DEL (Article)
11211 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
11212 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
11213 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
11214
11215 @item C-c ^
11216 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
11217 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
11218 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
11219 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
11220 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
11221
11222 @item C-c C-m
11223 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
11224 @findex gnus-article-mail
11225 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
11226 given a prefix, include the mail.
11227
11228 @item s
11229 @kindex s (Article)
11230 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
11231 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
11232 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
11233
11234 @item ?
11235 @kindex ? (Article)
11236 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
11237 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
11238 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
11239
11240 @item TAB
11241 @kindex TAB (Article)
11242 @findex gnus-article-next-button
11243 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
11244 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
11245
11246 @item M-TAB
11247 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
11248 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
11249 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
11250
11251 @item R
11252 @kindex R (Article)
11253 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
11254 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
11255 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If given a prefix, make a
11256 wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11257 region.
11258
11259 @item F
11260 @kindex F (Article)
11261 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
11262 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
11263 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If given a prefix, make
11264 a wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11265 region.
11266
11267
11268 @end table
11269
11270
11271 @node Misc Article
11272 @section Misc Article
11273
11274 @table @code
11275
11276 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
11277 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
11278 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
11279 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
11280 article buffer.
11281
11282 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
11283 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
11284 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11285 Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
11286 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
11287
11288 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
11289 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
11290 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
11291 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
11292 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
11293 the contents of the article buffer.
11294
11295 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
11296 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
11297 Hook called in article mode buffers.
11298
11299 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11300 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11301 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
11302 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
11303
11304 @vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
11305 @item gnus-article-over-scroll
11306 If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
11307 no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
11308
11309 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
11310 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
11311 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
11312 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
11313 Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
11314 with two extensions:
11315
11316 @table @samp
11317
11318 @item w
11319 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
11320 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
11321 performed. The characters and their meaning:
11322
11323 @table @samp
11324
11325 @item c
11326 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
11327
11328 @item h
11329 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
11330
11331 @item p
11332 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
11333 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
11334 security status, i.e. good or bad signature.)
11335
11336 @item s
11337 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
11338
11339 @item o
11340 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
11341
11342 @item e
11343 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasised strings in the article buffer.
11344
11345 @end table
11346
11347 @item m
11348 The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
11349
11350 @end table
11351
11352 @vindex gnus-break-pages
11353
11354 @item gnus-break-pages
11355 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
11356 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
11357 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
11358 paging will not be done.
11359
11360 @item gnus-page-delimiter
11361 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
11362 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
11363 (formfeed).
11364
11365 @cindex IDNA
11366 @cindex internationalized domain names
11367 @vindex gnus-use-idna
11368 @item gnus-use-idna
11369 This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
11370 internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
11371 @samp{Cc} headers. This requires
11372 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
11373 variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
11374
11375 @end table
11376
11377
11378 @node Composing Messages
11379 @chapter Composing Messages
11380 @cindex composing messages
11381 @cindex messages
11382 @cindex mail
11383 @cindex sending mail
11384 @cindex reply
11385 @cindex followup
11386 @cindex post
11387 @cindex using gpg
11388 @cindex using s/mime
11389 @cindex using smime
11390
11391 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
11392 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
11393 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
11394 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
11395 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
11396 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
11397
11398 @menu
11399 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
11400 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
11401 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
11402 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
11403 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
11404 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
11405 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
11406 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
11407 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
11408 @end menu
11409
11410 Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
11411 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
11412
11413
11414 @node Mail
11415 @section Mail
11416
11417 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
11418
11419 @table @code
11420 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
11421 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
11422 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
11423 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
11424 @code{nil} include all headers.
11425
11426 @item gnus-add-to-list
11427 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
11428 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
11429 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
11430
11431 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11432 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11433 This can also be a function receiving the group name as the only
11434 parameter which should return non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is
11435 needed, or a regular expression matching group names, where
11436 confirmation is should be asked for.
11437
11438 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
11439 press R anyway, this variable might be for you.
11440
11441 @item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11442 @vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11443 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
11444 @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
11445 useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
11446
11447 @end table
11448
11449
11450 @node Posting Server
11451 @section Posting Server
11452
11453 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
11454 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
11455
11456 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
11457
11458 It can be quite complicated.
11459
11460 @vindex gnus-post-method
11461 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
11462 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
11463 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
11464 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
11465 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
11466 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
11467 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
11468 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
11469 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
11470
11471 @lisp
11472 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
11473 @end lisp
11474
11475 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
11476 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
11477 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
11478 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
11479
11480 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
11481 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
11482
11483 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
11484 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
11485 for posting.
11486
11487 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
11488 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
11489
11490 When sending mail, Message invokes @code{message-send-mail-function}.
11491 The default function, @code{message-send-mail-with-sendmail}, pipes
11492 your article to the @code{sendmail} binary for further queuing and
11493 sending. When your local system is not configured for sending mail
11494 using @code{sendmail}, and you have access to a remote @acronym{SMTP}
11495 server, you can set @code{message-send-mail-function} to
11496 @code{smtpmail-send-it} and make sure to setup the @code{smtpmail}
11497 package correctly. An example:
11498
11499 @lisp
11500 (setq message-send-mail-function 'smtpmail-send-it
11501 smtpmail-default-smtp-server "YOUR SMTP HOST")
11502 @end lisp
11503
11504 To the thing similar to this, there is
11505 @code{message-smtpmail-send-it}. It is useful if your @acronym{ISP}
11506 requires the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication.
11507 @xref{POP before SMTP}.
11508
11509 Other possible choices for @code{message-send-mail-function} includes
11510 @code{message-send-mail-with-mh}, @code{message-send-mail-with-qmail},
11511 and @code{feedmail-send-it}.
11512
11513 @node POP before SMTP
11514 @section POP before SMTP
11515 @cindex pop before smtp
11516 @findex message-smtpmail-send-it
11517 @findex mail-source-touch-pop
11518
11519 Does your @acronym{ISP} require the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
11520 authentication? It is whether you need to connect to the @acronym{POP}
11521 mail server within a certain time before sending mails. If so, there is
11522 a convenient way. To do that, put the following lines in your
11523 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
11524
11525 @lisp
11526 (setq message-send-mail-function 'message-smtpmail-send-it)
11527 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
11528 @end lisp
11529
11530 @noindent
11531 It means to let Gnus connect to the @acronym{POP} mail server in advance
11532 whenever you send a mail. The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function
11533 does only a @acronym{POP} authentication according to the value of
11534 @code{mail-sources} without fetching mails, just before sending a mail.
11535 Note that you have to use @code{message-smtpmail-send-it} which runs
11536 @code{message-send-mail-hook} rather than @code{smtpmail-send-it} and
11537 set the value of @code{mail-sources} for a @acronym{POP} connection
11538 correctly. @xref{Mail Sources}.
11539
11540 If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
11541 @code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
11542 @code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
11543 used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
11544 is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
11545 mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
11546
11547 @lisp
11548 (setq mail-source-primary-source
11549 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11550 :password "secret"))
11551 @end lisp
11552
11553 @noindent
11554 Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
11555 @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
11556
11557 @lisp
11558 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
11559 (lambda ()
11560 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
11561 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11562 :password "secret")))
11563 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
11564 @end lisp
11565
11566 @node Mail and Post
11567 @section Mail and Post
11568
11569 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
11570 posting:
11571
11572 @table @code
11573 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
11574 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
11575 @cindex mailing lists
11576
11577 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
11578 gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
11579 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
11580 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
11581 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
11582 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
11583 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
11584 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
11585 still a pain, though.
11586
11587 @item gnus-user-agent
11588 @vindex gnus-user-agent
11589 @cindex User-Agent
11590
11591 This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
11592 User-Agent header. It can be one of the symbols @code{gnus} (show only
11593 Gnus version), @code{emacs-gnus} (show only Emacs and Gnus versions),
11594 @code{emacs-gnus-config} (same as @code{emacs-gnus} plus system
11595 configuration), @code{emacs-gnus-type} (same as @code{emacs-gnus} plus
11596 system type) or a custom string. If you set it to a string, be sure to
11597 use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
11598
11599 @end table
11600
11601 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
11602 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
11603 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
11604
11605 @cindex ispell
11606 @findex ispell-message
11607 @lisp
11608 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
11609 @end lisp
11610
11611 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
11612 you're in, you could say something like the following:
11613
11614 @lisp
11615 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
11616 (lambda ()
11617 (cond
11618 ((string-match
11619 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
11620 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
11621 (t
11622 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
11623 @end lisp
11624
11625 Modify to suit your needs.
11626
11627
11628 @node Archived Messages
11629 @section Archived Messages
11630 @cindex archived messages
11631 @cindex sent messages
11632
11633 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
11634 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
11635 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
11636 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}, which
11637 is the default.
11638
11639 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
11640 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
11641 Group Commands}).
11642
11643 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
11644 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
11645 use to store sent messages. The default is:
11646
11647 @lisp
11648 (nnfolder "archive"
11649 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
11650 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
11651 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
11652 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
11653 @end lisp
11654
11655 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
11656 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
11657 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
11658 directory chosen, you could say something like:
11659
11660 @lisp
11661 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
11662 '(nnfolder "archive"
11663 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
11664 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
11665 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
11666 @end lisp
11667
11668 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
11669 @cindex Gcc
11670 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
11671 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
11672 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
11673
11674 This variable can be used to do the following:
11675
11676 @table @asis
11677 @item a string
11678 Messages will be saved in that group.
11679
11680 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
11681 message will not be stored in the select method given by
11682 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
11683 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
11684 has the default value shown above. Then setting
11685 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
11686 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
11687 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
11688 @samp{nnml:foo}.
11689
11690 @item a list of strings
11691 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
11692
11693 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
11694 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
11695
11696 @item @code{nil}
11697 No message archiving will take place. This is the default.
11698 @end table
11699
11700 Let's illustrate:
11701
11702 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
11703 @lisp
11704 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
11705 @end lisp
11706
11707 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
11708 @lisp
11709 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
11710 @end lisp
11711
11712 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
11713 @lisp
11714 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11715 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
11716 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
11717 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
11718 @end lisp
11719
11720 More complex stuff:
11721 @lisp
11722 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11723 '((if (message-news-p)
11724 "misc-news"
11725 "misc-mail")))
11726 @end lisp
11727
11728 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
11729 messages in one file per month:
11730
11731 @lisp
11732 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11733 '((if (message-news-p)
11734 "misc-news"
11735 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
11736 @end lisp
11737
11738 @c (XEmacs 19.13 doesn't have @code{format-time-string}, so you'll have to
11739 @c use a different value for @code{gnus-message-archive-group} there.)
11740
11741 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
11742 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
11743 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
11744 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
11745 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
11746 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
11747 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
11748 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
11749 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
11750 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
11751
11752 That's the default method of archiving sent messages. Gnus offers a
11753 different way for the people who don't like the default method. In that
11754 case you should set @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{nil};
11755 this will disable archiving.
11756
11757 @table @code
11758 @item gnus-outgoing-message-group
11759 @vindex gnus-outgoing-message-group
11760 All outgoing messages will be put in this group. If you want to store
11761 all your outgoing mail and articles in the group @samp{nnml:archive},
11762 you set this variable to that value. This variable can also be a list of
11763 group names.
11764
11765 If you want to have greater control over what group to put each
11766 message in, you can set this variable to a function that checks the
11767 current newsgroup name and then returns a suitable group name (or list
11768 of names).
11769
11770 This variable can be used instead of @code{gnus-message-archive-group},
11771 but the latter is the preferred method.
11772
11773 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
11774 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
11775 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
11776
11777 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
11778 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
11779 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
11780 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
11781 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
11782 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
11783 changed in the future.
11784
11785 @end table
11786
11787
11788 @node Posting Styles
11789 @section Posting Styles
11790 @cindex posting styles
11791 @cindex styles
11792
11793 All them variables, they make my head swim.
11794
11795 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
11796 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
11797 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
11798 on?
11799
11800 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
11801 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
11802 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
11803 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
11804 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
11805 variable:
11806
11807 @lisp
11808 ((".*"
11809 (signature "Peace and happiness")
11810 (organization "What me?"))
11811 ("^comp"
11812 (signature "Death to everybody"))
11813 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
11814 (organization "Emacs is it")))
11815 @end lisp
11816
11817 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
11818 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
11819 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
11820 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
11821 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
11822 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
11823 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
11824 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
11825
11826 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
11827 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
11828 If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
11829 will look in the original article for a header whose name is
11830 @var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
11831 @var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
11832 replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
11833 followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
11834 @code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
11835 no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
11836 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
11837 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
11838 said to @dfn{match}.
11839
11840 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
11841 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
11842 addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
11843 form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
11844 @code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
11845 contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
11846 @var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
11847 name can be one of:
11848
11849 @itemize @bullet
11850 @item @code{signature}
11851 @item @code{signature-file}
11852 @item @code{x-face-file}
11853 @item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
11854 @item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
11855 @item @code{body}
11856 @end itemize
11857
11858 The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
11859 this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
11860 the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
11861 name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
11862 is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
11863
11864 The attribute value can be a string (used verbatim), a function with
11865 zero arguments (the return value will be used), a variable (its value
11866 will be used) or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value
11867 will be used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
11868 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current article
11869 are available through the @code{message-reply-headers} variable, which
11870 is a vector of the following headers: number subject from date id
11871 references chars lines xref extra.
11872
11873 @vindex message-reply-headers
11874
11875 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
11876 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
11877 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
11878
11879 @findex message-mail-p
11880 @findex message-news-p
11881
11882 So here's a new example:
11883
11884 @lisp
11885 (setq gnus-posting-styles
11886 '((".*"
11887 (signature-file "~/.signature")
11888 (name "User Name")
11889 ("X-Home-Page" (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
11890 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
11891 ("^rec.humor"
11892 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
11893 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
11894 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
11895 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
11896 (signature my-news-signature))
11897 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
11898 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
11899 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
11900 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
11901 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
11902 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
11903 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
11904 (address "user@@bar.foo")
11905 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
11906 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
11907 ("nnml:.*"
11908 (From (save-excursion
11909 (set-buffer gnus-article-buffer)
11910 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
11911 ("^nn.+:"
11912 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
11913 @end lisp
11914
11915 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
11916 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
11917 if you fill many roles.
11918
11919
11920 @node Drafts
11921 @section Drafts
11922 @cindex drafts
11923
11924 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
11925 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
11926 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
11927 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
11928 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
11929
11930 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
11931 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
11932 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
11933 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
11934 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
11935 group.)
11936
11937 @cindex nndraft
11938 @vindex nndraft-directory
11939 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
11940 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
11941 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
11942 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
11943 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
11944 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
11945
11946 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
11947 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
11948 unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
11949 a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
11950 behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
11951 be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
11952 simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
11953 Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
11954 correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
11955
11956 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
11957 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
11958 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
11959 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
11960 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
11961 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
11962 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
11963 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
11964 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
11965 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
11966 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
11967 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
11968 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
11969 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
11970 @c
11971 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
11972 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
11973 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
11974
11975 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
11976 @kindex D e (Draft)
11977 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
11978 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
11979 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
11980
11981 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
11982 Articles}).
11983
11984 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
11985 @kindex D s (Draft)
11986 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
11987 @kindex D S (Draft)
11988 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
11989 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
11990 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
11991 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
11992 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
11993 in the buffer.
11994
11995 @findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
11996 @kindex D t (Draft)
11997 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
11998 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
11999 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
12000
12001
12002 @node Rejected Articles
12003 @section Rejected Articles
12004 @cindex rejected articles
12005
12006 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12007 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12008 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12009 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
12010
12011 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12012 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12013 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
12014 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
12015 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
12016
12017 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
12018 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
12019 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
12020
12021 @node Signing and encrypting
12022 @section Signing and encrypting
12023 @cindex using gpg
12024 @cindex using s/mime
12025 @cindex using smime
12026
12027 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
12028 @acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
12029 decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
12030 @code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
12031
12032 @vindex gnus-message-replysign
12033 @vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
12034 @vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
12035 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
12036 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
12037 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
12038 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
12039 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
12040 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
12041 automatically encrypted messages.
12042
12043 Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
12044 @acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
12045 signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
12046
12047 @table @kbd
12048
12049 @item C-c C-m s s
12050 @kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
12051 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
12052
12053 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12054
12055 @item C-c C-m s o
12056 @kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
12057 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12058
12059 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12060
12061 @item C-c C-m s p
12062 @kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
12063 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12064
12065 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12066
12067 @item C-c C-m c s
12068 @kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
12069 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
12070
12071 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12072
12073 @item C-c C-m c o
12074 @kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
12075 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
12076
12077 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12078
12079 @item C-c C-m c p
12080 @kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
12081 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
12082
12083 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12084
12085 @item C-c C-m C-n
12086 @kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
12087 @findex mml-unsecure-message
12088 Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
12089
12090 @end table
12091
12092 @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
12093
12094 @node Select Methods
12095 @chapter Select Methods
12096 @cindex foreign groups
12097 @cindex select methods
12098
12099 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
12100 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
12101 @acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
12102 personal mail group.
12103
12104 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
12105 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
12106 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g. @code{nntp},
12107 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
12108 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
12109 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
12110
12111 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
12112 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
12113
12114 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
12115 group as.
12116
12117 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
12118 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
12119 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
12120 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
12121 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
12122
12123 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
12124
12125 @menu
12126 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
12127 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
12128 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
12129 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
12130 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
12131 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
12132 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
12133 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
12134 @end menu
12135
12136
12137 @node Server Buffer
12138 @section Server Buffer
12139
12140 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
12141 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
12142 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
12143 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
12144 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
12145 back end represents a virtual server.
12146
12147 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
12148 different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
12149 on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
12150 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
12151
12152 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
12153 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
12154 @acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
12155 hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
12156 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
12157 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
12158 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
12159
12160 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
12161 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
12162
12163 @menu
12164 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
12165 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
12166 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
12167 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
12168 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
12169 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
12170 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
12171 @end menu
12172
12173 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
12174 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
12175
12176
12177 @node Server Buffer Format
12178 @subsection Server Buffer Format
12179 @cindex server buffer format
12180
12181 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
12182 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
12183 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
12184 variable, with some simple extensions:
12185
12186 @table @samp
12187
12188 @item h
12189 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
12190
12191 @item n
12192 The name of this server.
12193
12194 @item w
12195 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
12196
12197 @item s
12198 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
12199 @end table
12200
12201 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
12202 The mode line can also be customized by using the
12203 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
12204 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
12205
12206 @table @samp
12207 @item S
12208 Server name.
12209
12210 @item M
12211 Server method.
12212 @end table
12213
12214 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
12215
12216
12217 @node Server Commands
12218 @subsection Server Commands
12219 @cindex server commands
12220
12221 @table @kbd
12222
12223 @item a
12224 @kindex a (Server)
12225 @findex gnus-server-add-server
12226 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
12227
12228 @item e
12229 @kindex e (Server)
12230 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
12231 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
12232
12233 @item SPACE
12234 @kindex SPACE (Server)
12235 @findex gnus-server-read-server
12236 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
12237
12238 @item q
12239 @kindex q (Server)
12240 @findex gnus-server-exit
12241 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
12242
12243 @item k
12244 @kindex k (Server)
12245 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
12246 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
12247
12248 @item y
12249 @kindex y (Server)
12250 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
12251 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
12252
12253 @item c
12254 @kindex c (Server)
12255 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
12256 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
12257
12258 @item l
12259 @kindex l (Server)
12260 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
12261 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
12262
12263 @item s
12264 @kindex s (Server)
12265 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
12266 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
12267 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
12268 servers.
12269
12270 @item g
12271 @kindex g (Server)
12272 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
12273 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
12274 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
12275 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
12276
12277 @end table
12278
12279
12280 @node Example Methods
12281 @subsection Example Methods
12282
12283 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
12284
12285 @lisp
12286 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
12287 @end lisp
12288
12289 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
12290
12291 @lisp
12292 (nnspool "")
12293 @end lisp
12294
12295 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
12296 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
12297 will.
12298
12299 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
12300 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
12301
12302 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
12303 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
12304 look like then:
12305
12306 @lisp
12307 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
12308 @end lisp
12309
12310 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
12311 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
12312
12313 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
12314 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
12315 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
12316 your private mail:
12317
12318 @lisp
12319 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
12320 @end lisp
12321
12322 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
12323 that.)
12324
12325 Here's the method for a public spool:
12326
12327 @lisp
12328 (nnmh "public"
12329 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
12330 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
12331 @end lisp
12332
12333 @cindex proxy
12334 @cindex firewall
12335
12336 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
12337 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
12338 on the firewall machine and telnet from there to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12339 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
12340 should probably look something like this:
12341
12342 @lisp
12343 (nntp "firewall"
12344 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
12345 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
12346 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host")
12347 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12348 @end lisp
12349
12350 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
12351 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
12352 configuration to the example above:
12353
12354 @lisp
12355 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
12356 @end lisp
12357
12358 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}.
12359
12360 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
12361 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
12362 telnet connection to the news server as follows:
12363
12364 @lisp
12365 (nntp "outside"
12366 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
12367 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-telnet)
12368 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
12369 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12370 @end lisp
12371
12372 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
12373 provide automatic authorization, of course. And to get a compressed
12374 connection, you have to have the @samp{Compression} option in the
12375 @code{ssh} @file{config} file.
12376
12377
12378 @node Creating a Virtual Server
12379 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
12380
12381 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
12382 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
12383
12384 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
12385 would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
12386 could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
12387
12388 Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
12389
12390 You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
12391 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
12392 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
12393 will contain the following:
12394
12395 @lisp
12396 (nnml "cache")
12397 @end lisp
12398
12399 Change that to:
12400
12401 @lisp
12402 (nnml "cache"
12403 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
12404 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
12405 @end lisp
12406
12407 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
12408 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
12409 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
12410
12411
12412 @node Server Variables
12413 @subsection Server Variables
12414 @cindex server variables
12415 @cindex server parameters
12416
12417 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
12418 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
12419 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
12420 change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
12421 won't change the ``derived'' variables.
12422
12423 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
12424 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
12425 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
12426 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
12427 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
12428 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
12429 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
12430 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
12431 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
12432
12433 @lisp
12434 (nnml "public"
12435 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
12436 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
12437 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
12438 @end lisp
12439
12440 Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
12441
12442 @node Servers and Methods
12443 @subsection Servers and Methods
12444
12445 Wherever you would normally use a select method
12446 (e.g. @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
12447 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
12448 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
12449 over.
12450
12451
12452 @node Unavailable Servers
12453 @subsection Unavailable Servers
12454
12455 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
12456 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
12457 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
12458 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
12459 actually the case or not.
12460
12461 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
12462 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
12463 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
12464 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
12465 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
12466 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
12467 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
12468 it will regard that server as ``down''.
12469
12470 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
12471 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
12472
12473 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
12474 with the following commands:
12475
12476 @table @kbd
12477
12478 @item O
12479 @kindex O (Server)
12480 @findex gnus-server-open-server
12481 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
12482 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
12483
12484 @item C
12485 @kindex C (Server)
12486 @findex gnus-server-close-server
12487 Close the connection (if any) to the server
12488 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
12489
12490 @item D
12491 @kindex D (Server)
12492 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
12493 Mark the current server as unreachable
12494 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
12495
12496 @item M-o
12497 @kindex M-o (Server)
12498 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
12499 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
12500 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
12501
12502 @item M-c
12503 @kindex M-c (Server)
12504 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
12505 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
12506 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
12507
12508 @item R
12509 @kindex R (Server)
12510 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
12511 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
12512 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
12513
12514 @item L
12515 @kindex L (Server)
12516 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
12517 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
12518
12519 @end table
12520
12521
12522 @node Getting News
12523 @section Getting News
12524 @cindex reading news
12525 @cindex news back ends
12526
12527 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
12528 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
12529 or it can read from a local spool.
12530
12531 @menu
12532 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12533 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
12534 @end menu
12535
12536
12537 @node NNTP
12538 @subsection NNTP
12539 @cindex nntp
12540
12541 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
12542 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
12543 server as the, uhm, address.
12544
12545 If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
12546 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
12547 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
12548 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
12549
12550 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
12551 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
12552 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
12553
12554 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
12555 server:
12556
12557 @table @code
12558
12559 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
12560 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
12561 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
12562 @cindex authinfo
12563 @cindex authentification
12564 @cindex nntp authentification
12565 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12566 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
12567 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
12568 commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
12569 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
12570 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
12571 present in this hook.
12572
12573 @item nntp-authinfo-function
12574 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
12575 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12576 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
12577 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
12578 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
12579 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
12580 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
12581 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
12582 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
12583 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
12584 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
12585
12586 @enumerate
12587 @item
12588 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
12589
12590 @item
12591 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
12592
12593 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
12594 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
12595 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
12596 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
12597 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
12598 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
12599 @samp{force} is explained below.
12600
12601 @end enumerate
12602
12603 Here's an example file:
12604
12605 @example
12606 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
12607 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
12608 @end example
12609
12610 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
12611 have to be first, for instance.
12612
12613 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
12614 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
12615 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
12616 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
12617 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
12618 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
12619 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
12620
12621 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
12622 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
12623
12624 @example
12625 default force yes
12626 @end example
12627
12628 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
12629 previously mentioned.
12630
12631 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
12632
12633 @item nntp-server-action-alist
12634 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
12635 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
12636 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
12637 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
12638
12639 @lisp
12640 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
12641 '(("innd" (ding))))
12642 @end lisp
12643
12644 You probably don't want to do that, though.
12645
12646 The default value is
12647
12648 @lisp
12649 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
12650 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
12651 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
12652 @end lisp
12653
12654 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
12655 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
12656
12657 @item nntp-maximum-request
12658 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
12659 If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
12660 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
12661 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
12662 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
12663 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
12664 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
12665
12666 @item nntp-connection-timeout
12667 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
12668 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
12669 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
12670 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
12671 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
12672 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
12673 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
12674 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
12675 no timeouts are done.
12676
12677 @c @item nntp-command-timeout
12678 @c @vindex nntp-command-timeout
12679 @c @cindex PPP connections
12680 @c @cindex dynamic IP addresses
12681 @c If you're running Gnus on a machine that has a dynamically assigned
12682 @c address, Gnus may become confused. If the address of your machine
12683 @c changes after connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will simply sit
12684 @c waiting forever for replies from the server. To help with this
12685 @c unfortunate problem, you can set this command to a number. Gnus will
12686 @c then, if it sits waiting for a reply from the server longer than that
12687 @c number of seconds, shut down the connection, start a new one, and resend
12688 @c the command. This should hopefully be transparent to the user. A
12689 @c likely number is 30 seconds.
12690 @c
12691 @c @item nntp-retry-on-break
12692 @c @vindex nntp-retry-on-break
12693 @c If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you can also @kbd{C-g} if Gnus
12694 @c hangs. This will have much the same effect as the command timeout
12695 @c described above.
12696
12697 @item nntp-server-hook
12698 @vindex nntp-server-hook
12699 This hook is run as the last step when connecting to an @acronym{NNTP}
12700 server.
12701
12702 @item nntp-buggy-select
12703 @vindex nntp-buggy-select
12704 Set this to non-@code{nil} if your select routine is buggy.
12705
12706 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
12707 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
12708 If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
12709 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
12710 can be used.
12711
12712 @item nntp-xover-commands
12713 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
12714 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
12715 @cindex XOVER
12716 List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
12717 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
12718 "XOVERVIEW")}.
12719
12720 @item nntp-nov-gap
12721 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
12722 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
12723 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
12724 if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
12725 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
12726 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
12727 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
12728 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
12729 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
12730 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
12731 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
12732
12733 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
12734 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
12735 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12736
12737 @item nntp-warn-about-losing-connection
12738 @vindex nntp-warn-about-losing-connection
12739 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, some noise will be made when a
12740 server closes connection.
12741
12742 @item nntp-record-commands
12743 @vindex nntp-record-commands
12744 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
12745 @acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
12746 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
12747 that doesn't seem to work.
12748
12749 @item nntp-open-connection-function
12750 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
12751 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
12752 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
12753 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
12754 Five pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped in
12755 two categories: direct connection functions (three pre-made), and
12756 indirect ones (two pre-made).
12757
12758 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
12759 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
12760 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
12761 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
12762 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
12763 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
12764 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
12765
12766 @lisp
12767 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
12768 @end lisp
12769
12770 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID. This works for
12771 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
12772
12773 @item nntp-read-timeout
12774 @vindex nntp-read-timeout
12775 How long nntp should wait between checking for the end of output.
12776 Shorter values mean quicker response, but is more CPU intensive. The
12777 default is 0.1 seconds. If you have a slow line to the server (and
12778 don't like to see Emacs eat your available CPU power), you might set
12779 this to, say, 1.
12780
12781 @end table
12782
12783 @menu
12784 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
12785 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
12786 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
12787 @end menu
12788
12789
12790 @node Direct Functions
12791 @subsubsection Direct Functions
12792 @cindex direct connection functions
12793
12794 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
12795 between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
12796 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
12797 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
12798
12799 @table @code
12800 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
12801 @item nntp-open-network-stream
12802 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
12803 remote system.
12804
12805 @findex nntp-open-tls-stream
12806 @item nntp-open-tls-stream
12807 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
12808 this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GNUTLS}
12809 installed. You then define a server as follows:
12810
12811 @lisp
12812 ;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
12813 ;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
12814 ;;
12815 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
12816 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
12817 (nntp-port-number )
12818 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
12819 @end lisp
12820
12821 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
12822 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
12823 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
12824 this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL} or
12825 @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay} installed. You
12826 then define a server as follows:
12827
12828 @lisp
12829 ;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
12830 ;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
12831 ;;
12832 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
12833 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
12834 (nntp-port-number 563)
12835 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
12836 @end lisp
12837
12838 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
12839 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
12840 Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server by simply @samp{telnet}'ing
12841 it. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have the
12842 default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
12843 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
12844 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
12845 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
12846
12847 @lisp
12848 (nntp "socksified"
12849 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
12850 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
12851 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
12852 @end lisp
12853
12854 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
12855 session, which is not a good idea.
12856 @end table
12857
12858
12859 @node Indirect Functions
12860 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
12861 @cindex indirect connection functions
12862
12863 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
12864 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12865 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
12866 the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
12867 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
12868 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
12869
12870 @table @code
12871 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
12872 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
12873 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then does a @samp{telnet}
12874 to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
12875 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
12876
12877 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
12878
12879 @table @code
12880 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
12881 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
12882 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
12883 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
12884
12885 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
12886 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
12887 List of strings to be used as the switches to
12888 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
12889 @samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
12890 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections, otherwise set
12891 this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
12892 the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
12893 host.
12894 @end table
12895
12896 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
12897 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
12898 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
12899 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
12900
12901 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
12902
12903 @table @code
12904 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
12905 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
12906 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
12907 @samp{telnet}.
12908
12909 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
12910 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
12911 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
12912 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
12913
12914 @item nntp-via-user-password
12915 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
12916 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
12917
12918 @item nntp-via-envuser
12919 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
12920 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
12921 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
12922 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
12923
12924 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
12925 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
12926 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
12927 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
12928
12929 @end table
12930
12931 @end table
12932
12933
12934 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
12935 functions:
12936
12937 @table @code
12938
12939 @item nntp-via-user-name
12940 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
12941 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
12942
12943 @item nntp-via-address
12944 @vindex nntp-via-address
12945 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
12946
12947 @end table
12948
12949
12950 @node Common Variables
12951 @subsubsection Common Variables
12952
12953 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
12954 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
12955 affected.
12956
12957 @table @code
12958
12959 @item nntp-pre-command
12960 @vindex nntp-pre-command
12961 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
12962 connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
12963 @code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}. This is
12964 where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
12965
12966 @item nntp-address
12967 @vindex nntp-address
12968 The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12969
12970 @item nntp-port-number
12971 @vindex nntp-port-number
12972 Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
12973 @samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
12974 @acronym{tls}/@acronym{ssl}, you may want to use integer ports rather
12975 than named ports (i.e, use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
12976 @samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
12977 not work with named ports.
12978
12979 @item nntp-end-of-line
12980 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
12981 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
12982 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
12983 using a non native connection function.
12984
12985 @item nntp-telnet-command
12986 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
12987 Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
12988 @samp{telnet}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
12989 just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
12990 @samp{telnet}.
12991
12992 @item nntp-telnet-switches
12993 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
12994 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-telnet-command}. The default
12995 is @samp{("-8")}.
12996
12997 @end table
12998
12999
13000 @node News Spool
13001 @subsection News Spool
13002 @cindex nnspool
13003 @cindex news spool
13004
13005 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
13006 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
13007 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
13008 instance.
13009
13010 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
13011 anything else) as the address.
13012
13013 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
13014 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
13015 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
13016 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
13017
13018 @table @code
13019
13020 @item nnspool-inews-program
13021 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
13022 Program used to post an article.
13023
13024 @item nnspool-inews-switches
13025 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
13026 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
13027
13028 @item nnspool-spool-directory
13029 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
13030 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
13031 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
13032
13033 @item nnspool-nov-directory
13034 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
13035 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
13036 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
13037
13038 @item nnspool-lib-dir
13039 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
13040 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
13041
13042 @item nnspool-active-file
13043 @vindex nnspool-active-file
13044 The name of the active file.
13045
13046 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
13047 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
13048 The name of the group descriptions file.
13049
13050 @item nnspool-history-file
13051 @vindex nnspool-history-file
13052 The name of the news history file.
13053
13054 @item nnspool-active-times-file
13055 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
13056 The name of the active date file.
13057
13058 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
13059 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
13060 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
13061 that it finds.
13062
13063 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13064 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13065 @cindex sed
13066 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
13067 relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
13068 @code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
13069 there.
13070
13071 @end table
13072
13073
13074 @node Getting Mail
13075 @section Getting Mail
13076 @cindex reading mail
13077 @cindex mail
13078
13079 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD? But of
13080 course.
13081
13082 @menu
13083 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
13084 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
13085 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
13086 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
13087 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
13088 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
13089 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
13090 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
13091 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
13092 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
13093 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
13094 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
13095 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
13096 @end menu
13097
13098
13099 @node Mail in a Newsreader
13100 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
13101
13102 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
13103 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
13104 of a culture shock.
13105
13106 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
13107 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
13108
13109 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
13110 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
13111 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
13112 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
13113
13114 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
13115
13116 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
13117 deleted? How awful!
13118
13119 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
13120 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
13121 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
13122 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
13123 Mail}.
13124
13125 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
13126 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
13127 they want to treat a message.
13128
13129 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
13130 via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
13131 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
13132 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
13133 archived somewhere else.
13134
13135 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
13136 These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
13137 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
13138 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
13139 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
13140
13141 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
13142 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
13143 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
13144
13145 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
13146 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
13147 differently.
13148
13149 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
13150 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
13151 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
13152 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
13153 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
13154
13155 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
13156 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
13157 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
13158 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
13159 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
13160 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
13161 You Do.)
13162
13163
13164 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
13165 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
13166
13167 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
13168 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
13169 and things will happen automatically.
13170
13171 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
13172 mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
13173
13174 @lisp
13175 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
13176 @end lisp
13177
13178 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
13179 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
13180 directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
13181 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
13182 like any other group.
13183
13184 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
13185
13186 @lisp
13187 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13188 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13189 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13190 ("other" "")))
13191 @end lisp
13192
13193 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
13194 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
13195 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
13196 last group.
13197
13198 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
13199 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
13200 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
13201
13202
13203 @node Splitting Mail
13204 @subsection Splitting Mail
13205 @cindex splitting mail
13206 @cindex mail splitting
13207 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
13208
13209 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
13210 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
13211 to be split into groups.
13212
13213 @lisp
13214 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13215 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13216 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13217 ("mail.other" "")))
13218 @end lisp
13219
13220 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
13221 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
13222 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
13223 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
13224 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
13225 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
13226 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
13227
13228 @lisp
13229 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
13230 @end lisp
13231
13232 @noindent
13233 In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
13234 the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
13235
13236 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
13237 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
13238 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
13239 mail belongs in that group.
13240
13241 @cindex @samp{bogus} group
13242 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
13243 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
13244 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
13245 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
13246 to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
13247 that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
13248 will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
13249 splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
13250 see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
13251
13252 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
13253 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
13254 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
13255 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
13256 thinks should carry this mail message.
13257
13258 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
13259 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
13260 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
13261 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
13262
13263 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
13264 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
13265 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
13266 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
13267 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
13268
13269 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
13270 @cindex crosspost
13271 @cindex links
13272 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
13273 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
13274 links. If that's the case for you, set
13275 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
13276 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
13277
13278 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
13279 @findex nnmail-split-history
13280 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
13281 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
13282 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
13283 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
13284 Group Commands}).
13285
13286 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
13287 Header lines longer than the value of
13288 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
13289 function.
13290
13291 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
13292 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
13293 By default the splitting codes @acronym{MIME} decodes headers so you
13294 can match on non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. The
13295 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset} variable specifies the default
13296 charset for decoding. The behaviour can be turned off completely by
13297 binding @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} to @code{nil}, which is
13298 useful if you want to match articles based on the raw header data.
13299
13300 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13301 By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
13302 specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
13303 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
13304 @emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
13305 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
13306 splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
13307 other kinds of entries.)
13308
13309 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
13310 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
13311 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
13312 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
13313 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
13314 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
13315 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
13316 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
13317 month's rent money.
13318
13319
13320 @node Mail Sources
13321 @subsection Mail Sources
13322
13323 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
13324 a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
13325 maildir, for instance.
13326
13327 @menu
13328 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
13329 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
13330 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
13331 @end menu
13332
13333
13334 @node Mail Source Specifiers
13335 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
13336 @cindex POP
13337 @cindex mail server
13338 @cindex procmail
13339 @cindex mail spool
13340 @cindex mail source
13341
13342 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
13343 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
13344
13345 Here's an example:
13346
13347 @lisp
13348 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
13349 @end lisp
13350
13351 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
13352 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
13353 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
13354 default values.
13355
13356 The following mail source types are available:
13357
13358 @table @code
13359 @item file
13360 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
13361
13362 Keywords:
13363
13364 @table @code
13365 @item :path
13366 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
13367 environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
13368 (usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
13369
13370 @item :prescript
13371 @itemx :postscript
13372 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13373 @end table
13374
13375 An example file mail source:
13376
13377 @lisp
13378 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
13379 @end lisp
13380
13381 Or using the default file name:
13382
13383 @lisp
13384 (file)
13385 @end lisp
13386
13387 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
13388 to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
13389 You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
13390 mail spool while moving the mail.
13391
13392 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
13393
13394 @lisp
13395 (setq mail-sources
13396 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
13397 @end lisp
13398
13399 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
13400
13401 @example
13402 #!/bin/sh
13403 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
13404 # flu@@iki.fi
13405
13406 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
13407 TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
13408 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
13409 @end example
13410
13411 Alter this script to fit find the @samp{movemail} you want to use.
13412
13413
13414 @item directory
13415 @vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
13416 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
13417 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
13418 That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
13419 directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
13420 will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
13421 to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
13422 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
13423 Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
13424 if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
13425
13426 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13427 There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
13428 that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
13429 applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
13430
13431 Keywords:
13432
13433 @table @code
13434 @item :path
13435 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
13436 value.
13437
13438 @item :suffix
13439 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
13440 @samp{.spool}.
13441
13442 @item :predicate
13443 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
13444 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
13445 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
13446 predicate are considered.
13447
13448 @item :prescript
13449 @itemx :postscript
13450 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13451
13452 @end table
13453
13454 An example directory mail source:
13455
13456 @lisp
13457 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
13458 :suffix ".prcml")
13459 @end lisp
13460
13461 @item pop
13462 Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
13463
13464 Keywords:
13465
13466 @table @code
13467 @item :server
13468 The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
13469 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13470
13471 @item :port
13472 The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (eg,
13473 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (eg, @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
13474 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
13475 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
13476 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
13477
13478 @item :user
13479 The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
13480 name.
13481
13482 @item :password
13483 The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
13484 the user is prompted.
13485
13486 @item :program
13487 The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
13488 should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
13489
13490 @example
13491 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
13492 @end example
13493
13494 The valid format specifier characters are:
13495
13496 @table @samp
13497 @item t
13498 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
13499 included in this string.
13500
13501 @item s
13502 The name of the server.
13503
13504 @item P
13505 The port number of the server.
13506
13507 @item u
13508 The user name to use.
13509
13510 @item p
13511 The password to use.
13512 @end table
13513
13514 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13515 corresponding keywords.
13516
13517 @item :prescript
13518 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13519 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13520
13521 @item :postscript
13522 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13523 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13524
13525 @item :function
13526 The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
13527 function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
13528 mail should be moved to.
13529
13530 @item :authentication
13531 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
13532 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
13533 @code{password}.
13534
13535 @end table
13536
13537 @vindex pop3-movemail
13538 @vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
13539 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
13540 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used. If the
13541 @code{pop3-leave-mail-on-server} is non-@code{nil} the mail is to be
13542 left on the @acronym{POP} server after fetching when using
13543 @code{pop3-movemail}. Note that POP servers maintain no state
13544 information between sessions, so what the client believes is there and
13545 what is actually there may not match up. If they do not, then the whole
13546 thing can fall apart and leave you with a corrupt mailbox.
13547
13548 Here are some examples. Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server,
13549 using the default user name, and default fetcher:
13550
13551 @lisp
13552 (pop)
13553 @end lisp
13554
13555 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
13556
13557 @lisp
13558 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
13559 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
13560 @end lisp
13561
13562 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
13563
13564 @lisp
13565 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
13566 @end lisp
13567
13568 @item maildir
13569 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
13570 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
13571 contains exactly one mail.
13572
13573 Keywords:
13574
13575 @table @code
13576 @item :path
13577 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
13578 taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
13579 @file{~/Maildir/}.
13580 @item :subdirs
13581 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
13582 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
13583
13584 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
13585 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
13586 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
13587 @c below.
13588
13589 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
13590 from locking problems).
13591
13592 @end table
13593
13594 Two example maildir mail sources:
13595
13596 @lisp
13597 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
13598 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
13599 @end lisp
13600
13601 @lisp
13602 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
13603 :subdirs ("new"))
13604 @end lisp
13605
13606 @item imap
13607 Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
13608 @acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (ie
13609 with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
13610 to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
13611 @acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{IMAP}, for more information.
13612
13613 Note that for the Kerberos, GSSAPI, @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} and STARTTLS support you
13614 may need external programs and libraries, @xref{IMAP}.
13615
13616 Keywords:
13617
13618 @table @code
13619 @item :server
13620 The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
13621 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13622
13623 @item :port
13624 The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
13625 @samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
13626
13627 @item :user
13628 The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
13629 name.
13630
13631 @item :password
13632 The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
13633 prompted.
13634
13635 @item :stream
13636 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
13637 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
13638 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
13639 @samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
13640
13641 @item :authentication
13642 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
13643 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
13644 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
13645 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
13646
13647 @item :program
13648 When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
13649 mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
13650 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
13651
13652 @example
13653 ssh %s imapd
13654 @end example
13655
13656 The valid format specifier characters are:
13657
13658 @table @samp
13659 @item s
13660 The name of the server.
13661
13662 @item l
13663 User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
13664
13665 @item p
13666 The port number of the server.
13667 @end table
13668
13669 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13670 corresponding keywords.
13671
13672 @item :mailbox
13673 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
13674 which normally is the mailbox which receive incoming mail.
13675
13676 @item :predicate
13677 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
13678 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
13679 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
13680 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
13681 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
13682 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
13683
13684 @item :fetchflag
13685 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
13686 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
13687 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
13688 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
13689
13690 @item :dontexpunge
13691 If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
13692 mailbox after finishing the fetch.
13693
13694 @end table
13695
13696 An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
13697
13698 @lisp
13699 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
13700 :stream kerberos4
13701 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
13702 @end lisp
13703
13704 @item webmail
13705 Get mail from a webmail server, such as @uref{http://www.hotmail.com/},
13706 @uref{http://webmail.netscape.com/}, @uref{http://www.netaddress.com/},
13707 @uref{http://mail.yahoo.com/}.
13708
13709 NOTE: Webmail largely depends on cookies. A "one-line-cookie" patch is
13710 required for url "4.0pre.46".
13711
13712 WARNING: Mails may be lost. NO WARRANTY.
13713
13714 Keywords:
13715
13716 @table @code
13717 @item :subtype
13718 The type of the webmail server. The default is @code{hotmail}. The
13719 alternatives are @code{netscape}, @code{netaddress}, @code{my-deja}.
13720
13721 @item :user
13722 The user name to give to the webmail server. The default is the login
13723 name.
13724
13725 @item :password
13726 The password to give to the webmail server. If not specified, the user is
13727 prompted.
13728
13729 @item :dontexpunge
13730 If non-@code{nil}, only fetch unread articles and don't move them to
13731 trash folder after finishing the fetch.
13732
13733 @end table
13734
13735 An example webmail source:
13736
13737 @lisp
13738 (webmail :subtype 'hotmail
13739 :user "user-name"
13740 :password "secret")
13741 @end lisp
13742 @end table
13743
13744 @table @dfn
13745 @item Common Keywords
13746 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
13747
13748 Keywords:
13749
13750 @table @code
13751 @item :plugged
13752 If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
13753 use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
13754 example:
13755
13756 @lisp
13757 (setq mail-sources
13758 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
13759 :suffix ""
13760 :plugged t)))
13761 @end lisp
13762
13763 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
13764 useful when you use local mail and news.
13765
13766 @end table
13767 @end table
13768
13769 @subsubsection Function Interface
13770
13771 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
13772 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
13773 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
13774 consider the following mail-source setting:
13775
13776 @lisp
13777 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
13778 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
13779 @end lisp
13780
13781 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
13782 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
13783 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
13784 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
13785 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
13786
13787 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
13788
13789
13790 @node Mail Source Customization
13791 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
13792
13793 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
13794 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
13795 variables.
13796
13797 @table @code
13798 @item mail-source-crash-box
13799 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
13800 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
13801 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
13802
13803 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
13804 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
13805 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
13806 @code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
13807 files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
13808 (This will only happen, when receiving new mail). You may also set
13809 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
13810 @code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
13811
13812 @item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
13813 @vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
13814 If non-@code{nil}, ask for for confirmation before deleting old incoming
13815 files. This variable only applies when
13816 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
13817
13818 @item mail-source-ignore-errors
13819 @vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
13820 If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
13821
13822 @item mail-source-directory
13823 @vindex mail-source-directory
13824 Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
13825 default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
13826 is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
13827 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
13828
13829 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
13830 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
13831 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
13832 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
13833 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
13834 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil}.
13835
13836 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
13837 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
13838 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is 384.
13839
13840 @item mail-source-movemail-program
13841 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
13842 If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
13843 @code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
13844
13845 @end table
13846
13847
13848 @node Fetching Mail
13849 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
13850
13851 @vindex mail-sources
13852 @vindex nnmail-spool-file
13853 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
13854 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
13855 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
13856
13857 If this variable (and the obsolescent @code{nnmail-spool-file}) is
13858 @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to fetch mail by
13859 themselves.
13860
13861 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
13862 @acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
13863
13864 @lisp
13865 (setq mail-sources
13866 '((file)
13867 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
13868 :password "secret")))
13869 @end lisp
13870
13871 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
13872
13873 @lisp
13874 (setq mail-sources
13875 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
13876 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
13877 :user "user-name"
13878 :port "pop3"
13879 :password "secret")))
13880 @end lisp
13881
13882
13883 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
13884 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
13885 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
13886 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
13887 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
13888 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
13889
13890
13891
13892 @node Mail Back End Variables
13893 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
13894
13895 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
13896 mail back ends.
13897
13898 @table @code
13899 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
13900 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
13901 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
13902 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
13903
13904 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
13905 @item nnmail-split-hook
13906 @findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
13907 @cindex RFC 1522 decoding
13908 @cindex RFC 2047 decoding
13909 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
13910 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
13911 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
13912 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
13913 in the buffer will show up in any files.
13914 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
13915 to this hook.
13916
13917 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13918 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13919 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13920 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13921 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
13922 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
13923 starting to handle the new mail) and
13924 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
13925 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
13926 default file modes the new mail files get:
13927
13928 @lisp
13929 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13930 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 511)))
13931
13932 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13933 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 551)))
13934 @end lisp
13935
13936 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
13937 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
13938 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
13939 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
13940 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
13941 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
13942 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
13943
13944 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
13945 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
13946 @findex delete-file
13947 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
13948
13949 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
13950 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
13951 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
13952 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
13953 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
13954
13955 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
13956 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
13957 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
13958 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
13959 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
13960
13961 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
13962 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
13963 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
13964
13965 @end table
13966
13967
13968 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
13969 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
13970 @cindex mail splitting
13971 @cindex fancy mail splitting
13972
13973 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
13974 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
13975 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
13976 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
13977 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
13978 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
13979
13980 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
13981
13982 @lisp
13983 ;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
13984 ;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
13985 ;; @r{from real errors.}
13986 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
13987 "mail.misc"))
13988 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
13989 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
13990 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
13991 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
13992 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
13993 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
13994 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
13995 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
13996 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
13997 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
13998 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
13999 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
14000 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
14001 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
14002 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
14003 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
14004 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
14005 "misc.misc")
14006 @end lisp
14007
14008 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
14009 (possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
14010 splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
14011
14012 @table @code
14013
14014 @item group
14015 If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
14016 regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
14017
14018 @item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split})
14019 If the split is a list, the first element of which is a string, then
14020 store the message as specified by @var{split}, if header @var{field}
14021 (a regexp) contains @var{value} (also a regexp). If @var{restrict}
14022 (yet another regexp) matches some string after @var{field} and before
14023 the end of the matched @var{value}, the @var{split} is ignored. If
14024 none of the @var{restrict} clauses match, @var{split} is processed.
14025
14026 @item (| @var{split} @dots{})
14027 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
14028 bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
14029 @var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
14030 stored in one or more groups.
14031
14032 @item (& @var{split} @dots{})
14033 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
14034 process all @var{split}s in the list.
14035
14036 @item junk
14037 If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
14038 this message. Use with extreme caution.
14039
14040 @item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
14041 If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
14042 second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
14043 arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
14044
14045 @cindex body split
14046 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
14047 body of the messages:
14048
14049 @lisp
14050 (defun split-on-body ()
14051 (save-excursion
14052 (save-restriction
14053 (widen)
14054 (goto-char (point-min))
14055 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
14056 "string.group"))))
14057 @end lisp
14058
14059 The buffer is narrowed to the message in question when @var{function}
14060 is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called after
14061 @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
14062 above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
14063 not be downloaded by default. You need to set
14064 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
14065 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
14066
14067 @item (! @var{func} @var{split})
14068 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
14069 @var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
14070 function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
14071 should return a split.
14072
14073 @item nil
14074 If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
14075
14076 @end table
14077
14078 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
14079 @var{value} must match a complete word according to the fundamental mode
14080 syntax table. You can use @code{.*} in the regexps to match partial
14081 field names or words. In other words, all @var{value}'s are wrapped in
14082 @samp{\<} and @samp{\>} pairs.
14083
14084 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
14085 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
14086 they are expanded as specified by the variable
14087 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
14088 where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
14089 contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
14090 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
14091
14092 @table @code
14093 @item from
14094 Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
14095 @item to
14096 Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
14097 @samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
14098 @item any
14099 Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
14100 @end table
14101
14102 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
14103 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
14104 when all this splitting is performed.
14105
14106 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
14107 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
14108 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
14109
14110 @example
14111 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
14112 @end example
14113
14114 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
14115 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
14116
14117 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
14118 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
14119 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
14120 groupings 1 through 9.
14121
14122 @vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
14123 Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
14124 lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
14125 Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
14126 groups when users send to an address using different case
14127 (i.e. mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
14128 is @code{t}.
14129
14130 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
14131 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} controls whether partial
14132 words are matched during fancy splitting.
14133
14134 Normally, regular expressions given in @code{nnmail-split-fancy} are
14135 implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers, which are word
14136 delimiters. If this variable is true, they are not implicitly
14137 surrounded by anything.
14138
14139 @example
14140 (any "joe" "joemail")
14141 @end example
14142
14143 In this example, messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will
14144 normally not be filed in @samp{joemail}. With
14145 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} set to t, however, the
14146 match will happen. In effect, the requirement of a word boundary is
14147 removed and instead the match becomes more like a grep.
14148
14149 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
14150 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
14151 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
14152 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
14153 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
14154 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
14155 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
14156 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
14157 it once per thread.
14158
14159 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
14160 and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
14161 value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
14162 using the colon feature, like so:
14163 @lisp
14164 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
14165 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
14166 nnmail-split-fancy
14167 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
14168 ;; @r{other splits go here}
14169 ))
14170 @end lisp
14171
14172 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
14173 non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
14174 in the file specified by the variable
14175 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
14176 (the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
14177 invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
14178 at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
14179 and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
14180 for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
14181 corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
14182 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
14183 recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
14184 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
14185 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
14186 300 kBytes in size.)
14187 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14188 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
14189 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
14190 messages goes into the new group.
14191
14192 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
14193 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
14194 outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
14195 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
14196 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
14197 ``outgoing'' group.
14198
14199
14200 @node Group Mail Splitting
14201 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
14202 @cindex mail splitting
14203 @cindex group mail splitting
14204
14205 @findex gnus-group-split
14206 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
14207 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
14208 You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
14209 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
14210 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
14211 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
14212 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
14213 @code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
14214
14215 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
14216 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
14217 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
14218 rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
14219
14220 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
14221 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
14222 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
14223 @code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
14224 matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
14225 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
14226 @code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
14227
14228 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
14229 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
14230 parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
14231 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
14232 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
14233 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
14234 @code{gnus-group-split}.
14235
14236 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
14237 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
14238 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
14239 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
14240 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
14241 some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
14242 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
14243 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
14244 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
14245 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
14246 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
14247 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
14248 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
14249
14250 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
14251 been defined:
14252
14253 @example
14254 nnml:mail.bar:
14255 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
14256 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
14257 nnml:mail.foo:
14258 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
14259 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
14260 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
14261 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
14262 nnml:mail.others:
14263 ((split-spec . catch-all))
14264 @end example
14265
14266 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
14267 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
14268 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
14269
14270 @lisp
14271 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
14272 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
14273 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
14274 "mail.others")
14275 @end lisp
14276
14277 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
14278 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
14279 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
14280 splits like this:
14281
14282 @lisp
14283 (: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
14284 @end lisp
14285
14286 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
14287 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
14288 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
14289 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
14290 fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
14291 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
14292 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
14293 Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
14294 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
14295
14296 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
14297 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
14298 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
14299 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
14300 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
14301 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
14302 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
14303 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
14304 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
14305
14306 @findex gnus-group-split-update
14307 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
14308 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
14309 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
14310 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
14311 you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
14312
14313 @lisp
14314 (gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
14315 @end lisp
14316
14317 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
14318 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
14319 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
14320 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
14321 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
14322 value.
14323
14324 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
14325 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
14326 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
14327 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
14328
14329 @node Incorporating Old Mail
14330 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
14331 @cindex incorporating old mail
14332 @cindex import old mail
14333
14334 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
14335 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
14336 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
14337 your mail groups.
14338
14339 Doing so can be quite easy.
14340
14341 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
14342 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
14343 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
14344 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
14345 your @code{nnml} groups.
14346
14347 Here's how:
14348
14349 @enumerate
14350 @item
14351 Go to the group buffer.
14352
14353 @item
14354 Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
14355 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
14356
14357 @item
14358 Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
14359
14360 @item
14361 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
14362 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
14363
14364 @item
14365 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
14366 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
14367 @end enumerate
14368
14369 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
14370 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
14371 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
14372 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
14373 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
14374
14375 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
14376 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
14377 using the new mail back end.
14378
14379
14380 @node Expiring Mail
14381 @subsection Expiring Mail
14382 @cindex article expiry
14383
14384 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
14385 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
14386 different approach to mail reading.
14387
14388 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
14389 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
14390 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
14391 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
14392 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
14393 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
14394 course.
14395
14396 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
14397 articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
14398 that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
14399 will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
14400 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
14401 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
14402 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
14403 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
14404 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
14405
14406 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
14407 two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
14408 with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
14409 for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
14410 considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
14411 the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
14412 @samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} and so on are considered
14413 expirable.
14414
14415 When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
14416 who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
14417 and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
14418 (@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
14419 into its own group.)
14420
14421 Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
14422 answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
14423 advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
14424 the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
14425 between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
14426 only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
14427 total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
14428 Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
14429 scoring.
14430
14431 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14432 Groups that match the regular expression
14433 @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
14434 read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
14435 expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
14436
14437 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
14438 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
14439 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
14440 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
14441 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14442
14443 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
14444 @lisp
14445 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
14446 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
14447 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
14448 @end lisp
14449
14450 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
14451 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
14452 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
14453 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
14454 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
14455
14456 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
14457 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
14458
14459 @lisp
14460 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14461 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
14462 @end lisp
14463
14464 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
14465 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
14466
14467 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
14468 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
14469 don't really mix very well.
14470
14471 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
14472 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
14473 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
14474 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
14475 days.
14476
14477 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
14478 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
14479 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
14480 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
14481 everywhere else:
14482
14483 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14484 @lisp
14485 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14486 (lambda (group)
14487 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
14488 31)
14489 ((string= group "mail.junk")
14490 1)
14491 ((string= group "important")
14492 'never)
14493 (t
14494 6))))
14495 @end lisp
14496
14497 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
14498 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
14499
14500 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
14501 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
14502 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
14503 @code{never}.
14504
14505 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
14506 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
14507
14508 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
14509 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
14510 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
14511 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
14512 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
14513 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
14514 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
14515 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
14516 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
14517 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
14518 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
14519 from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
14520 name or @code{delete}.
14521
14522 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
14523 @lisp
14524 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
14525 @end lisp
14526
14527 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14528 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14529 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
14530 expire mail to groups according to the variable
14531 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
14532
14533 @lisp
14534 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14535 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14536 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
14537 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
14538 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
14539 @end lisp
14540
14541 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
14542 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
14543 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
14544 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
14545 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
14546 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
14547
14548 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
14549 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
14550 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
14551 easier for procmail users.
14552
14553 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
14554 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
14555 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
14556 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
14557 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
14558 caution. Even more dangerous is the
14559 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
14560 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
14561 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
14562 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
14563 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
14564 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
14565 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
14566 with! So there!
14567
14568 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
14569
14570 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
14571 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
14572 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
14573 auto-expire turned on.
14574
14575
14576 @node Washing Mail
14577 @subsection Washing Mail
14578 @cindex mail washing
14579 @cindex list server brain damage
14580 @cindex incoming mail treatment
14581
14582 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
14583 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
14584 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
14585 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
14586 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
14587 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
14588
14589 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
14590 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
14591 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
14592 laugh.
14593
14594 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
14595 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
14596 storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
14597 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
14598
14599 @table @code
14600 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14601 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14602 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
14603 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
14604 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
14605
14606 @table @code
14607 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14608 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14609 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
14610 Emacs running on MS machines.
14611
14612 @end table
14613
14614 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14615 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14616 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
14617 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
14618
14619 @table @code
14620 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14621 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14622 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
14623 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
14624
14625 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
14626 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
14627 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
14628 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
14629 into a feature by documenting it.)
14630
14631 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14632 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14633 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
14634 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
14635 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
14636 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
14637 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
14638 @code{\\(..\\)}.
14639
14640 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
14641 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
14642
14643 @lisp
14644 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
14645 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
14646 @end lisp
14647
14648 This can also be done non-destructively with
14649 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
14650
14651 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
14652 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
14653 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
14654
14655 @item nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14656 @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14657 @cindex Eudora
14658 Eudora produces broken @code{References} headers, but OK
14659 @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This function will get rid of the
14660 @code{References} headers.
14661
14662 @end table
14663
14664 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14665 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14666 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
14667 include:
14668
14669 @table @code
14670 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
14671 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
14672 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
14673
14674 @end table
14675 @end table
14676
14677
14678 @node Duplicates
14679 @subsection Duplicates
14680
14681 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
14682 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
14683 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
14684 @cindex duplicate mails
14685 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
14686 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
14687 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
14688 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
14689 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
14690 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
14691 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
14692 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
14693 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
14694 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
14695 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
14696 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
14697 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
14698
14699 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
14700 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
14701 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
14702 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
14703
14704 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
14705 @code{nil}.
14706
14707 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
14708 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
14709 methods:
14710
14711 @lisp
14712 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
14713 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
14714 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
14715 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
14716 (any mail "mail.misc")
14717 ;; @r{Other rules.}
14718 [...] ))
14719 @end lisp
14720 @noindent
14721 Or something like:
14722 @lisp
14723 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14724 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
14725 ;; @r{Other rules.}
14726 [...]))
14727 @end lisp
14728
14729 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
14730 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
14731 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
14732 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
14733 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
14734
14735
14736 @node Not Reading Mail
14737 @subsection Not Reading Mail
14738
14739 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
14740 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
14741 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
14742
14743 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
14744 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
14745 mail, which should help.
14746
14747 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14748 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
14749 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
14750 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
14751 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
14752 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
14753 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old Rmail
14754 file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
14755 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
14756 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
14757 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
14758
14759 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
14760 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
14761 incoming mail.
14762
14763
14764 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
14765 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
14766
14767 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
14768 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
14769 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
14770
14771 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
14772 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
14773 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
14774 Spool}).
14775
14776 @menu
14777 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
14778 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
14779 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
14780 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
14781 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
14782 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
14783 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
14784 @end menu
14785
14786
14787 @node Unix Mail Box
14788 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
14789 @cindex nnmbox
14790 @cindex unix mail box
14791
14792 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
14793 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
14794 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
14795 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
14796 which group it belongs in.
14797
14798 Virtual server settings:
14799
14800 @table @code
14801 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
14802 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
14803 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
14804 @file{~/mbox}.
14805
14806 @item nnmbox-active-file
14807 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
14808 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
14809 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
14810
14811 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
14812 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
14813 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
14814 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
14815 @end table
14816
14817
14818 @node Rmail Babyl
14819 @subsubsection Rmail Babyl
14820 @cindex nnbabyl
14821 @cindex Rmail mbox
14822
14823 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
14824 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
14825 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box (aka. @dfn{Rmail
14826 mbox}) to store mail. @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each
14827 mail article to say which group it belongs in.
14828
14829 Virtual server settings:
14830
14831 @table @code
14832 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
14833 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
14834 The name of the Rmail mbox file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
14835
14836 @item nnbabyl-active-file
14837 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
14838 The name of the active file for the rmail box. The default is
14839 @file{~/.rmail-active}
14840
14841 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14842 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14843 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
14844 @code{t}
14845 @end table
14846
14847
14848 @node Mail Spool
14849 @subsubsection Mail Spool
14850 @cindex nnml
14851 @cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
14852
14853 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
14854 format. It should be used with some caution.
14855
14856 @vindex nnml-directory
14857 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
14858 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
14859 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
14860 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
14861
14862 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
14863 care of all that.
14864
14865 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
14866 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
14867 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
14868 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
14869 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
14870 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
14871 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
14872 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
14873
14874 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
14875 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
14876 @acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
14877 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
14878
14879 @cindex self contained nnml servers
14880 @cindex marks
14881 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnml}
14882 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
14883 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
14884 proper @code{nnml} server) and have all your marks be preserved. Marks
14885 for a group is usually stored in the @code{.marks} file (but see
14886 @code{nnml-marks-file-name}) within each @code{nnml} group's directory.
14887 Individual @code{nnml} groups are also possible to backup, use @kbd{G m}
14888 to restore the group (after restoring the backup into the nnml
14889 directory).
14890
14891 If for some reason you believe your @file{.marks} files are screwed
14892 up, you can just delete them all. Gnus will then correctly regenerate
14893 them next time it starts.
14894
14895 Virtual server settings:
14896
14897 @table @code
14898 @item nnml-directory
14899 @vindex nnml-directory
14900 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
14901 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
14902 is @file{~/Mail}).
14903
14904 @item nnml-active-file
14905 @vindex nnml-active-file
14906 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
14907 @file{~/Mail/active}.
14908
14909 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
14910 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
14911 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
14912 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
14913
14914 @item nnml-get-new-mail
14915 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
14916 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
14917 @code{t}.
14918
14919 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
14920 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
14921 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
14922 default is @code{nil}.
14923
14924 @item nnml-nov-file-name
14925 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
14926 The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
14927
14928 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
14929 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
14930 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
14931
14932 @item nnml-marks-is-evil
14933 @vindex nnml-marks-is-evil
14934 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
14935 default is @code{nil}.
14936
14937 @item nnml-marks-file-name
14938 @vindex nnml-marks-file-name
14939 The name of the @dfn{marks} files. The default is @file{.marks}.
14940
14941 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
14942 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
14943 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
14944 files.
14945
14946 @end table
14947
14948 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
14949 If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
14950 whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
14951 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
14952 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
14953 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
14954 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
14955 Commands}).
14956
14957
14958 @node MH Spool
14959 @subsubsection MH Spool
14960 @cindex nnmh
14961 @cindex mh-e mail spool
14962
14963 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
14964 @acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
14965 file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
14966 @code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
14967 for.
14968
14969 Virtual server settings:
14970
14971 @table @code
14972 @item nnmh-directory
14973 @vindex nnmh-directory
14974 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
14975 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
14976 @file{~/Mail})
14977
14978 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
14979 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
14980 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
14981 @code{t}.
14982
14983 @item nnmh-be-safe
14984 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
14985 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
14986 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
14987 they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
14988 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
14989 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
14990 have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
14991 @end table
14992
14993
14994 @node Maildir
14995 @subsubsection Maildir
14996 @cindex nnmaildir
14997 @cindex maildir
14998
14999 @code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
15000 corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
15001 @uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
15002 @uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
15003 also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
15004 within a maildir.
15005
15006 Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
15007 reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
15008 your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
15009 configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
15010 can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
15011 configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
15012 that appear as group in Gnus.
15013
15014 @code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
15015 never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
15016 corrupt its data in the filesystem.
15017
15018 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
15019 maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
15020 another, and you will keep your marks.
15021
15022 Virtual server settings:
15023
15024 @table @code
15025 @item directory
15026 For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
15027 you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
15028 it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
15029 choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
15030 will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
15031 filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
15032 in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
15033 scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
15034 the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
15035 @code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
15036
15037 The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
15038 which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
15039 the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
15040 only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
15041 server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
15042 don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
15043 optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
15044 @code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
15045 use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
15046 if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
15047 value.
15048
15049 @item target-prefix
15050 This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
15051 @code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
15052 server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
15053 closed.
15054
15055 When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
15056 created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
15057 pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
15058 So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
15059 @code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
15060 the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
15061 @file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
15062 @file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
15063 @file{../maildirs/foo}.
15064
15065 You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
15066 create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
15067 this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
15068 with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
15069 symlinks pointing to them will be).
15070
15071 As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
15072 then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
15073 @code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
15074 cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
15075 @code{force} argument.
15076
15077 @item directory-files
15078 This should be a function with the same interface as
15079 @code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
15080 used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
15081 parameter is optional; the default is
15082 @code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
15083 @code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
15084 @code{directory-files} otherwise.
15085 (@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
15086 server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
15087 scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
15088
15089 @item get-new-mail
15090 If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
15091 maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
15092 the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
15093 @code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
15094 value is @code{nil}.
15095
15096 Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
15097 an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
15098 that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
15099 different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
15100 remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
15101 @end table
15102
15103 @subsubsection Group parameters
15104
15105 @code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
15106 all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
15107 default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
15108 one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
15109 functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
15110 you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
15111 another back end.
15112
15113 If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
15114 is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
15115 original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
15116 evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
15117 different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
15118 back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
15119 numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
15120 @code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
15121 quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
15122
15123 @table @code
15124 @item expire-age
15125 An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
15126 before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
15127 articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
15128 @code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
15129 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (overrideable by
15130 the @code{expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) group parameters. If you
15131 wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
15132 60 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
15133 An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
15134 modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
15135 delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
15136 article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
15137
15138 @item expire-group
15139 If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
15140 @example
15141 "backend+server.address.string:group.name"
15142 @end example
15143 and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
15144 to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
15145 before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
15146 group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
15147 was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
15148 destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
15149 the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
15150 you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
15151 article. So that form can refer to
15152 @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
15153 article. @emph{If this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir} does
15154 not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
15155 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
15156
15157 @item read-only
15158 If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
15159 in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
15160 from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
15161 @file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
15162 cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
15163 @file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
15164 containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
15165 maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
15166 a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
15167 have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
15168 contain extra copies of the articles.
15169
15170 @item directory-files
15171 A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
15172 used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
15173 group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
15174 server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
15175
15176 @item distrust-Lines:
15177 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
15178 article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
15179 @code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
15180
15181 @item always-marks
15182 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
15183 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15184 say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
15185 marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
15186 feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
15187 in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15188
15189 @item never-marks
15190 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
15191 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15192 say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
15193 stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
15194 @code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
15195 probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
15196 abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15197
15198 @item nov-cache-size
15199 An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
15200 speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
15201 for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
15202 worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
15203 parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
15204 the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
15205 The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
15206 and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
15207 that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
15208 that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
15209 @code{read}, plus a little extra.
15210 @end table
15211
15212 @subsubsection Article identification
15213 Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
15214 Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
15215 contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
15216 @code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
15217 the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
15218 identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
15219 @file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
15220 about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
15221 available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
15222 request the article in the summary buffer.
15223
15224 @subsubsection NOV data
15225 An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
15226 to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
15227 @code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
15228 @code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
15229 need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
15230 when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
15231 force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
15232 single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
15233 file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
15234 assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
15235 with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
15236
15237 @subsubsection Article marks
15238 An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
15239 @code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
15240 When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15241 looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
15242 asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15243 creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
15244 rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
15245 links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
15246
15247 You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
15248 @file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
15249 your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
15250 remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
15251 this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
15252 it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
15253 type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
15254 @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
15255 pick up the changes, and might undo them.
15256
15257
15258 @node Mail Folders
15259 @subsubsection Mail Folders
15260 @cindex nnfolder
15261 @cindex mbox folders
15262 @cindex mail folders
15263
15264 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
15265 separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
15266 @code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
15267 numbers and arrival dates.
15268
15269 @cindex self contained nnfolder servers
15270 @cindex marks
15271 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnfolder}
15272 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
15273 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
15274 proper @code{nnfolder} server) and have all your marks be preserved.
15275 Marks for a group is usually stored in a file named as the mbox file
15276 with @code{.mrk} concatenated to it (but see
15277 @code{nnfolder-marks-file-suffix}) within the @code{nnfolder}
15278 directory. Individual @code{nnfolder} groups are also possible to
15279 backup, use @kbd{G m} to restore the group (after restoring the backup
15280 into the @code{nnfolder} directory).
15281
15282 Virtual server settings:
15283
15284 @table @code
15285 @item nnfolder-directory
15286 @vindex nnfolder-directory
15287 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
15288 directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
15289 (whose default is @file{~/Mail})
15290
15291 @item nnfolder-active-file
15292 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
15293 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
15294
15295 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15296 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15297 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
15298 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
15299
15300 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
15301 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
15302 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
15303 default is @code{t}
15304
15305 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15306 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15307 @cindex backup files
15308 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
15309 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
15310 you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
15311 following in your @file{.emacs} file:
15312
15313 @lisp
15314 (defun turn-off-backup ()
15315 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
15316
15317 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
15318 @end lisp
15319
15320 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15321 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15322 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
15323 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
15324 extract some information from it before removing it.
15325
15326 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15327 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15328 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
15329 default is @code{nil}.
15330
15331 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15332 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15333 The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
15334
15335 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
15336 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
15337 The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
15338 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15339
15340 @item nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15341 @vindex nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15342 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
15343 default is @code{nil}.
15344
15345 @item nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15346 @vindex nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15347 The extension for @sc{marks} files. The default is @file{.mrk}.
15348
15349 @item nnfolder-marks-directory
15350 @vindex nnfolder-marks-directory
15351 The directory where the @sc{marks} files should be stored. If
15352 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15353
15354 @end table
15355
15356
15357 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
15358 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
15359 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
15360 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
15361 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
15362 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
15363 though.
15364
15365 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
15366 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
15367
15368 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
15369 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
15370 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
15371 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
15372 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
15373
15374 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
15375 typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
15376 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
15377 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
15378 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
15379 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
15380 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
15381 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
15382 via NFS).
15383
15384 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
15385 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
15386 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
15387 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
15388
15389 @table @code
15390 @item nnmbox
15391
15392 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-
15393 defined format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
15394 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
15395 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
15396 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
15397 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
15398 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
15399 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
15400 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
15401 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
15402 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
15403 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
15404 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
15405 what's where.
15406
15407 @item nnbabyl
15408
15409 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
15410 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
15411 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
15412 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
15413 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
15414 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
15415 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
15416 Rmail was Emacs' first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
15417 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
15418 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
15419 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
15420 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
15421 headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
15422 course, and is still maintained by Stallman.
15423
15424 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
15425 file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
15426 look at your mail.
15427
15428 @item nnml
15429
15430 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
15431 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
15432 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
15433 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
15434 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
15435 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
15436 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
15437 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
15438 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
15439 @acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
15440 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
15441 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
15442 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
15443 provided by the active file and overviews.
15444
15445 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
15446 resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
15447 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
15448 tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
15449 the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
15450 wins big.
15451
15452 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
15453 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
15454 tiny files.
15455
15456 @item nnmh
15457
15458 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
15459 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
15460 individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
15461 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
15462 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
15463 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
15464 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
15465
15466 @item nnfolder
15467
15468 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
15469 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
15470 itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
15471 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
15472 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
15473 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
15474 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
15475 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
15476 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
15477
15478 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
15479 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
15480 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
15481 friendly mail back end all over.
15482
15483 @item nnmaildir
15484
15485 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
15486 incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
15487 mail back ends.
15488
15489 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
15490 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
15491 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
15492 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
15493 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}. (Use
15494 @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this slows
15495 you down or takes up very much space, consider switching to
15496 @uref{http://www.namesys.com/, ReiserFS} or another non-block-structured
15497 file system.
15498
15499 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
15500 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
15501 This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
15502 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
15503 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
15504 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
15505 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
15506 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
15507 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
15508 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
15509 undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
15510
15511 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
15512 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
15513 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
15514 else, and still have your marks. @code{nnml} also stores marks, but
15515 it's not as easy to work with them from outside Gnus as with
15516 @code{nnmaildir}.
15517
15518 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
15519 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
15520 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
15521 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
15522 parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
15523 would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
15524 removed in the future.
15525
15526 Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
15527 back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
15528 on your file system.
15529
15530 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
15531 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
15532
15533 @end table
15534
15535
15536 @node Browsing the Web
15537 @section Browsing the Web
15538 @cindex web
15539 @cindex browsing the web
15540 @cindex www
15541 @cindex http
15542
15543 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
15544 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
15545 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
15546 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
15547 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
15548 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
15549 even know what a news group is.
15550
15551 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
15552 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
15553 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
15554 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
15555 you mad in the end.
15556
15557 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
15558 to do it instead?
15559
15560 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
15561 interfaces to these sources.
15562
15563 @menu
15564 * Archiving Mail::
15565 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
15566 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
15567 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
15568 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
15569 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
15570 * Customizing w3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/w3 from Gnus.
15571 @end menu
15572
15573 All the web sources require Emacs/w3 and the url library to work.
15574
15575 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
15576 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
15577 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
15578 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
15579 though, you should be ok.
15580
15581 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
15582 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
15583 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
15584 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
15585 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
15586
15587 @node Archiving Mail
15588 @subsection Archiving Mail
15589 @cindex archiving mail
15590 @cindex backup of mail
15591
15592 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
15593 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
15594 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
15595 marks is fairly simple.
15596
15597 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
15598 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
15599 though.)
15600
15601 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
15602 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
15603 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
15604 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
15605 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
15606 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
15607 might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
15608 before you restore the data.
15609
15610 It is also possible to archive individual @code{nnml},
15611 @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir} groups, while preserving marks.
15612 For @code{nnml} or @code{nnmaildir}, you copy all files in the group's
15613 directory. For @code{nnfolder} you need to copy both the base folder
15614 file itself (@file{FOO}, say), and the marks file (@file{FOO.mrk} in
15615 this example). Restoring the group is done with @kbd{G m} from the Group
15616 buffer. The last step makes Gnus notice the new directory.
15617 @code{nnmaildir} notices the new directory automatically, so @kbd{G m}
15618 is unnecessary in that case.
15619
15620 @node Web Searches
15621 @subsection Web Searches
15622 @cindex nnweb
15623 @cindex Google
15624 @cindex dejanews
15625 @cindex gmane
15626 @cindex Usenet searches
15627 @cindex searching the Usenet
15628
15629 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
15630 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
15631 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
15632 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
15633 searches without having to use a browser.
15634
15635 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
15636 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
15637 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
15638 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
15639 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
15640
15641 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
15642 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
15643 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
15644 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
15645 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
15646 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
15647 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
15648 engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
15649 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
15650 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
15651 group as read.
15652
15653 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
15654 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
15655 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'être} is to
15656 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
15657 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
15658 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
15659
15660 You must have the @code{url} and @code{w3} package installed to be able
15661 to use @code{nnweb}.
15662
15663 Virtual server variables:
15664
15665 @table @code
15666 @item nnweb-type
15667 @vindex nnweb-type
15668 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
15669 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
15670 @code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
15671
15672 @item nnweb-search
15673 @vindex nnweb-search
15674 The search string to feed to the search engine.
15675
15676 @item nnweb-max-hits
15677 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
15678 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
15679 999.
15680
15681 @item nnweb-type-definition
15682 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
15683 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
15684 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
15685 present:
15686
15687 @table @code
15688 @item article
15689 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
15690 understands.
15691
15692 @item map
15693 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
15694
15695 @item search
15696 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
15697
15698 @item address
15699 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
15700 to.
15701
15702 @item id
15703 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
15704 @end table
15705
15706 @end table
15707
15708
15709 @node Slashdot
15710 @subsection Slashdot
15711 @cindex Slashdot
15712 @cindex nnslashdot
15713
15714 @uref{http://slashdot.org/, Slashdot} is a popular news site, with
15715 lively discussion following the news articles. @code{nnslashdot} will
15716 let you read this forum in a convenient manner.
15717
15718 The easiest way to read this source is to put something like the
15719 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
15720
15721 @lisp
15722 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
15723 '((nnslashdot "")))
15724 @end lisp
15725
15726 This will make Gnus query the @code{nnslashdot} back end for new comments
15727 and groups. The @kbd{F} command will subscribe each new news article as
15728 a new Gnus group, and you can read the comments by entering these
15729 groups. (Note that the default subscription method is to subscribe new
15730 groups as zombies. Other methods are available (@pxref{Subscription
15731 Methods}).
15732
15733 If you want to remove an old @code{nnslashdot} group, the @kbd{G DEL}
15734 command is the most handy tool (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
15735
15736 When following up to @code{nnslashdot} comments (or posting new
15737 comments), some light @acronym{HTML}izations will be performed. In
15738 particular, text quoted with @samp{> } will be quoted with
15739 @samp{blockquote} instead, and signatures will have @samp{br} added to
15740 the end of each line. Other than that, you can just write @acronym{HTML}
15741 directly into the message buffer. Note that Slashdot filters out some
15742 @acronym{HTML} forms.
15743
15744 The following variables can be altered to change its behavior:
15745
15746 @table @code
15747 @item nnslashdot-threaded
15748 Whether @code{nnslashdot} should display threaded groups or not. The
15749 default is @code{t}. To be able to display threads, @code{nnslashdot}
15750 has to retrieve absolutely all comments in a group upon entry. If a
15751 threaded display is not required, @code{nnslashdot} will only retrieve
15752 the comments that are actually wanted by the user. Threading is nicer,
15753 but much, much slower than unthreaded.
15754
15755 @item nnslashdot-login-name
15756 @vindex nnslashdot-login-name
15757 The login name to use when posting.
15758
15759 @item nnslashdot-password
15760 @vindex nnslashdot-password
15761 The password to use when posting.
15762
15763 @item nnslashdot-directory
15764 @vindex nnslashdot-directory
15765 Where @code{nnslashdot} will store its files. The default is
15766 @file{~/News/slashdot/}.
15767
15768 @item nnslashdot-active-url
15769 @vindex nnslashdot-active-url
15770 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the
15771 information on news articles and comments. The default is@*
15772 @samp{http://slashdot.org/search.pl?section=&min=%d}.
15773
15774 @item nnslashdot-comments-url
15775 @vindex nnslashdot-comments-url
15776 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch comments.
15777
15778 @item nnslashdot-article-url
15779 @vindex nnslashdot-article-url
15780 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the news
15781 article. The default is
15782 @samp{http://slashdot.org/article.pl?sid=%s&mode=nocomment}.
15783
15784 @item nnslashdot-threshold
15785 @vindex nnslashdot-threshold
15786 The score threshold. The default is -1.
15787
15788 @item nnslashdot-group-number
15789 @vindex nnslashdot-group-number
15790 The number of old groups, in addition to the ten latest, to keep
15791 updated. The default is 0.
15792
15793 @end table
15794
15795
15796
15797 @node Ultimate
15798 @subsection Ultimate
15799 @cindex nnultimate
15800 @cindex Ultimate Bulletin Board
15801
15802 @uref{http://www.ultimatebb.com/, The Ultimate Bulletin Board} is
15803 probably the most popular Web bulletin board system used. It has a
15804 quite regular and nice interface, and it's possible to get the
15805 information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
15806
15807 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnultimate} is to say
15808 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnultimate RET
15809 http://www.tcj.com/messboard/ubbcgi/ RET}. (Substitute the @acronym{URL}
15810 (not including @samp{Ultimate.cgi} or the like at the end) for a forum
15811 you're interested in; there's quite a list of them on the Ultimate web
15812 site.) Then subscribe to the groups you're interested in from the
15813 server buffer, and read them from the group buffer.
15814
15815 The following @code{nnultimate} variables can be altered:
15816
15817 @table @code
15818 @item nnultimate-directory
15819 @vindex nnultimate-directory
15820 The directory where @code{nnultimate} stores its files. The default is@*
15821 @file{~/News/ultimate/}.
15822 @end table
15823
15824
15825 @node Web Archive
15826 @subsection Web Archive
15827 @cindex nnwarchive
15828 @cindex Web Archive
15829
15830 Some mailing lists only have archives on Web servers, such as
15831 @uref{http://www.egroups.com/} and
15832 @uref{http://www.mail-archive.com/}. It has a quite regular and nice
15833 interface, and it's possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep
15834 groups updated.
15835
15836 @findex gnus-group-make-warchive-group
15837 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnwarchive} is to say
15838 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{M-x
15839 gnus-group-make-warchive-group RET @var{an_egroup} RET egroups RET
15840 www.egroups.com RET @var{your@@email.address} RET}. (Substitute the
15841 @var{an_egroup} with the mailing list you subscribed, the
15842 @var{your@@email.address} with your email address.), or to browse the
15843 back end by @kbd{B nnwarchive RET mail-archive RET}.
15844
15845 The following @code{nnwarchive} variables can be altered:
15846
15847 @table @code
15848 @item nnwarchive-directory
15849 @vindex nnwarchive-directory
15850 The directory where @code{nnwarchive} stores its files. The default is@*
15851 @file{~/News/warchive/}.
15852
15853 @item nnwarchive-login
15854 @vindex nnwarchive-login
15855 The account name on the web server.
15856
15857 @item nnwarchive-passwd
15858 @vindex nnwarchive-passwd
15859 The password for your account on the web server.
15860 @end table
15861
15862 @node RSS
15863 @subsection RSS
15864 @cindex nnrss
15865 @cindex RSS
15866
15867 Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
15868 @acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
15869 sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
15870 presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
15871 changes to a wiki (e.g. @url{http://cliki.net/recent-changes.rdf}).
15872
15873 @acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
15874 possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
15875
15876 @kindex G R (Summary)
15877 Use @kbd{G R} from the summary buffer to subscribe to a feed---you
15878 will be prompted for the location of the feed.
15879
15880 An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
15881 the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
15882 subscribe to groups.
15883
15884 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
15885
15886 @table @code
15887 @item nnrss-directory
15888 @vindex nnrss-directory
15889 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
15890 @file{~/News/rss/}.
15891
15892 @item nnrss-use-local
15893 @vindex nnrss-use-local
15894 @findex nnrss-generate-download-script
15895 If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
15896 the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
15897 the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
15898 download script using @command{wget}.
15899 @end table
15900
15901 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
15902 the summary buffer.
15903
15904 @lisp
15905 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
15906 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
15907
15908 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
15909 (let ((descr
15910 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
15911 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
15912 @end lisp
15913
15914 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
15915 summary buffer.
15916 @lisp
15917 (require 'browse-url)
15918
15919 (defun browse-nnrss-url( arg )
15920 (interactive "p")
15921 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
15922 (mail-header-extra
15923 (gnus-data-header
15924 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
15925 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
15926 (if url
15927 (progn
15928 (browse-url (cdr url))
15929 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
15930 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
15931
15932 (eval-after-load "gnus"
15933 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
15934 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
15935 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
15936 @end lisp
15937
15938 @node Customizing w3
15939 @subsection Customizing w3
15940 @cindex w3
15941 @cindex html
15942 @cindex url
15943 @cindex Netscape
15944
15945 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/w3 to display web
15946 pages. Emacs/w3 is documented in its own manual, but there are some
15947 things that may be more relevant for Gnus users.
15948
15949 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/w3 follow links
15950 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
15951 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
15952
15953 @lisp
15954 (eval-after-load "w3"
15955 '(progn
15956 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
15957 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
15958 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
15959 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
15960 (browse-url url)
15961 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
15962 @end lisp
15963
15964 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in w3-rendered
15965 @acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
15966 follow the link.
15967
15968
15969 @node IMAP
15970 @section IMAP
15971 @cindex nnimap
15972 @cindex @acronym{IMAP}
15973
15974 @acronym{IMAP} is a network protocol for reading mail (or news, or @dots{}),
15975 think of it as a modernized @acronym{NNTP}. Connecting to a @acronym{IMAP}
15976 server is much similar to connecting to a news server, you just
15977 specify the network address of the server.
15978
15979 @acronym{IMAP} has two properties. First, @acronym{IMAP} can do
15980 everything that @acronym{POP} can, it can hence be viewed as a
15981 @acronym{POP++}. Secondly, @acronym{IMAP} is a mail storage protocol,
15982 similar to @acronym{NNTP} being a news storage protocol---however,
15983 @acronym{IMAP} offers more features than @acronym{NNTP} because news
15984 is more or less read-only whereas mail is read-write.
15985
15986 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a @acronym{POP++}, use an imap
15987 entry in @code{mail-sources}. With this, Gnus will fetch mails from
15988 the @acronym{IMAP} server and store them on the local disk. This is
15989 not the usage described in this section---@xref{Mail Sources}.
15990
15991 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a mail storage protocol, use an nnimap
15992 entry in @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}. With this, Gnus will
15993 manipulate mails stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server. This is the kind of
15994 usage explained in this section.
15995
15996 A server configuration in @file{~/.gnus.el} with a few @acronym{IMAP}
15997 servers might look something like the following. (Note that for
15998 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you need external programs and libraries,
15999 see below.)
16000
16001 @lisp
16002 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
16003 '((nnimap "simpleserver") ; @r{no special configuration}
16004 ; @r{perhaps a ssh port forwarded server:}
16005 (nnimap "dolk"
16006 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16007 (nnimap-server-port 1430))
16008 ; @r{a UW server running on localhost}
16009 (nnimap "barbar"
16010 (nnimap-server-port 143)
16011 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16012 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "mail/*")))
16013 ; @r{anonymous public cyrus server:}
16014 (nnimap "cyrus.andrew.cmu.edu"
16015 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous)
16016 (nnimap-list-pattern "archive.*")
16017 (nnimap-stream network))
16018 ; @r{a ssl server on a non-standard port:}
16019 (nnimap "vic20"
16020 (nnimap-address "vic20.somewhere.com")
16021 (nnimap-server-port 9930)
16022 (nnimap-stream ssl))))
16023 @end lisp
16024
16025 After defining the new server, you can subscribe to groups on the
16026 server using normal Gnus commands such as @kbd{U} in the Group Buffer
16027 (@pxref{Subscription Commands}) or via the Server Buffer
16028 (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
16029
16030 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nnimap}
16031 server:
16032
16033 @table @code
16034
16035 @item nnimap-address
16036 @vindex nnimap-address
16037
16038 The address of the remote @acronym{IMAP} server. Defaults to the virtual
16039 server name if not specified.
16040
16041 @item nnimap-server-port
16042 @vindex nnimap-server-port
16043 Port on server to contact. Defaults to port 143, or 993 for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}.
16044
16045 Note that this should be an integer, example server specification:
16046
16047 @lisp
16048 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16049 (nnimap-server-port 4711))
16050 @end lisp
16051
16052 @item nnimap-list-pattern
16053 @vindex nnimap-list-pattern
16054 String or list of strings of mailboxes to limit available groups to.
16055 This is used when the server has very many mailboxes and you're only
16056 interested in a few---some servers export your home directory via
16057 @acronym{IMAP}, you'll probably want to limit the mailboxes to those in
16058 @file{~/Mail/*} then.
16059
16060 The string can also be a cons of REFERENCE and the string as above, what
16061 REFERENCE is used for is server specific, but on the University of
16062 Washington server it's a directory that will be concatenated with the
16063 mailbox.
16064
16065 Example server specification:
16066
16067 @lisp
16068 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16069 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "Mail/*" "alt.sex.*"
16070 ("~friend/Mail/" . "list/*"))))
16071 @end lisp
16072
16073 @item nnimap-stream
16074 @vindex nnimap-stream
16075 The type of stream used to connect to your server. By default, nnimap
16076 will detect and automatically use all of the below, with the exception
16077 of @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}. (@acronym{IMAP} over
16078 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is being replaced by STARTTLS, which can
16079 be automatically detected, but it's not widely deployed yet.)
16080
16081 Example server specification:
16082
16083 @lisp
16084 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16085 (nnimap-stream ssl))
16086 @end lisp
16087
16088 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-stream} is a symbol!
16089
16090 @itemize @bullet
16091 @item
16092 @dfn{gssapi:} Connect with GSSAPI (usually Kerberos 5). Requires the
16093 @samp{gsasl} or @samp{imtest} program.
16094 @item
16095 @dfn{kerberos4:} Connect with Kerberos 4. Requires the @samp{imtest} program.
16096 @item
16097 @dfn{starttls:} Connect via the STARTTLS extension (similar to
16098 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}). Requires the external library @samp{starttls.el} and program
16099 @samp{starttls}.
16100 @item
16101 @dfn{tls:} Connect through @acronym{TLS}. Requires GNUTLS (the program
16102 @samp{gnutls-cli}).
16103 @item
16104 @dfn{ssl:} Connect through @acronym{SSL}. Requires OpenSSL (the program
16105 @samp{openssl}) or SSLeay (@samp{s_client}).
16106 @item
16107 @dfn{shell:} Use a shell command to start @acronym{IMAP} connection.
16108 @item
16109 @dfn{network:} Plain, TCP/IP network connection.
16110 @end itemize
16111
16112 @vindex imap-kerberos4-program
16113 The @samp{imtest} program is shipped with Cyrus IMAPD. If you're
16114 using @samp{imtest} from Cyrus IMAPD < 2.0.14 (which includes version
16115 1.5.x and 1.6.x) you need to frob @code{imap-process-connection-type}
16116 to make @code{imap.el} use a pty instead of a pipe when communicating
16117 with @samp{imtest}. You will then suffer from a line length
16118 restrictions on @acronym{IMAP} commands, which might make Gnus seem to hang
16119 indefinitely if you have many articles in a mailbox. The variable
16120 @code{imap-kerberos4-program} contain parameters to pass to the imtest
16121 program.
16122
16123 For @acronym{TLS} connection, the @code{gnutls-cli} program from GNUTLS is
16124 needed. It is available from
16125 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/}.
16126
16127 @vindex imap-gssapi-program
16128 This parameter specifies a list of command lines that invoke a GSSAPI
16129 authenticated @acronym{IMAP} stream in a subshell. They are tried
16130 sequentially until a connection is made, or the list has been
16131 exhausted. By default, @samp{gsasl} from GNU SASL, available from
16132 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gsasl/}, and the @samp{imtest}
16133 program from Cyrus IMAPD (see @code{imap-kerberos4-program}), are
16134 tried.
16135
16136 @vindex imap-ssl-program
16137 For @acronym{SSL} connections, the OpenSSL program is available from
16138 @uref{http://www.openssl.org/}. OpenSSL was formerly known as SSLeay,
16139 and nnimap support it too---although the most recent versions of
16140 SSLeay, 0.9.x, are known to have serious bugs making it
16141 useless. Earlier versions, especially 0.8.x, of SSLeay are known to
16142 work. The variable @code{imap-ssl-program} contain parameters to pass
16143 to OpenSSL/SSLeay.
16144
16145 @vindex imap-shell-program
16146 @vindex imap-shell-host
16147 For @acronym{IMAP} connections using the @code{shell} stream, the variable
16148 @code{imap-shell-program} specify what program to call.
16149
16150 @item nnimap-authenticator
16151 @vindex nnimap-authenticator
16152
16153 The authenticator used to connect to the server. By default, nnimap
16154 will use the most secure authenticator your server is capable of.
16155
16156 Example server specification:
16157
16158 @lisp
16159 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16160 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous))
16161 @end lisp
16162
16163 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-authenticator} is a symbol!
16164
16165 @itemize @bullet
16166 @item
16167 @dfn{gssapi:} GSSAPI (usually kerberos 5) authentication. Requires
16168 external program @code{gsasl} or @code{imtest}.
16169 @item
16170 @dfn{kerberos4:} Kerberos 4 authentication. Requires external program
16171 @code{imtest}.
16172 @item
16173 @dfn{digest-md5:} Encrypted username/password via DIGEST-MD5. Requires
16174 external library @code{digest-md5.el}.
16175 @item
16176 @dfn{cram-md5:} Encrypted username/password via CRAM-MD5.
16177 @item
16178 @dfn{login:} Plain-text username/password via LOGIN.
16179 @item
16180 @dfn{anonymous:} Login as ``anonymous'', supplying your email address as password.
16181 @end itemize
16182
16183 @item nnimap-expunge-on-close
16184 @cindex expunging
16185 @vindex nnimap-expunge-on-close
16186 Unlike Parmenides the @acronym{IMAP} designers have decided things that
16187 don't exist actually do exist. More specifically, @acronym{IMAP} has
16188 this concept of marking articles @code{Deleted} which doesn't actually
16189 delete them, and this (marking them @code{Deleted}, that is) is what
16190 nnimap does when you delete an article in Gnus (with @kbd{B DEL} or
16191 similar).
16192
16193 Since the articles aren't really removed when we mark them with the
16194 @code{Deleted} flag we'll need a way to actually delete them. Feel like
16195 running in circles yet?
16196
16197 Traditionally, nnimap has removed all articles marked as @code{Deleted}
16198 when closing a mailbox but this is now configurable by this server
16199 variable.
16200
16201 The possible options are:
16202
16203 @table @code
16204
16205 @item always
16206 The default behavior, delete all articles marked as ``Deleted'' when
16207 closing a mailbox.
16208 @item never
16209 Never actually delete articles. Currently there is no way of showing
16210 the articles marked for deletion in nnimap, but other @acronym{IMAP} clients
16211 may allow you to do this. If you ever want to run the EXPUNGE command
16212 manually, @xref{Expunging mailboxes}.
16213 @item ask
16214 When closing mailboxes, nnimap will ask if you wish to expunge deleted
16215 articles or not.
16216
16217 @end table
16218
16219 @item nnimap-importantize-dormant
16220 @vindex nnimap-importantize-dormant
16221
16222 If non-@code{nil} (the default), marks dormant articles as ticked (as
16223 well), for other @acronym{IMAP} clients. Within Gnus, dormant articles will
16224 naturally still (only) be marked as dormant. This is to make dormant
16225 articles stand out, just like ticked articles, in other @acronym{IMAP}
16226 clients. (In other words, Gnus has two ``Tick'' marks and @acronym{IMAP}
16227 has only one.)
16228
16229 Probably the only reason for frobing this would be if you're trying
16230 enable per-user persistent dormant flags, using something like:
16231
16232 @lisp
16233 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-flag-alist)
16234 (format "gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16235 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-predicate-alist)
16236 (format "KEYWORD gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16237 @end lisp
16238
16239 In this case, you would not want the per-user dormant flag showing up
16240 as ticked for other users.
16241
16242 @item nnimap-expunge-search-string
16243 @cindex expunging
16244 @vindex nnimap-expunge-search-string
16245
16246 This variable contain the @acronym{IMAP} search command sent to server when
16247 searching for articles eligible for expiring. The default is
16248 @code{"UID %s NOT SINCE %s"}, where the first @code{%s} is replaced by
16249 UID set and the second @code{%s} is replaced by a date.
16250
16251 Probably the only useful value to change this to is
16252 @code{"UID %s NOT SENTSINCE %s"}, which makes nnimap use the Date: in
16253 messages instead of the internal article date. See section 6.4.4 of
16254 RFC 2060 for more information on valid strings.
16255
16256 @item nnimap-authinfo-file
16257 @vindex nnimap-authinfo-file
16258
16259 A file containing credentials used to log in on servers. The format is
16260 (almost) the same as the @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file. See the
16261 variable @code{nntp-authinfo-file} for exact syntax; also see
16262 @ref{NNTP}. An example of an .authinfo line for an IMAP server, is:
16263
16264 @example
16265 machine students.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis port imap
16266 @end example
16267
16268 Note that it should be @code{port imap}, or @code{port 143}, if you
16269 use a @code{nnimap-stream} of @code{tls} or @code{ssl}, even if the
16270 actual port number used is port 993 for secured IMAP. For
16271 convenience, Gnus will accept @code{port imaps} as a synonym of
16272 @code{port imap}.
16273
16274 @item nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16275 @vindex nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16276
16277 Unselect mailboxes before looking for new mail in them. Some servers
16278 seem to need this under some circumstances; it was reported that
16279 Courier 1.7.1 did.
16280
16281 @end table
16282
16283 @menu
16284 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
16285 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
16286 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
16287 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
16288 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
16289 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
16290 @end menu
16291
16292
16293
16294 @node Splitting in IMAP
16295 @subsection Splitting in IMAP
16296 @cindex splitting imap mail
16297
16298 Splitting is something Gnus users have loved and used for years, and now
16299 the rest of the world is catching up. Yeah, dream on, not many
16300 @acronym{IMAP} servers have server side splitting and those that have
16301 splitting seem to use some non-standard protocol. This means that
16302 @acronym{IMAP} support for Gnus has to do its own splitting.
16303
16304 And it does.
16305
16306 (Incidentally, people seem to have been dreaming on, and Sieve has
16307 gaining a market share and is supported by several IMAP servers.
16308 Fortunately, Gnus support it too, @xref{Sieve Commands}.)
16309
16310 Here are the variables of interest:
16311
16312 @table @code
16313
16314 @item nnimap-split-crosspost
16315 @cindex splitting, crosspost
16316 @cindex crosspost
16317 @vindex nnimap-split-crosspost
16318
16319 If non-@code{nil}, do crossposting if several split methods match the
16320 mail. If @code{nil}, the first match in @code{nnimap-split-rule}
16321 found will be used.
16322
16323 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-crosspost}.
16324
16325 @item nnimap-split-inbox
16326 @cindex splitting, inbox
16327 @cindex inbox
16328 @vindex nnimap-split-inbox
16329
16330 A string or a list of strings that gives the name(s) of @acronym{IMAP}
16331 mailboxes to split from. Defaults to @code{nil}, which means that
16332 splitting is disabled!
16333
16334 @lisp
16335 (setq nnimap-split-inbox
16336 '("INBOX" ("~/friend/Mail" . "lists/*") "lists.imap"))
16337 @end lisp
16338
16339 No nnmail equivalent.
16340
16341 @item nnimap-split-rule
16342 @cindex splitting, rules
16343 @vindex nnimap-split-rule
16344
16345 New mail found in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be split according to
16346 this variable.
16347
16348 This variable contains a list of lists, where the first element in the
16349 sublist gives the name of the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox to move articles
16350 matching the regexp in the second element in the sublist. Got that?
16351 Neither did I, we need examples.
16352
16353 @lisp
16354 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16355 '(("INBOX.nnimap"
16356 "^Sender: owner-nnimap@@vic20.globalcom.se")
16357 ("INBOX.junk" "^Subject:.*MAKE MONEY")
16358 ("INBOX.private" "")))
16359 @end lisp
16360
16361 This will put all articles from the nnimap mailing list into mailbox
16362 INBOX.nnimap, all articles containing MAKE MONEY in the Subject: line
16363 into INBOX.junk and everything else in INBOX.private.
16364
16365 The first string may contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by
16366 replace-match to insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For
16367 instance:
16368
16369 @lisp
16370 ("INBOX.lists.\\1" "^Sender: owner-\\([a-z-]+\\)@@")
16371 @end lisp
16372
16373 The first element can also be the symbol @code{junk} to indicate that
16374 matching messages should simply be deleted. Use with care.
16375
16376 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
16377 called with the first element of the rule as the argument, in a buffer
16378 containing the headers of the article. It should return a
16379 non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the mail belongs in that group.
16380
16381 Nnmail users might recollect that the last regexp had to be empty to
16382 match all articles (like in the example above). This is not required in
16383 nnimap. Articles not matching any of the regexps will not be moved out
16384 of your inbox. (This might affect performance if you keep lots of
16385 unread articles in your inbox, since the splitting code would go over
16386 them every time you fetch new mail.)
16387
16388 These rules are processed from the beginning of the alist toward the
16389 end. The first rule to make a match will ``win'', unless you have
16390 crossposting enabled. In that case, all matching rules will ``win''.
16391
16392 This variable can also have a function as its value, the function will
16393 be called with the headers narrowed and should return a group where it
16394 thinks the article should be split to. See @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16395
16396 The splitting code tries to create mailboxes if it needs to.
16397
16398 To allow for different split rules on different virtual servers, and
16399 even different split rules in different inboxes on the same server,
16400 the syntax of this variable have been extended along the lines of:
16401
16402 @lisp
16403 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16404 '(("my1server" (".*" (("ding" "ding@@gnus.org")
16405 ("junk" "From:.*Simon"))))
16406 ("my2server" ("INBOX" nnimap-split-fancy))
16407 ("my[34]server" (".*" (("private" "To:.*Simon")
16408 ("junk" my-junk-func))))))
16409 @end lisp
16410
16411 The virtual server name is in fact a regexp, so that the same rules
16412 may apply to several servers. In the example, the servers
16413 @code{my3server} and @code{my4server} both use the same rules.
16414 Similarly, the inbox string is also a regexp. The actual splitting
16415 rules are as before, either a function, or a list with group/regexp or
16416 group/function elements.
16417
16418 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
16419
16420 @item nnimap-split-predicate
16421 @cindex splitting
16422 @vindex nnimap-split-predicate
16423
16424 Mail matching this predicate in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be
16425 split, it is a string and the default is @samp{UNSEEN UNDELETED}.
16426
16427 This might be useful if you use another @acronym{IMAP} client to read mail in
16428 your inbox but would like Gnus to split all articles in the inbox
16429 regardless of readedness. Then you might change this to
16430 @samp{UNDELETED}.
16431
16432 @item nnimap-split-fancy
16433 @cindex splitting, fancy
16434 @findex nnimap-split-fancy
16435 @vindex nnimap-split-fancy
16436
16437 It's possible to set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16438 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} if you want to use fancy
16439 splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
16440
16441 However, to be able to have different fancy split rules for nnmail and
16442 nnimap back ends you can set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16443 @code{nnimap-split-fancy} and define the nnimap specific fancy split
16444 rule in @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16445
16446 Example:
16447
16448 @lisp
16449 (setq nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
16450 nnimap-split-fancy ...)
16451 @end lisp
16452
16453 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
16454
16455 @item nnimap-split-download-body
16456 @findex nnimap-split-download-body
16457 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
16458
16459 Set to non-@code{nil} to download entire articles during splitting.
16460 This is generally not required, and will slow things down
16461 considerably. You may need it if you want to use an advanced
16462 splitting function that analyses the body to split the article.
16463
16464 @end table
16465
16466 @node Expiring in IMAP
16467 @subsection Expiring in IMAP
16468 @cindex expiring imap mail
16469
16470 Even though @code{nnimap} is not a proper @code{nnmail} derived back
16471 end, it supports most features in regular expiring (@pxref{Expiring
16472 Mail}). Unlike splitting in @acronym{IMAP} (@pxref{Splitting in
16473 IMAP}) it does not clone the @code{nnmail} variables (i.e., creating
16474 @var{nnimap-expiry-wait}) but reuse the @code{nnmail} variables. What
16475 follows below are the variables used by the @code{nnimap} expiry
16476 process.
16477
16478 A note on how the expire mark is stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server is
16479 appropriate here as well. The expire mark is translated into a
16480 @code{imap} client specific mark, @code{gnus-expire}, and stored on the
16481 message. This means that likely only Gnus will understand and treat
16482 the @code{gnus-expire} mark properly, although other clients may allow
16483 you to view client specific flags on the message. It also means that
16484 your server must support permanent storage of client specific flags on
16485 messages. Most do, fortunately.
16486
16487 @table @code
16488
16489 @item nnmail-expiry-wait
16490 @item nnmail-expiry-wait-function
16491
16492 These variables are fully supported. The expire value can be a
16493 number, the symbol @code{immediate} or @code{never}.
16494
16495 @item nnmail-expiry-target
16496
16497 This variable is supported, and internally implemented by calling the
16498 @code{nnmail} functions that handle this. It contains an optimization
16499 that if the destination is a @acronym{IMAP} group on the same server, the
16500 article is copied instead of appended (that is, uploaded again).
16501
16502 @end table
16503
16504 @node Editing IMAP ACLs
16505 @subsection Editing IMAP ACLs
16506 @cindex editing imap acls
16507 @cindex Access Control Lists
16508 @cindex Editing @acronym{IMAP} ACLs
16509 @kindex G l (Group)
16510 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-edit-acl
16511
16512 ACL stands for Access Control List. ACLs are used in @acronym{IMAP} for
16513 limiting (or enabling) other users access to your mail boxes. Not all
16514 @acronym{IMAP} servers support this, this function will give an error if it
16515 doesn't.
16516
16517 To edit an ACL for a mailbox, type @kbd{G l}
16518 (@code{gnus-group-edit-nnimap-acl}) and you'll be presented with an ACL
16519 editing window with detailed instructions.
16520
16521 Some possible uses:
16522
16523 @itemize @bullet
16524 @item
16525 Giving ``anyone'' the ``lrs'' rights (lookup, read, keep seen/unseen flags)
16526 on your mailing list mailboxes enables other users on the same server to
16527 follow the list without subscribing to it.
16528 @item
16529 At least with the Cyrus server, you are required to give the user
16530 ``anyone'' posting ("p") capabilities to have ``plussing'' work (that is,
16531 mail sent to user+mailbox@@domain ending up in the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox
16532 INBOX.mailbox).
16533 @end itemize
16534
16535 @node Expunging mailboxes
16536 @subsection Expunging mailboxes
16537 @cindex expunging
16538
16539 @cindex expunge
16540 @cindex manual expunging
16541 @kindex G x (Group)
16542 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-expunge
16543
16544 If you're using the @code{never} setting of @code{nnimap-expunge-on-close},
16545 you may want the option of expunging all deleted articles in a mailbox
16546 manually. This is exactly what @kbd{G x} does.
16547
16548 Currently there is no way of showing deleted articles, you can just
16549 delete them.
16550
16551 @node A note on namespaces
16552 @subsection A note on namespaces
16553 @cindex IMAP namespace
16554 @cindex namespaces
16555
16556 The @acronym{IMAP} protocol has a concept called namespaces, described
16557 by the following text in the RFC:
16558
16559 @display
16560 5.1.2. Mailbox Namespace Naming Convention
16561
16562 By convention, the first hierarchical element of any mailbox name
16563 which begins with "#" identifies the "namespace" of the remainder of
16564 the name. This makes it possible to disambiguate between different
16565 types of mailbox stores, each of which have their own namespaces.
16566
16567 For example, implementations which offer access to USENET
16568 newsgroups MAY use the "#news" namespace to partition the USENET
16569 newsgroup namespace from that of other mailboxes. Thus, the
16570 comp.mail.misc newsgroup would have an mailbox name of
16571 "#news.comp.mail.misc", and the name "comp.mail.misc" could refer
16572 to a different object (e.g. a user's private mailbox).
16573 @end display
16574
16575 While there is nothing in this text that warrants concern for the
16576 @acronym{IMAP} implementation in Gnus, some servers use namespace
16577 prefixes in a way that does not work with how Gnus uses mailbox names.
16578
16579 Specifically, University of Washington's @acronym{IMAP} server uses
16580 mailbox names like @code{#driver.mbx/read-mail} which are valid only
16581 in the @sc{create} and @sc{append} commands. After the mailbox is
16582 created (or a messages is appended to a mailbox), it must be accessed
16583 without the namespace prefix, i.e. @code{read-mail}. Since Gnus do
16584 not make it possible for the user to guarantee that user entered
16585 mailbox names will only be used with the CREATE and APPEND commands,
16586 you should simply not use the namespace prefixed mailbox names in
16587 Gnus.
16588
16589 See the UoW IMAPD documentation for the @code{#driver.*/} prefix
16590 for more information on how to use the prefixes. They are a power
16591 tool and should be used only if you are sure what the effects are.
16592
16593 @node Debugging IMAP
16594 @subsection Debugging IMAP
16595 @cindex IMAP debugging
16596 @cindex protocol dump (IMAP)
16597
16598 @acronym{IMAP} is a complex protocol, more so than @acronym{NNTP} or
16599 @acronym{POP3}. Implementation bugs are not unlikely, and we do our
16600 best to fix them right away. If you encounter odd behaviour, chances
16601 are that either the server or Gnus is buggy.
16602
16603 If you are familiar with network protocols in general, you will
16604 probably be able to extract some clues from the protocol dump of the
16605 exchanges between Gnus and the server. Even if you are not familiar
16606 with network protocols, when you include the protocol dump in
16607 @acronym{IMAP}-related bug reports you are helping us with data
16608 critical to solving the problem. Therefore, we strongly encourage you
16609 to include the protocol dump when reporting IMAP bugs in Gnus.
16610
16611
16612 @vindex imap-log
16613 Because the protocol dump, when enabled, generates lots of data, it is
16614 disabled by default. You can enable it by setting @code{imap-log} as
16615 follows:
16616
16617 @lisp
16618 (setq imap-log t)
16619 @end lisp
16620
16621 This instructs the @code{imap.el} package to log any exchanges with
16622 the server. The log is stored in the buffer @samp{*imap-log*}. Look
16623 for error messages, which sometimes are tagged with the keyword
16624 @code{BAD}---but when submitting a bug, make sure to include all the
16625 data.
16626
16627 @node Other Sources
16628 @section Other Sources
16629
16630 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
16631 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
16632 newsgroups.
16633
16634 @menu
16635 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
16636 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
16637 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
16638 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
16639 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
16640 @end menu
16641
16642
16643 @node Directory Groups
16644 @subsection Directory Groups
16645 @cindex nndir
16646 @cindex directory groups
16647
16648 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
16649 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
16650 names, of course.
16651
16652 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
16653 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
16654 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
16655 back end to read directories. Big deal.
16656
16657 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
16658 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
16659 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
16660 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
16661 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
16662
16663 @code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
16664
16665 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
16666 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
16667 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
16668 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
16669
16670
16671 @node Anything Groups
16672 @subsection Anything Groups
16673 @cindex nneething
16674
16675 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
16676 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
16677 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
16678 true.
16679
16680 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
16681 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
16682 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
16683 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
16684 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
16685 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
16686 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
16687 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g. a C source file),
16688 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
16689 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
16690 elements.
16691
16692 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
16693 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
16694 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
16695 in the article buffer, just as usual.
16696
16697 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
16698 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
16699 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
16700 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
16701
16702 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
16703 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
16704 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
16705 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
16706 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
16707 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
16708 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
16709 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
16710
16711 Some variables:
16712
16713 @table @code
16714 @item nneething-map-file-directory
16715 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
16716 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
16717 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
16718
16719 @item nneething-exclude-files
16720 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
16721 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
16722 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
16723
16724 @item nneething-include-files
16725 @vindex nneething-include-files
16726 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
16727 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
16728
16729 @item nneething-map-file
16730 @vindex nneething-map-file
16731 Name of the map files.
16732 @end table
16733
16734
16735 @node Document Groups
16736 @subsection Document Groups
16737 @cindex nndoc
16738 @cindex documentation group
16739 @cindex help group
16740
16741 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
16742 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
16743
16744 @table @code
16745 @cindex Babyl
16746 @cindex Rmail mbox
16747
16748 @item babyl
16749 The Babyl (Rmail) mail box.
16750 @cindex mbox
16751 @cindex Unix mbox
16752
16753 @item mbox
16754 The standard Unix mbox file.
16755
16756 @cindex MMDF mail box
16757 @item mmdf
16758 The MMDF mail box format.
16759
16760 @item news
16761 Several news articles appended into a file.
16762
16763 @item rnews
16764 @cindex rnews batch files
16765 The rnews batch transport format.
16766 @cindex forwarded messages
16767
16768 @item forward
16769 Forwarded articles.
16770
16771 @item nsmail
16772 Netscape mail boxes.
16773
16774 @item mime-parts
16775 @acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
16776
16777 @item standard-digest
16778 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
16779
16780 @item mime-digest
16781 A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
16782
16783 @item lanl-gov-announce
16784 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
16785
16786 @item rfc822-forward
16787 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
16788
16789 @item outlook
16790 The Outlook mail box.
16791
16792 @item oe-dbx
16793 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
16794
16795 @item exim-bounce
16796 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
16797
16798 @item forward
16799 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
16800
16801 @item rfc934
16802 An RFC934-forwarded message.
16803
16804 @item mailman
16805 A mailman digest.
16806
16807 @item clari-briefs
16808 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
16809
16810 @item slack-digest
16811 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
16812
16813 @item mail-in-mail
16814 The last resort.
16815 @end table
16816
16817 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
16818 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
16819 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
16820 file is.
16821
16822 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
16823 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
16824 group. And that's it.
16825
16826 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
16827 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
16828 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
16829 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
16830 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
16831 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
16832 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
16833 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
16834 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
16835 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
16836
16837 Virtual server variables:
16838
16839 @table @code
16840 @item nndoc-article-type
16841 @vindex nndoc-article-type
16842 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
16843 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
16844 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
16845 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
16846 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
16847
16848 @item nndoc-post-type
16849 @vindex nndoc-post-type
16850 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
16851 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
16852 and @code{news}.
16853 @end table
16854
16855 @menu
16856 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
16857 @end menu
16858
16859
16860 @node Document Server Internals
16861 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
16862
16863 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
16864 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
16865 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
16866 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
16867
16868 First, here's an example document type definition:
16869
16870 @example
16871 (mmdf
16872 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
16873 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
16874 @end example
16875
16876 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
16877 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
16878 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
16879 types can be defined with very few settings:
16880
16881 @table @code
16882 @item first-article
16883 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
16884 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
16885 totally ignored.
16886
16887 @item article-begin
16888 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
16889 says what the beginning of each article looks like.
16890
16891 @item head-begin-function
16892 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
16893 the article.
16894
16895 @item nndoc-head-begin
16896 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
16897 article.
16898
16899 @item nndoc-head-end
16900 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
16901 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
16902
16903 @item body-begin-function
16904 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
16905 of the article.
16906
16907 @item body-begin
16908 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
16909 to @samp{^\n}.
16910
16911 @item body-end-function
16912 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
16913 the article.
16914
16915 @item body-end
16916 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article.
16917
16918 @item file-end
16919 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
16920 regexp will be totally ignored.
16921
16922 @end table
16923
16924 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
16925 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
16926 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
16927 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
16928 something that's palatable for Gnus:
16929
16930 @table @code
16931 @item prepare-body-function
16932 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
16933 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
16934 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
16935
16936 @item article-transform-function
16937 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
16938 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
16939 body of the article.
16940
16941 @item generate-head-function
16942 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
16943 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
16944 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
16945 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
16946
16947 @end table
16948
16949 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
16950 digests:
16951
16952 @example
16953 (standard-digest
16954 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
16955 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
16956 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
16957 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
16958 (head-end . "^ ?$")
16959 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
16960 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
16961 (subtype digest guess))
16962 @end example
16963
16964 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
16965 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
16966 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
16967 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
16968 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
16969
16970 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
16971 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
16972 is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
16973 where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
16974 The alist is traversed sequentially, and
16975 @code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
16976 So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
16977 @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
16978 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
16979 is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
16980 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
16981 means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
16982
16983
16984 @node SOUP
16985 @subsection SOUP
16986 @cindex SOUP
16987 @cindex offline
16988
16989 In the PC world people often talk about ``offline'' newsreaders. These
16990 are thingies that are combined reader/news transport monstrosities.
16991 With built-in modem programs. Yecchh!
16992
16993 Of course, us Unix Weenie types of human beans use things like
16994 @code{uucp} and, like, @code{nntpd} and set up proper news and mail
16995 transport things like Ghod intended. And then we just use normal
16996 newsreaders.
16997
16998 However, it can sometimes be convenient to do something that's a bit
16999 easier on the brain if you have a very slow modem, and you're not really
17000 that interested in doing things properly.
17001
17002 A file format called @sc{soup} has been developed for transporting news
17003 and mail from servers to home machines and back again. It can be a bit
17004 fiddly.
17005
17006 First some terminology:
17007
17008 @table @dfn
17009
17010 @item server
17011 This is the machine that is connected to the outside world and where you
17012 get news and/or mail from.
17013
17014 @item home machine
17015 This is the machine that you want to do the actual reading and responding
17016 on. It is typically not connected to the rest of the world in any way.
17017
17018 @item packet
17019 Something that contains messages and/or commands. There are two kinds
17020 of packets:
17021
17022 @table @dfn
17023 @item message packets
17024 These are packets made at the server, and typically contain lots of
17025 messages for you to read. These are called @file{SoupoutX.tgz} by
17026 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17027
17028 @item response packets
17029 These are packets made at the home machine, and typically contains
17030 replies that you've written. These are called @file{SoupinX.tgz} by
17031 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17032
17033 @end table
17034
17035 @end table
17036
17037
17038 @enumerate
17039
17040 @item
17041 You log in on the server and create a @sc{soup} packet. You can either
17042 use a dedicated @sc{soup} thingie (like the @code{awk} program), or you
17043 can use Gnus to create the packet with its @sc{soup} commands (@kbd{O
17044 s} and/or @kbd{G s b}; and then @kbd{G s p}) (@pxref{SOUP Commands}).
17045
17046 @item
17047 You transfer the packet home. Rail, boat, car or modem will do fine.
17048
17049 @item
17050 You put the packet in your home directory.
17051
17052 @item
17053 You fire up Gnus on your home machine using the @code{nnsoup} back end as
17054 the native or secondary server.
17055
17056 @item
17057 You read articles and mail and answer and followup to the things you
17058 want (@pxref{SOUP Replies}).
17059
17060 @item
17061 You do the @kbd{G s r} command to pack these replies into a @sc{soup}
17062 packet.
17063
17064 @item
17065 You transfer this packet to the server.
17066
17067 @item
17068 You use Gnus to mail this packet out with the @kbd{G s s} command.
17069
17070 @item
17071 You then repeat until you die.
17072
17073 @end enumerate
17074
17075 So you basically have a bipartite system---you use @code{nnsoup} for
17076 reading and Gnus for packing/sending these @sc{soup} packets.
17077
17078 @menu
17079 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
17080 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
17081 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
17082 @end menu
17083
17084
17085 @node SOUP Commands
17086 @subsubsection SOUP Commands
17087
17088 These are commands for creating and manipulating @sc{soup} packets.
17089
17090 @table @kbd
17091 @item G s b
17092 @kindex G s b (Group)
17093 @findex gnus-group-brew-soup
17094 Pack all unread articles in the current group
17095 (@code{gnus-group-brew-soup}). This command understands the
17096 process/prefix convention.
17097
17098 @item G s w
17099 @kindex G s w (Group)
17100 @findex gnus-soup-save-areas
17101 Save all @sc{soup} data files (@code{gnus-soup-save-areas}).
17102
17103 @item G s s
17104 @kindex G s s (Group)
17105 @findex gnus-soup-send-replies
17106 Send all replies from the replies packet
17107 (@code{gnus-soup-send-replies}).
17108
17109 @item G s p
17110 @kindex G s p (Group)
17111 @findex gnus-soup-pack-packet
17112 Pack all files into a @sc{soup} packet (@code{gnus-soup-pack-packet}).
17113
17114 @item G s r
17115 @kindex G s r (Group)
17116 @findex nnsoup-pack-replies
17117 Pack all replies into a replies packet (@code{nnsoup-pack-replies}).
17118
17119 @item O s
17120 @kindex O s (Summary)
17121 @findex gnus-soup-add-article
17122 This summary-mode command adds the current article to a @sc{soup} packet
17123 (@code{gnus-soup-add-article}). It understands the process/prefix
17124 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
17125
17126 @end table
17127
17128
17129 There are a few variables to customize where Gnus will put all these
17130 thingies:
17131
17132 @table @code
17133
17134 @item gnus-soup-directory
17135 @vindex gnus-soup-directory
17136 Directory where Gnus will save intermediate files while composing
17137 @sc{soup} packets. The default is @file{~/SoupBrew/}.
17138
17139 @item gnus-soup-replies-directory
17140 @vindex gnus-soup-replies-directory
17141 This is what Gnus will use as a temporary directory while sending our
17142 reply packets. @file{~/SoupBrew/SoupReplies/} is the default.
17143
17144 @item gnus-soup-prefix-file
17145 @vindex gnus-soup-prefix-file
17146 Name of the file where Gnus stores the last used prefix. The default is
17147 @samp{gnus-prefix}.
17148
17149 @item gnus-soup-packer
17150 @vindex gnus-soup-packer
17151 A format string command for packing a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17152 @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupout%d.tgz}.
17153
17154 @item gnus-soup-unpacker
17155 @vindex gnus-soup-unpacker
17156 Format string command for unpacking a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17157 @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17158
17159 @item gnus-soup-packet-directory
17160 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-directory
17161 Where Gnus will look for reply packets. The default is @file{~/}.
17162
17163 @item gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17164 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17165 Regular expression matching @sc{soup} reply packets in
17166 @code{gnus-soup-packet-directory}.
17167
17168 @end table
17169
17170
17171 @node SOUP Groups
17172 @subsubsection SOUP Groups
17173 @cindex nnsoup
17174
17175 @code{nnsoup} is the back end for reading @sc{soup} packets. It will
17176 read incoming packets, unpack them, and put them in a directory where
17177 you can read them at leisure.
17178
17179 These are the variables you can use to customize its behavior:
17180
17181 @table @code
17182
17183 @item nnsoup-tmp-directory
17184 @vindex nnsoup-tmp-directory
17185 When @code{nnsoup} unpacks a @sc{soup} packet, it does it in this
17186 directory. (@file{/tmp/} by default.)
17187
17188 @item nnsoup-directory
17189 @vindex nnsoup-directory
17190 @code{nnsoup} then moves each message and index file to this directory.
17191 The default is @file{~/SOUP/}.
17192
17193 @item nnsoup-replies-directory
17194 @vindex nnsoup-replies-directory
17195 All replies will be stored in this directory before being packed into a
17196 reply packet. The default is @file{~/SOUP/replies/}.
17197
17198 @item nnsoup-replies-format-type
17199 @vindex nnsoup-replies-format-type
17200 The @sc{soup} format of the replies packets. The default is @samp{?n}
17201 (rnews), and I don't think you should touch that variable. I probably
17202 shouldn't even have documented it. Drats! Too late!
17203
17204 @item nnsoup-replies-index-type
17205 @vindex nnsoup-replies-index-type
17206 The index type of the replies packet. The default is @samp{?n}, which
17207 means ``none''. Don't fiddle with this one either!
17208
17209 @item nnsoup-active-file
17210 @vindex nnsoup-active-file
17211 Where @code{nnsoup} stores lots of information. This is not an ``active
17212 file'' in the @code{nntp} sense; it's an Emacs Lisp file. If you lose
17213 this file or mess it up in any way, you're dead. The default is
17214 @file{~/SOUP/active}.
17215
17216 @item nnsoup-packer
17217 @vindex nnsoup-packer
17218 Format string command for packing a reply @sc{soup} packet. The default
17219 is @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupin%d.tgz}.
17220
17221 @item nnsoup-unpacker
17222 @vindex nnsoup-unpacker
17223 Format string command for unpacking incoming @sc{soup} packets. The
17224 default is @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17225
17226 @item nnsoup-packet-directory
17227 @vindex nnsoup-packet-directory
17228 Where @code{nnsoup} will look for incoming packets. The default is
17229 @file{~/}.
17230
17231 @item nnsoup-packet-regexp
17232 @vindex nnsoup-packet-regexp
17233 Regular expression matching incoming @sc{soup} packets. The default is
17234 @samp{Soupout}.
17235
17236 @item nnsoup-always-save
17237 @vindex nnsoup-always-save
17238 If non-@code{nil}, save the replies buffer after each posted message.
17239
17240 @end table
17241
17242
17243 @node SOUP Replies
17244 @subsubsection SOUP Replies
17245
17246 Just using @code{nnsoup} won't mean that your postings and mailings end
17247 up in @sc{soup} reply packets automagically. You have to work a bit
17248 more for that to happen.
17249
17250 @findex nnsoup-set-variables
17251 The @code{nnsoup-set-variables} command will set the appropriate
17252 variables to ensure that all your followups and replies end up in the
17253 @sc{soup} system.
17254
17255 In specific, this is what it does:
17256
17257 @lisp
17258 (setq message-send-news-function 'nnsoup-request-post)
17259 (setq message-send-mail-function 'nnsoup-request-mail)
17260 @end lisp
17261
17262 And that's it, really. If you only want news to go into the @sc{soup}
17263 system you just use the first line. If you only want mail to be
17264 @sc{soup}ed you use the second.
17265
17266
17267 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
17268 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17269 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
17270 @cindex gateways
17271
17272 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17273 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17274 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
17275
17276 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17277 used to post with.
17278
17279 Server variables:
17280
17281 @table @code
17282 @item nngateway-address
17283 @vindex nngateway-address
17284 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
17285
17286 @item nngateway-header-transformation
17287 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17288 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17289 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17290 transformation should be called, and defaults to
17291 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17292 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17293 gateway address.
17294
17295 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17296 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17297 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
17298
17299 @example
17300 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17301 @end example
17302
17303 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
17304
17305 @example
17306 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17307 @end example
17308
17309 The following pre-defined functions exist:
17310
17311 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17312 @table @code
17313
17314 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17315 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17316 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
17317
17318 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17319
17320 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17321 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17322 @code{nngateway-address}.
17323 @end table
17324
17325 @end table
17326
17327 Here's an example:
17328
17329 @lisp
17330 (setq gnus-post-method
17331 '(nngateway
17332 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17333 (nngateway-header-transformation
17334 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17335 @end lisp
17336
17337 So, to use this, simply say something like:
17338
17339 @lisp
17340 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17341 @end lisp
17342
17343
17344
17345 @node Combined Groups
17346 @section Combined Groups
17347
17348 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17349 groups.
17350
17351 @menu
17352 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
17353 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
17354 @end menu
17355
17356
17357 @node Virtual Groups
17358 @subsection Virtual Groups
17359 @cindex nnvirtual
17360 @cindex virtual groups
17361 @cindex merging groups
17362
17363 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17364 other groups.
17365
17366 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17367 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17368 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
17369
17370 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17371 regexp to match component groups.
17372
17373 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17374 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17375 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17376 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17377 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17378 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17379 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17380 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
17381
17382 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17383 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
17384
17385 @lisp
17386 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17387 @end lisp
17388
17389 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17390 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
17391
17392 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17393 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17394 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17395 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
17396
17397 @example
17398 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17399 @end example
17400
17401 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17402 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17403 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
17404
17405 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17406 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17407 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17408 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17409 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
17410
17411 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17412 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17413 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
17414
17415 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17416 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} is non-@code{nil},
17417 @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread articles when
17418 entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
17419 default) and you read articles in a component group after the virtual
17420 group has been activated, the read articles from the component group
17421 will show up when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this
17422 effect if you have two virtual groups that have a component group in
17423 common. If that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}.
17424 Or you can just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before
17425 you enter it---it'll have much the same effect.
17426
17427 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17428 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17429 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17430 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17431 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17432 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17433 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
17434
17435 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17436 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
17437
17438 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17439 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17440 inherited.
17441
17442
17443 @node Kibozed Groups
17444 @subsection Kibozed Groups
17445 @cindex nnkiboze
17446 @cindex kibozing
17447
17448 @dfn{Kibozing} is defined by the @acronym{OED} as ``grepping through
17449 (parts of) the news feed''. @code{nnkiboze} is a back end that will
17450 do this for you. Oh joy! Now you can grind any @acronym{NNTP} server
17451 down to a halt with useless requests! Oh happiness!
17452
17453 @kindex G k (Group)
17454 To create a kibozed group, use the @kbd{G k} command in the group
17455 buffer.
17456
17457 The address field of the @code{nnkiboze} method is, as with
17458 @code{nnvirtual}, a regexp to match groups to be ``included'' in the
17459 @code{nnkiboze} group. That's where most similarities between
17460 @code{nnkiboze} and @code{nnvirtual} end.
17461
17462 In addition to this regexp detailing component groups, an
17463 @code{nnkiboze} group must have a score file to say what articles are
17464 to be included in the group (@pxref{Scoring}).
17465
17466 @kindex M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups
17467 @findex nnkiboze-generate-groups
17468 You must run @kbd{M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups} after creating the
17469 @code{nnkiboze} groups you want to have. This command will take time.
17470 Lots of time. Oodles and oodles of time. Gnus has to fetch the
17471 headers from all the articles in all the component groups and run them
17472 through the scoring process to determine if there are any articles in
17473 the groups that are to be part of the @code{nnkiboze} groups.
17474
17475 Please limit the number of component groups by using restrictive
17476 regexps. Otherwise your sysadmin may become annoyed with you, and the
17477 @acronym{NNTP} site may throw you off and never let you back in again.
17478 Stranger things have happened.
17479
17480 @code{nnkiboze} component groups do not have to be alive---they can be dead,
17481 and they can be foreign. No restrictions.
17482
17483 @vindex nnkiboze-directory
17484 The generation of an @code{nnkiboze} group means writing two files in
17485 @code{nnkiboze-directory}, which is @file{~/News/kiboze/} by default.
17486 One contains the @acronym{NOV} header lines for all the articles in
17487 the group, and the other is an additional @file{.newsrc} file to store
17488 information on what groups have been searched through to find
17489 component articles.
17490
17491 Articles marked as read in the @code{nnkiboze} group will have
17492 their @acronym{NOV} lines removed from the @acronym{NOV} file.
17493
17494
17495 @node Gnus Unplugged
17496 @section Gnus Unplugged
17497 @cindex offline
17498 @cindex unplugged
17499 @cindex agent
17500 @cindex Gnus agent
17501 @cindex Gnus unplugged
17502
17503 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
17504 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
17505 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
17506 read news. Believe it or not.
17507
17508 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
17509 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
17510 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
17511 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
17512 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
17513
17514 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
17515 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
17516 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
17517 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
17518 reading news on a machine.
17519
17520 Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
17521 fact, you don't even have to configure anything.
17522
17523 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
17524
17525 @menu
17526 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
17527 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
17528 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
17529 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
17530 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
17531 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
17532 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
17533 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
17534 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
17535 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
17536 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
17537 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
17538 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
17539 @end menu
17540
17541
17542 @node Agent Basics
17543 @subsection Agent Basics
17544
17545 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
17546
17547 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
17548 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
17549 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
17550 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
17551
17552 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
17553 connected to the net continuously.
17554
17555 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
17556 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
17557
17558 You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
17559 shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
17560 is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
17561 say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
17562 you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
17563
17564 Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
17565 that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
17566 can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
17567 servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
17568 they're kinda like plugged always).
17569
17570 So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
17571 connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
17572 servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
17573 the culprit.
17574
17575 Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
17576 reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
17577 server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
17578 server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
17579 will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
17580
17581 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
17582
17583 @itemize @bullet
17584
17585 @item
17586 @findex gnus-unplugged
17587 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
17588 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
17589 already fetched while in this mode.
17590
17591 @item
17592 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
17593 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
17594 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
17595 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
17596 Source Specifiers}).
17597
17598 @item
17599 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
17600 news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
17601 @kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
17602 all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
17603 articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
17604
17605 @item
17606 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
17607 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
17608 then you read the news offline.
17609
17610 @item
17611 And then you go to step 2.
17612 @end itemize
17613
17614 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
17615 the Agent.
17616
17617 @itemize @bullet
17618
17619 @item
17620 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
17621 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
17622 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
17623 @kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
17624 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
17625 added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
17626 all @code{nntp} and @code{nnimap} servers in @code{gnus-select-method} and
17627 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} are agentized.
17628
17629 @item
17630 Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
17631 you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
17632 parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
17633 is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
17634
17635 Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
17636 (@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
17637 to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
17638 parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
17639 to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
17640 your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
17641 configure them.
17642
17643 @item
17644 Uhm@dots{} that's it.
17645 @end itemize
17646
17647
17648 @node Agent Categories
17649 @subsection Agent Categories
17650
17651 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
17652 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
17653 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
17654 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
17655 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
17656 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
17657 you're interested in the articles anyway.
17658
17659 One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
17660 downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
17661 groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
17662 category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
17663 buffer for creating and managing categories.
17664
17665 If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
17666 Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
17667 alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
17668 difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
17669 less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
17670 sink.
17671
17672 Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
17673 a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
17674 the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
17675 parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
17676 variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
17677 of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
17678 your settings.
17679
17680 @menu
17681 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
17682 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
17683 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
17684 @end menu
17685
17686
17687 @node Category Syntax
17688 @subsubsection Category Syntax
17689
17690 A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
17691 category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
17692 customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
17693 listed below.
17694
17695 @cindex Agent Parameters
17696 @table @code
17697 @item gnus-agent-cat-name
17698 The name of the category.
17699
17700 @item gnus-agent-cat-groups
17701 The list of groups that are in this category.
17702
17703 @item gnus-agent-cat-predicate
17704 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
17705 are eligible for downloading; and
17706
17707 @item gnus-agent-cat-score-file
17708 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
17709 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
17710 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
17711
17712 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-expiration
17713 a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
17714 this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
17715 fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
17716 only groups that should not be expired.
17717
17718 @item gnus-agent-cat-days-until-old
17719 an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
17720 before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
17721
17722 @item gnus-agent-cat-low-score
17723 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
17724
17725 @item gnus-agent-cat-high-score
17726 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
17727
17728 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-short
17729 an integer that overrides the value of
17730 @code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
17731
17732 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-long
17733 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
17734
17735 @c @item gnus-agent-cat-disable-undownloaded-faces
17736 @c a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should @emph{not} display
17737 @c undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
17738 @c faces. The symbol nil will enable the use of undownloaded faces while
17739 @c all other symbols disable them.
17740
17741 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-undownloaded-faces
17742 a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
17743 undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
17744 faces. The symbol nil will disable the use of undownloaded faces while
17745 all other symbols enable them.
17746 @end table
17747
17748 The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
17749 created.
17750
17751 Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
17752 that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
17753 group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
17754 category.
17755
17756 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
17757 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
17758 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
17759 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
17760
17761 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
17762 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
17763 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
17764
17765 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
17766 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
17767 operators sprinkled in between.
17768
17769 Perhaps some examples are in order.
17770
17771 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
17772 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
17773
17774 @lisp
17775 short
17776 @end lisp
17777
17778 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
17779 short (for some value of ``short'').
17780
17781 Here's a more complex predicate:
17782
17783 @lisp
17784 (or high
17785 (and
17786 (not low)
17787 (not long)))
17788 @end lisp
17789
17790 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
17791 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
17792 drift.
17793
17794 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
17795 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
17796 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
17797
17798 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
17799 you want to do, you can write your own.
17800
17801 When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
17802 bound to the value determined by calling
17803 @code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
17804 example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
17805 @code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
17806 means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
17807 predicate to individual groups.
17808
17809 @table @code
17810 @item short
17811 True iff the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
17812 lines; default 100.
17813
17814 @item long
17815 True iff the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
17816 lines; default 200.
17817
17818 @item low
17819 True iff the article has a download score less than
17820 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
17821
17822 @item high
17823 True iff the article has a download score greater than
17824 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
17825
17826 @item spam
17827 True iff the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
17828 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
17829 checksum and sees whether articles match.
17830
17831 @item true
17832 Always true.
17833
17834 @item false
17835 Always false.
17836 @end table
17837
17838 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
17839 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
17840 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
17841 useful values.
17842
17843 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
17844 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g. posted
17845 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
17846 something along the lines of the following:
17847
17848 @lisp
17849 (defun my-article-old-p ()
17850 "Say whether an article is old."
17851 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
17852 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
17853 @end lisp
17854
17855 with the predicate then defined as:
17856
17857 @lisp
17858 (not my-article-old-p)
17859 @end lisp
17860
17861 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
17862 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
17863 wherever.
17864
17865 @lisp
17866 (require 'gnus-agent)
17867 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
17868 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
17869 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
17870 @end lisp
17871
17872 and simply specify your predicate as:
17873
17874 @lisp
17875 (not old)
17876 @end lisp
17877
17878 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
17879 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
17880 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
17881 just don't give a damn.
17882
17883 The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
17884 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
17885 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
17886 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
17887 parameters like so:
17888
17889 @lisp
17890 (agent-predicate . short)
17891 @end lisp
17892
17893 This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
17894 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
17895 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
17896
17897 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
17898
17899 @lisp
17900 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
17901 @end lisp
17902
17903 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
17904 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
17905 predicate is assumed to be a list.
17906
17907
17908 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
17909 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
17910 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
17911 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
17912 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
17913 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
17914
17915 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
17916 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
17917 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
17918 if it's to be specific to that group.
17919
17920 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
17921 three forms:
17922
17923 @enumerate
17924 @item
17925 Score rule
17926
17927 This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
17928 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
17929
17930 example:
17931
17932 @itemize @bullet
17933 @item
17934 Category specification
17935
17936 @lisp
17937 (("from"
17938 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
17939 ("lines"
17940 (500 -100 nil <)))
17941 @end lisp
17942
17943 @item
17944 Group/Topic Parameter specification
17945
17946 @lisp
17947 (agent-score ("from"
17948 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
17949 ("lines"
17950 (500 -100 nil <)))
17951 @end lisp
17952
17953 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
17954 @end itemize
17955
17956 @item
17957 Agent score file
17958
17959 These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
17960 keywords stated above.
17961
17962 example:
17963
17964 @itemize @bullet
17965 @item
17966 Category specification
17967
17968 @lisp
17969 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
17970 @end lisp
17971
17972 or perhaps
17973
17974 @lisp
17975 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
17976 @end lisp
17977
17978 @item
17979 Group Parameter specification
17980
17981 @lisp
17982 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
17983 @end lisp
17984
17985 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
17986 about parenthesis?
17987 @end itemize
17988
17989 @item
17990 Use @code{normal} score files
17991
17992 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
17993 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
17994 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
17995 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
17996
17997 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
17998 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
17999 files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
18000 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
18001
18002 @itemize @bullet
18003 @item
18004 Category Specification
18005
18006 @lisp
18007 file
18008 @end lisp
18009
18010 @item
18011 Group Parameter specification
18012
18013 @lisp
18014 (agent-score . file)
18015 @end lisp
18016 @end itemize
18017 @end enumerate
18018
18019 @node Category Buffer
18020 @subsubsection Category Buffer
18021
18022 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
18023 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
18024 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
18025
18026 The following commands are available in this buffer:
18027
18028 @table @kbd
18029 @item q
18030 @kindex q (Category)
18031 @findex gnus-category-exit
18032 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
18033
18034 @item e
18035 @kindex e (Category)
18036 @findex gnus-category-customize-category
18037 Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
18038 parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
18039
18040 @item k
18041 @kindex k (Category)
18042 @findex gnus-category-kill
18043 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
18044
18045 @item c
18046 @kindex c (Category)
18047 @findex gnus-category-copy
18048 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
18049
18050 @item a
18051 @kindex a (Category)
18052 @findex gnus-category-add
18053 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
18054
18055 @item p
18056 @kindex p (Category)
18057 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
18058 Edit the predicate of the current category
18059 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
18060
18061 @item g
18062 @kindex g (Category)
18063 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18064 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18065 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
18066
18067 @item s
18068 @kindex s (Category)
18069 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
18070 Edit the download score rule of the current category
18071 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
18072
18073 @item l
18074 @kindex l (Category)
18075 @findex gnus-category-list
18076 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18077 @end table
18078
18079
18080 @node Category Variables
18081 @subsubsection Category Variables
18082
18083 @table @code
18084 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
18085 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18086 Hook run in category buffers.
18087
18088 @item gnus-category-line-format
18089 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
18090 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18091 Variables}). Valid elements are:
18092
18093 @table @samp
18094 @item c
18095 The name of the category.
18096
18097 @item g
18098 The number of groups in the category.
18099 @end table
18100
18101 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18102 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18103 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
18104
18105 @item gnus-agent-short-article
18106 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18107 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
18108
18109 @item gnus-agent-long-article
18110 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18111 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
18112
18113 @item gnus-agent-low-score
18114 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18115 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
18116 0.
18117
18118 @item gnus-agent-high-score
18119 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18120 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
18121 0.
18122
18123 @item gnus-agent-expire-days
18124 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18125 The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18126 local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18127 the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18128 just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18129 important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18130 article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18131 read.
18132 Default 7.
18133
18134 @item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18135 @vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18136 Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18137 retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18138 you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18139 you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18140 have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18141
18142 @end table
18143
18144
18145 @node Agent Commands
18146 @subsection Agent Commands
18147 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18148 @kindex J j (Agent)
18149
18150 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18151 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
18152 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
18153
18154
18155 @menu
18156 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
18157 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
18158 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
18159 @end menu
18160
18161
18162
18163
18164 @node Group Agent Commands
18165 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
18166
18167 @table @kbd
18168 @item J u
18169 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
18170 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
18171 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
18172 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
18173
18174 @item J c
18175 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
18176 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
18177 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
18178
18179 @item J s
18180 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
18181 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
18182 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
18183 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
18184
18185 @item J S
18186 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
18187 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
18188 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
18189 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
18190
18191 @item J a
18192 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
18193 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
18194 Add the current group to an Agent category
18195 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
18196 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18197
18198 @item J r
18199 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
18200 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
18201 Remove the current group from its category, if any
18202 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
18203 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18204
18205 @item J Y
18206 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
18207 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18208 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
18209
18210
18211 @end table
18212
18213
18214 @node Summary Agent Commands
18215 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
18216
18217 @table @kbd
18218 @item J #
18219 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
18220 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
18221 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
18222
18223 @item J M-#
18224 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
18225 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
18226 Remove the downloading mark from the article
18227 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
18228
18229 @cindex %
18230 @item @@
18231 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
18232 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
18233 Toggle whether to download the article
18234 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
18235 default.
18236
18237 @item J c
18238 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
18239 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
18240 Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
18241
18242 @item J S
18243 @kindex J S (Agent Summary)
18244 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
18245 Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
18246 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
18247
18248 @item J s
18249 @kindex J s (Agent Summary)
18250 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-series
18251 Download all processable articles in this group.
18252 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-series}).
18253
18254 @item J u
18255 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
18256 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
18257 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
18258 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
18259
18260 @end table
18261
18262
18263 @node Server Agent Commands
18264 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
18265
18266 @table @kbd
18267 @item J a
18268 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
18269 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
18270 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
18271 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
18272
18273 @item J r
18274 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
18275 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
18276 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
18277 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
18278
18279 @end table
18280
18281
18282 @node Agent Visuals
18283 @subsection Agent Visuals
18284
18285 If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
18286 active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
18287 stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
18288 something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
18289 placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
18290 there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
18291 When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
18292 placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
18293 You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
18294 placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
18295
18296 While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
18297 available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
18298 fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
18299 way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
18300 less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
18301 adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
18302 the download status of each article so that you always know which
18303 articles will be available when unplugged.
18304
18305 The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
18306 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
18307 a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
18308 Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
18309 will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
18310 other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
18311 @samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
18312 (@samp{ }) will be displayed.
18313
18314 The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
18315 are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
18316 result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
18317 that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
18318 face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
18319 tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
18320 conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
18321 that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
18322 to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
18323
18324 If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
18325 each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
18326 undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
18327 being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
18328 downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear.
18329
18330 For occasional Agent users, the undownloaded faces may appear to be an
18331 absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since most of their
18332 articles have not been fetched into the Agent, most of the normal
18333 faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces. If this is your
18334 situation, you have two choices available. First, you can completely
18335 disable the undownload faces by customizing
18336 @code{gnus-summary-highlight} to delete the three cons-cells that
18337 refer to the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face} faces. Second, if
18338 you prefer to take a more fine-grained approach, you may set the
18339 @code{agent-disable-undownloaded-faces} group parameter to t. This
18340 parameter, like all other agent parameters, may be set on an Agent
18341 Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}), a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic
18342 Parameters}), or an individual group (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
18343
18344 @node Agent as Cache
18345 @subsection Agent as Cache
18346
18347 When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
18348 articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
18349 Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
18350 in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
18351 buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
18352 are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
18353 consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
18354 article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
18355 server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
18356
18357 If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
18358 @pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
18359 plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
18360 synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
18361 sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
18362
18363 @node Agent Expiry
18364 @subsection Agent Expiry
18365
18366 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18367 @findex gnus-agent-expire
18368 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
18369 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
18370 @findex gnus-agent-expire-group
18371 @cindex agent expiry
18372 @cindex Gnus agent expiry
18373 @cindex expiry
18374
18375 The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
18376 least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
18377 special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
18378 commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
18379 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
18380 that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
18381 efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
18382 @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
18383
18384 Note that other functions, e.g. @code{gnus-request-expire-articles},
18385 might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you to keep the agent
18386 synchronized with the group.
18387
18388 The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
18389 prevent expiration in selected groups.
18390
18391 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
18392 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
18393 expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
18394 and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
18395 are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
18396 be kept indefinitely.
18397
18398 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
18399 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
18400 commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
18401 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
18402
18403 @node Agent Regeneration
18404 @subsection Agent Regeneration
18405
18406 @cindex agent regeneration
18407 @cindex Gnus agent regeneration
18408 @cindex regeneration
18409
18410 The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
18411 due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
18412 @code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
18413 to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
18414 internal inconsistencies.
18415
18416 For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
18417 downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
18418 know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
18419 failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
18420 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
18421 such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
18422
18423 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
18424 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
18425 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
18426 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
18427 you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
18428 recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
18429
18430 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18431 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18432 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
18433 of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
18434 then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
18435 are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
18436 agent as unread.
18437
18438 @node Agent and IMAP
18439 @subsection Agent and IMAP
18440
18441 The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
18442 since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
18443 @acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
18444 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
18445
18446 The first thing to keep in mind is that all flags (read, ticked, etc)
18447 are kept on the @acronym{IMAP} server, rather than in @file{.newsrc} as is the
18448 case for nntp. Thus Gnus need to remember flag changes when
18449 disconnected, and synchronize these flags when you plug back in.
18450
18451 Gnus keeps track of flag changes when reading nnimap groups under the
18452 Agent. When you plug back in, Gnus will check if you have any changed
18453 any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the server.
18454 The behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
18455
18456 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18457 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
18458 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
18459 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
18460 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
18461 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
18462
18463 If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
18464 re-connect, you can do it manually with the
18465 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
18466 in the group buffer.
18467
18468 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
18469 expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
18470
18471 @itemize @bullet
18472
18473 @item
18474 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
18475
18476 @item
18477 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
18478
18479 @end itemize
18480
18481 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
18482 all local flags to the server, but rather incrementally update the
18483 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
18484 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group and
18485 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
18486 removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
18487 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
18488 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
18489
18490
18491 @node Outgoing Messages
18492 @subsection Outgoing Messages
18493
18494 When Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail and news) are
18495 stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}). You can view
18496 them there after posting, and edit them at will.
18497
18498 When Gnus is plugged again, you can send the messages either from the
18499 draft group with the special commands available there, or you can use
18500 the @kbd{J S} command in the group buffer to send all the sendable
18501 messages in the draft group.
18502
18503
18504
18505 @node Agent Variables
18506 @subsection Agent Variables
18507
18508 @table @code
18509 @item gnus-agent-directory
18510 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
18511 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
18512 @file{~/News/agent/}.
18513
18514 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
18515 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
18516 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
18517 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
18518 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
18519 by default.
18520
18521 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
18522 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
18523 Hook run when connecting to the network.
18524
18525 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
18526 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
18527 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
18528
18529 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
18530 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
18531 Hook run when finished fetching articles.
18532
18533 @item gnus-agent-cache
18534 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
18535 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
18536 articles when plugged, e.g. essentially using the Agent as a cache.
18537 The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
18538
18539 @item gnus-agent-go-online
18540 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
18541 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
18542 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
18543 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
18544 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
18545 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
18546 online status.
18547
18548 @item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
18549 @vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
18550 If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
18551 mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
18552 thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
18553 read. The default is t.
18554
18555 @item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
18556 @vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
18557 If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
18558 agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
18559 downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
18560 the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
18561 are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
18562 into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
18563 the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
18564 over and over again.
18565
18566 @item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
18567 @vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
18568 The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
18569 them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
18570 the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
18571 have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
18572 limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
18573 performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
18574 connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
18575 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
18576 However, all articles parsed prior to loosing the connection will be
18577 available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
18578 see any cycling.
18579
18580 @item gnus-server-unopen-status
18581 @vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
18582 Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
18583 variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
18584 Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
18585 whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
18586 Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
18587 for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
18588 is only valid if the Agent is used.
18589
18590 @item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
18591 @vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
18592 Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
18593 that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
18594 buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
18595 agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
18596
18597 The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
18598 @code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
18599 have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
18600 ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
18601 (maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
18602
18603 @item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
18604 @vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
18605 If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
18606 @file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
18607 automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
18608 which backends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
18609 to agentize remote backends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
18610 as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
18611 If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
18612 removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
18613 start Gnus. The default is @samp{(nntp nnimap)}.
18614
18615 @end table
18616
18617
18618 @node Example Setup
18619 @subsection Example Setup
18620
18621 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
18622 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
18623 @file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
18624
18625 @lisp
18626 ;;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
18627 ;;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
18628 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
18629
18630 ;;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
18631 ;;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
18632 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
18633
18634 ;;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
18635 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
18636
18637 ;;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
18638 ;;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
18639 ;;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
18640 @end lisp
18641
18642 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
18643 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
18644 gnus}.
18645
18646 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
18647 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
18648 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
18649 @acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
18650 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
18651 once.
18652
18653 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
18654 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
18655 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
18656 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
18657 back all the killed groups.)
18658
18659 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
18660 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
18661 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
18662
18663
18664 @node Batching Agents
18665 @subsection Batching Agents
18666 @findex gnus-agent-batch
18667
18668 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
18669 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
18670 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
18671
18672 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
18673 following incantation:
18674
18675 @example
18676 #!/bin/sh
18677 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
18678 @end example
18679
18680
18681 @node Agent Caveats
18682 @subsection Agent Caveats
18683
18684 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
18685 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
18686 may ask:
18687
18688 @table @dfn
18689 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
18690
18691 @strong{No}. If you want this behaviour, add
18692 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
18693 @code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
18694
18695 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
18696 the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
18697
18698 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
18699
18700 @end table
18701
18702 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
18703 articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
18704 locally stored articles.
18705
18706
18707 @node Scoring
18708 @chapter Scoring
18709 @cindex scoring
18710
18711 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
18712 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
18713 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
18714 attention!
18715
18716 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
18717 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
18718 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
18719 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
18720 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
18721
18722 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
18723 before generating the summary buffer.
18724
18725 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
18726 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
18727 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
18728
18729 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
18730 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
18731 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
18732 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
18733
18734 @menu
18735 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
18736 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
18737 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
18738 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
18739 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
18740 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
18741 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
18742 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
18743 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
18744 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
18745 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
18746 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
18747 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
18748 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
18749 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
18750 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
18751 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
18752 @end menu
18753
18754
18755 @node Summary Score Commands
18756 @section Summary Score Commands
18757 @cindex score commands
18758
18759 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
18760 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
18761 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
18762 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
18763 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
18764
18765 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
18766 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
18767 some other score file (e.g. @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
18768 score file the current one.
18769
18770 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
18771
18772 @table @kbd
18773
18774 @item V s
18775 @kindex V s (Summary)
18776 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
18777 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
18778
18779 @item V S
18780 @kindex V S (Summary)
18781 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
18782 Display the score of the current article
18783 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
18784
18785 @item V t
18786 @kindex V t (Summary)
18787 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
18788 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
18789 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
18790 may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
18791 current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
18792 score file and edit it.
18793
18794 @item V w
18795 @kindex V w (Summary)
18796 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
18797 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
18798
18799 @item V R
18800 @kindex V R (Summary)
18801 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
18802 Run the current summary through the scoring process
18803 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
18804 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
18805 effect you're having.
18806
18807 @item V c
18808 @kindex V c (Summary)
18809 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
18810 Make a different score file the current
18811 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
18812
18813 @item V e
18814 @kindex V e (Summary)
18815 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
18816 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
18817 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
18818 File Editing}).
18819
18820 @item V f
18821 @kindex V f (Summary)
18822 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
18823 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
18824 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
18825
18826 @item V F
18827 @kindex V F (Summary)
18828 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
18829 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
18830 after editing score files.
18831
18832 @item V C
18833 @kindex V C (Summary)
18834 @findex gnus-score-customize
18835 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
18836 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
18837
18838 @end table
18839
18840 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
18841
18842 @table @kbd
18843
18844 @item V m
18845 @kindex V m (Summary)
18846 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
18847 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
18848 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
18849
18850 @item V x
18851 @kindex V x (Summary)
18852 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
18853 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
18854 expunge all articles below this score
18855 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
18856 @end table
18857
18858 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
18859 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
18860 them.)
18861
18862 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
18863 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
18864
18865 @enumerate
18866 @item
18867 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
18868 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
18869 @item
18870 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
18871 keys are available:
18872 @table @kbd
18873
18874 @item a
18875 Score on the author name.
18876
18877 @item s
18878 Score on the subject line.
18879
18880 @item x
18881 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
18882
18883 @item r
18884 Score on the @code{References} line.
18885
18886 @item d
18887 Score on the date.
18888
18889 @item l
18890 Score on the number of lines.
18891
18892 @item i
18893 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
18894
18895 @item e
18896 Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
18897 if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
18898
18899 @item f
18900 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
18901 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
18902 @file{ADAPT} files.)
18903
18904 @item b
18905 Score on the body.
18906
18907 @item h
18908 Score on the head.
18909
18910 @item t
18911 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
18912 files.)
18913
18914 @end table
18915
18916 @item
18917 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
18918 what headers you are scoring on.
18919
18920 @table @code
18921
18922 @item strings
18923
18924 @table @kbd
18925
18926 @item e
18927 Exact matching.
18928
18929 @item s
18930 Substring matching.
18931
18932 @item f
18933 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
18934
18935 @item r
18936 Regexp matching
18937 @end table
18938
18939 @item date
18940 @table @kbd
18941
18942 @item b
18943 Before date.
18944
18945 @item a
18946 After date.
18947
18948 @item n
18949 This date.
18950 @end table
18951
18952 @item number
18953 @table @kbd
18954
18955 @item <
18956 Less than number.
18957
18958 @item =
18959 Equal to number.
18960
18961 @item >
18962 Greater than number.
18963 @end table
18964 @end table
18965
18966 @item
18967 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
18968 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
18969 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
18970 file.
18971 @table @kbd
18972
18973 @item t
18974 Temporary score entry.
18975
18976 @item p
18977 Permanent score entry.
18978
18979 @item i
18980 Immediately scoring.
18981 @end table
18982
18983 @item
18984 If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
18985 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
18986 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
18987
18988 @end enumerate
18989
18990 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
18991 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
18992 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
18993 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
18994
18995 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
18996 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
18997 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
18998 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
18999 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
19000
19001 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
19002 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
19003 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
19004 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
19005 current score file.
19006
19007 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
19008 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
19009 pretend they are keymaps or not.
19010
19011
19012 @node Group Score Commands
19013 @section Group Score Commands
19014 @cindex group score commands
19015
19016 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
19017
19018 @table @kbd
19019
19020 @item W f
19021 @kindex W f (Group)
19022 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19023 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
19024 all the time. This command will flush the cache
19025 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
19026
19027 @end table
19028
19029 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
19030
19031 @findex gnus-batch-score
19032 @cindex batch scoring
19033 @example
19034 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
19035 @end example
19036
19037
19038 @node Score Variables
19039 @section Score Variables
19040 @cindex score variables
19041
19042 @table @code
19043
19044 @item gnus-use-scoring
19045 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
19046 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
19047 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
19048
19049 @item gnus-kill-killed
19050 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
19051 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
19052 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
19053 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
19054 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
19055 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
19056 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
19057
19058 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
19059 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19060 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19061 initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19062 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
19063
19064 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
19065 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19066 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19067 (@file{SCORE} by default.)
19068
19069 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19070 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19071 @cindex score cache
19072 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19073 score files. However, if this might make your Emacs grow big and
19074 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19075 to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19076 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19077 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19078 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19079 be cached.
19080
19081 @item gnus-save-score
19082 @vindex gnus-save-score
19083 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19084 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19085 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
19086
19087 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19088 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19089 across group visits.
19090
19091 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19092 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19093 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19094 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19095 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19096 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19097 manually entered data.
19098
19099 @item gnus-summary-default-score
19100 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19101 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
19102
19103 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19104 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19105 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19106 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19107 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19108 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
19109
19110 @item gnus-score-over-mark
19111 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19112 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19113 default. Default is @samp{+}.
19114
19115 @item gnus-score-below-mark
19116 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19117 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19118 default. Default is @samp{-}.
19119
19120 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19121 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19122 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19123 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
19124
19125 Predefined functions available are:
19126 @table @code
19127
19128 @item gnus-score-find-single
19129 @findex gnus-score-find-single
19130 Only apply the group's own score file.
19131
19132 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
19133 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19134 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19135 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19136 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19137 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19138 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19139 then a regexp match is done.
19140
19141 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19142 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
19143
19144 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19145 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19146 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19147 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
19148
19149 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19150 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19151 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
19152 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
19153 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
19154 server.
19155
19156 @end table
19157 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
19158 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
19159 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
19160 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
19161 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
19162 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
19163 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
19164 Phu.
19165
19166 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
19167 overall score file, you could use the value
19168 @example
19169 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
19170 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
19171 @end example
19172
19173 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
19174 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
19175 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
19176 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
19177 are expired. It's 7 by default.
19178
19179 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19180 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19181 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
19182 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
19183 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
19184 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
19185 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
19186 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
19187
19188 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19189 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19190 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
19191
19192 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
19193 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
19194 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
19195 simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
19196 threading---according to the current value of
19197 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
19198 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
19199 simplified in this manner.
19200
19201 @end table
19202
19203
19204 @node Score File Format
19205 @section Score File Format
19206 @cindex score file format
19207
19208 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
19209 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
19210 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
19211
19212 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
19213
19214 @lisp
19215 (("from"
19216 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
19217 ("Per Abrahamsen")
19218 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
19219 ("subject"
19220 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
19221 ("xref"
19222 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
19223 ("lines"
19224 (2 -100 nil <))
19225 (mark 0)
19226 (expunge -1000)
19227 (mark-and-expunge -10)
19228 (read-only nil)
19229 (orphan -10)
19230 (adapt t)
19231 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
19232 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
19233 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
19234 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
19235 (eval (ding)))
19236 @end lisp
19237
19238 This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
19239 Scoring}, for a different approach.
19240
19241 Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
19242 @code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
19243 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
19244
19245 Six keys are supported by this alist:
19246
19247 @table @code
19248
19249 @item STRING
19250 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
19251 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
19252 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
19253 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
19254 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
19255 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
19256 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
19257 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
19258 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
19259 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
19260 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
19261 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
19262 to articles that matches these score entries.
19263
19264 Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
19265 score entry has one to four elements.
19266 @enumerate
19267
19268 @item
19269 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
19270 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
19271 integer.
19272
19273 @item
19274 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
19275 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
19276 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
19277 is successful. If this element is not present, the
19278 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
19279 instead. This is 1000 by default.
19280
19281 @item
19282 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
19283 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
19284 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
19285 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
19286 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
19287
19288 @item
19289 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
19290 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
19291 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
19292 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
19293 @table @dfn
19294
19295 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
19296 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
19297 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
19298 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
19299 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
19300 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
19301 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
19302 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
19303 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
19304 instead, if you feel like.
19305
19306 @item Extra
19307 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
19308 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
19309 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
19310 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
19311 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
19312 host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
19313 overviews:
19314
19315 @lisp
19316 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
19317 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
19318 @end lisp
19319
19320 @item Lines, Chars
19321 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
19322 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
19323
19324 These predicates are true if
19325
19326 @example
19327 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
19328 @end example
19329
19330 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
19331 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
19332 following form:
19333
19334 @lisp
19335 (< header-value 4)
19336 @end lisp
19337
19338 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
19339 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
19340 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
19341 it's not. I think.)
19342
19343 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
19344 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
19345 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
19346 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
19347
19348 @item Date
19349 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
19350 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
19351 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
19352 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
19353 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
19354 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
19355 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
19356
19357 @cindex ISO8601
19358 @cindex date
19359 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
19360 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
19361 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
19362 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
19363 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
19364 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
19365 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
19366 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
19367 whole family, eh?)
19368
19369 @item Head, Body, All
19370 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
19371 header uses.
19372
19373 @item Followup
19374 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
19375 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
19376 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
19377 you e.g. increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
19378 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
19379 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
19380 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
19381 files.)
19382
19383 @item Thread
19384 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
19385 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
19386 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
19387 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
19388 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
19389 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
19390 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
19391 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
19392 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
19393 undeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
19394 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
19395 @end table
19396 @end enumerate
19397
19398 @cindex score file atoms
19399 @item mark
19400 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19401 lower than this number will be marked as read.
19402
19403 @item expunge
19404 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19405 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
19406
19407 @item mark-and-expunge
19408 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19409 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
19410 summary buffer.
19411
19412 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
19413 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
19414 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
19415 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
19416 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
19417
19418 @item files
19419 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
19420 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
19421 this one was.
19422
19423 @item exclude-files
19424 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
19425 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
19426 other.
19427
19428 @item eval
19429 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}el. This element will be
19430 ignored when handling global score files.
19431
19432 @item read-only
19433 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
19434 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
19435 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
19436 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
19437
19438 @item orphan
19439 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
19440 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
19441 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
19442 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
19443
19444 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
19445
19446 @example
19447 (orphan -500)
19448 (mark-and-expunge -100)
19449 @end example
19450
19451 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
19452 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
19453 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{C y}) the
19454 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
19455 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
19456
19457 I.e.---the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
19458 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
19459 scoring rules exist.
19460
19461 @item adapt
19462 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
19463 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
19464 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
19465 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
19466 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
19467 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
19468 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
19469 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
19470 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
19471 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
19472 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
19473 it.
19474
19475 @item adapt-file
19476 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
19477 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
19478 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
19479 file for a number of groups.
19480
19481 @item local
19482 @cindex local variables
19483 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
19484 @var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
19485 current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
19486 convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
19487 groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
19488 be evaluated.
19489 @end table
19490
19491
19492 @node Score File Editing
19493 @section Score File Editing
19494
19495 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
19496 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
19497 with a mode for that.
19498
19499 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
19500 additional commands:
19501
19502 @table @kbd
19503
19504 @item C-c C-c
19505 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
19506 @findex gnus-score-edit-done
19507 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
19508 (@code{gnus-score-edit-done}).
19509
19510 @item C-c C-d
19511 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
19512 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
19513 Insert the current date in numerical format
19514 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
19515 you were wondering.
19516
19517 @item C-c C-p
19518 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
19519 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
19520 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
19521 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
19522 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
19523 you.
19524
19525 @end table
19526
19527 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
19528
19529 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
19530 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
19531
19532 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
19533 @kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
19534
19535
19536 @node Adaptive Scoring
19537 @section Adaptive Scoring
19538 @cindex adaptive scoring
19539
19540 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
19541 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
19542 stupidity, to be precise.
19543
19544 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
19545 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
19546 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
19547 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
19548 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
19549 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
19550 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
19551 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
19552 variable to @code{(word line)}.
19553
19554 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
19555 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
19556 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
19557 might look something like this:
19558
19559 @lisp
19560 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
19561 '((gnus-unread-mark)
19562 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
19563 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
19564 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
19565 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
19566 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
19567 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
19568 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
19569 (gnus-ancient-mark)
19570 (gnus-low-score-mark)
19571 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
19572 @end lisp
19573
19574 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
19575 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
19576 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
19577 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
19578 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
19579 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
19580 entries.
19581
19582 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
19583 will be applied to each article.
19584
19585 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
19586 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
19587 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
19588 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
19589
19590 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
19591 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
19592 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
19593 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
19594
19595 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
19596 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
19597 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
19598 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
19599
19600 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
19601 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
19602 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
19603 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
19604 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
19605 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
19606
19607 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
19608 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
19609 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
19610
19611 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
19612 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
19613 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
19614
19615 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
19616 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
19617 let you use different rules in different groups.
19618
19619 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
19620 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
19621 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
19622 is @file{ADAPT}.
19623
19624 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
19625 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
19626 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
19627 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
19628 the length of the match is less than
19629 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
19630 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
19631 this problem.
19632
19633 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
19634 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
19635 headers. If you adapt on words, the
19636 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
19637 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
19638
19639 @lisp
19640 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
19641 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
19642 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
19643 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
19644 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
19645 @end lisp
19646
19647 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
19648 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
19649 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
19650 score with 30 points.
19651
19652 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
19653 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
19654 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
19655 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
19656 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
19657
19658 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
19659 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
19660 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
19661 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
19662 variable defaults to @code{nil}.
19663
19664 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
19665 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
19666 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
19667 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
19668
19669 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
19670 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
19671 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
19672 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
19673
19674 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
19675 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
19676 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
19677 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
19678 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
19679
19680 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
19681 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
19682 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
19683
19684 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
19685 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
19686 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
19687 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
19688
19689
19690 @node Home Score File
19691 @section Home Score File
19692
19693 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
19694 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
19695 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
19696 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
19697
19698 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
19699 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
19700 could perhaps use the same home score file.
19701
19702 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
19703 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
19704 be:
19705
19706 @enumerate
19707 @item
19708 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
19709 groups.
19710
19711 @item
19712 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
19713 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
19714 parameter.
19715
19716 @item
19717 A list. The elements in this list can be:
19718
19719 @enumerate
19720 @item
19721 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
19722 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
19723
19724 @item
19725 A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
19726 be used as the home score file.
19727
19728 @item
19729 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
19730 @end enumerate
19731
19732 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
19733 for matches.
19734
19735 @end enumerate
19736
19737 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
19738
19739 @lisp
19740 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19741 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
19742 @end lisp
19743
19744 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
19745 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
19746
19747 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
19748 @lisp
19749 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19750 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
19751 @end lisp
19752
19753 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
19754 Other functions include
19755
19756 @table @code
19757 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
19758 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
19759 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
19760 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
19761
19762 @end table
19763
19764 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
19765 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
19766 their own home score files:
19767
19768 @lisp
19769 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19770 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
19771 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
19772 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
19773 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
19774 @end lisp
19775
19776 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
19777 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
19778 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
19779 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
19780 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
19781
19782 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
19783 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
19784 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
19785 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
19786 precedence over this variable.
19787
19788
19789 @node Followups To Yourself
19790 @section Followups To Yourself
19791
19792 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
19793 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
19794 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
19795 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
19796 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
19797 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
19798
19799 @table @code
19800
19801 @item gnus-score-followup-article
19802 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
19803 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
19804 article.
19805
19806 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
19807 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
19808 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
19809 your own article.
19810 @end table
19811
19812 @vindex message-sent-hook
19813 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
19814 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
19815 @lisp
19816 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
19817 @end lisp
19818
19819
19820 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
19821 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
19822 mine:
19823
19824 @example
19825 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
19826 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
19827 @end example
19828
19829 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
19830 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
19831 myself:
19832
19833 @lisp
19834 ("references"
19835 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
19836 1000 nil r))
19837 @end lisp
19838
19839 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
19840 is system-dependent.
19841
19842
19843 @node Scoring On Other Headers
19844 @section Scoring On Other Headers
19845 @cindex scoring on other headers
19846
19847 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
19848 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
19849 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
19850 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
19851 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
19852
19853 Now, there's not much you can do about this for news groups, but for
19854 mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
19855 it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
19856 a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
19857 @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
19858
19859 Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
19860
19861 @lisp
19862 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
19863 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
19864 @end lisp
19865
19866 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
19867 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
19868 time if you have much mail.
19869
19870 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
19871 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
19872
19873 See? Simple.
19874
19875
19876 @node Scoring Tips
19877 @section Scoring Tips
19878 @cindex scoring tips
19879
19880 @table @dfn
19881
19882 @item Crossposts
19883 @cindex crossposts
19884 @cindex scoring crossposts
19885 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
19886 the @code{Xref} header.
19887 @lisp
19888 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
19889 @end lisp
19890
19891 @item Multiple crossposts
19892 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
19893 more than, say, 3 groups:
19894 @lisp
19895 ("xref"
19896 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
19897 -1000 nil r))
19898 @end lisp
19899
19900 @item Matching on the body
19901 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
19902 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
19903 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
19904 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
19905 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
19906 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
19907 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
19908 the matches.
19909
19910 @item Marking as read
19911 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
19912 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
19913 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
19914 @lisp
19915 ((mark -100))
19916 @end lisp
19917 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
19918
19919 @item Negated character classes
19920 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
19921 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
19922 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
19923 @end table
19924
19925
19926 @node Reverse Scoring
19927 @section Reverse Scoring
19928 @cindex reverse scoring
19929
19930 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
19931 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
19932 like this in your score file:
19933
19934 @lisp
19935 (("subject"
19936 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
19937 (mark 1)
19938 (expunge 1))
19939 @end lisp
19940
19941 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
19942 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
19943
19944
19945 @node Global Score Files
19946 @section Global Score Files
19947 @cindex global score files
19948
19949 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
19950 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
19951 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
19952
19953 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
19954 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
19955 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
19956
19957 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
19958 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
19959 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
19960 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
19961 files are applicable to which group.
19962
19963 To use the score file
19964 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
19965 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
19966 say this:
19967
19968 @lisp
19969 (setq gnus-global-score-files
19970 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
19971 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
19972 @end lisp
19973
19974 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
19975 @noindent
19976 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
19977 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
19978 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
19979 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
19980
19981 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
19982 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
19983
19984 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
19985 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
19986 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
19987 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
19988 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
19989 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
19990
19991 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
19992 head:
19993
19994 @itemize @bullet
19995
19996 @item
19997 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
19998 @item
19999 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
20000 @item
20001 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
20002 @item
20003 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
20004 lowered out of existence.
20005 @item
20006 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
20007 articles completely.
20008
20009 @item
20010 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
20011 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
20012 old articles for a long time.
20013 @end itemize
20014
20015 @dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
20016 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
20017 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
20018 holding our breath yet?
20019
20020
20021 @node Kill Files
20022 @section Kill Files
20023 @cindex kill files
20024
20025 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
20026 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
20027 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
20028
20029 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
20030 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
20031 files into score files.
20032
20033 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
20034 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
20035 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
20036 that isn't a very good idea.
20037
20038 Normal kill files look like this:
20039
20040 @lisp
20041 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20042 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
20043 (gnus-expunge "X")
20044 @end lisp
20045
20046 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
20047 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
20048
20049 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
20050 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
20051 interpreting it.
20052
20053 Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
20054
20055 @table @kbd
20056
20057 @item M-k
20058 @kindex M-k (Summary)
20059 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20060 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
20061
20062 @item M-K
20063 @kindex M-K (Summary)
20064 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20065 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20066 @end table
20067
20068 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
20069
20070 @table @kbd
20071
20072 @item M-k
20073 @kindex M-k (Group)
20074 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20075 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
20076
20077 @item M-K
20078 @kindex M-K (Group)
20079 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20080 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
20081 @end table
20082
20083 Kill file variables:
20084
20085 @table @code
20086 @item gnus-kill-file-name
20087 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20088 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20089 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20090 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20091 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20092 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
20093
20094 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20095 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20096 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20097 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20098 kills.
20099
20100 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20101 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20102 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20103 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20104 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20105 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20106 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20107 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20108 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
20109
20110 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20111 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20112 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
20113
20114 @end table
20115
20116
20117 @node Converting Kill Files
20118 @section Converting Kill Files
20119 @cindex kill files
20120 @cindex converting kill files
20121
20122 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20123 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20124 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20125 by hand.
20126
20127 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Gnus by default.
20128 You can fetch it from
20129 @uref{http://www.stud.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
20130
20131 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20132 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20133 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20134 before.
20135
20136
20137 @node GroupLens
20138 @section GroupLens
20139 @cindex GroupLens
20140
20141 @sc{Note:} Unfortunately the GroupLens system seems to have shut down,
20142 so this section is mostly of historical interest.
20143
20144 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/, GroupLens} is a
20145 collaborative filtering system that helps you work together with other
20146 people to find the quality news articles out of the huge volume of
20147 news articles generated every day.
20148
20149 To accomplish this the GroupLens system combines your opinions about
20150 articles you have already read with the opinions of others who have done
20151 likewise and gives you a personalized prediction for each unread news
20152 article. Think of GroupLens as a matchmaker. GroupLens watches how you
20153 rate articles, and finds other people that rate articles the same way.
20154 Once it has found some people you agree with it tells you, in the form
20155 of a prediction, what they thought of the article. You can use this
20156 prediction to help you decide whether or not you want to read the
20157 article.
20158
20159 @menu
20160 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
20161 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
20162 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
20163 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
20164 @end menu
20165
20166
20167 @node Using GroupLens
20168 @subsection Using GroupLens
20169
20170 To use GroupLens you must register a pseudonym with your local
20171 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/bbb.html, Better Bit
20172 Bureau (BBB)} is the only better bit in town at the moment.
20173
20174 Once you have registered you'll need to set a couple of variables.
20175
20176 @table @code
20177
20178 @item gnus-use-grouplens
20179 @vindex gnus-use-grouplens
20180 Setting this variable to a non-@code{nil} value will make Gnus hook into
20181 all the relevant GroupLens functions.
20182
20183 @item grouplens-pseudonym
20184 @vindex grouplens-pseudonym
20185 This variable should be set to the pseudonym you got when registering
20186 with the Better Bit Bureau.
20187
20188 @item grouplens-newsgroups
20189 @vindex grouplens-newsgroups
20190 A list of groups that you want to get GroupLens predictions for.
20191
20192 @end table
20193
20194 That's the minimum of what you need to get up and running with GroupLens.
20195 Once you've registered, GroupLens will start giving you scores for
20196 articles based on the average of what other people think. But, to get
20197 the real benefit of GroupLens you need to start rating articles
20198 yourself. Then the scores GroupLens gives you will be personalized for
20199 you, based on how the people you usually agree with have already rated.
20200
20201
20202 @node Rating Articles
20203 @subsection Rating Articles
20204
20205 In GroupLens, an article is rated on a scale from 1 to 5, inclusive.
20206 Where 1 means something like this article is a waste of bandwidth and 5
20207 means that the article was really good. The basic question to ask
20208 yourself is, ``on a scale from 1 to 5 would I like to see more articles
20209 like this one?''
20210
20211 There are four ways to enter a rating for an article in GroupLens.
20212
20213 @table @kbd
20214
20215 @item r
20216 @kindex r (GroupLens)
20217 @findex bbb-summary-rate-article
20218 This function will prompt you for a rating on a scale of one to five.
20219
20220 @item k
20221 @kindex k (GroupLens)
20222 @findex grouplens-score-thread
20223 This function will prompt you for a rating, and rate all the articles in
20224 the thread. This is really useful for some of those long running giant
20225 threads in rec.humor.
20226
20227 @end table
20228
20229 The next two commands, @kbd{n} and @kbd{,} take a numerical prefix to be
20230 the score of the article you're reading.
20231
20232 @table @kbd
20233
20234 @item 1-5 n
20235 @kindex n (GroupLens)
20236 @findex grouplens-next-unread-article
20237 Rate the article and go to the next unread article.
20238
20239 @item 1-5 ,
20240 @kindex , (GroupLens)
20241 @findex grouplens-best-unread-article
20242 Rate the article and go to the next unread article with the highest score.
20243
20244 @end table
20245
20246 If you want to give the current article a score of 4 and then go to the
20247 next article, just type @kbd{4 n}.
20248
20249
20250 @node Displaying Predictions
20251 @subsection Displaying Predictions
20252
20253 GroupLens makes a prediction for you about how much you will like a
20254 news article. The predictions from GroupLens are on a scale from 1 to
20255 5, where 1 is the worst and 5 is the best. You can use the predictions
20256 from GroupLens in one of three ways controlled by the variable
20257 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring}.
20258
20259 @vindex gnus-grouplens-override-scoring
20260 There are three ways to display predictions in grouplens. You may
20261 choose to have the GroupLens scores contribute to, or override the
20262 regular Gnus scoring mechanism. override is the default; however, some
20263 people prefer to see the Gnus scores plus the grouplens scores. To get
20264 the separate scoring behavior you need to set
20265 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'separate}. To have the
20266 GroupLens predictions combined with the grouplens scores set it to
20267 @code{'override} and to combine the scores set
20268 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'combine}. When you use
20269 the combine option you will also want to set the values for
20270 @code{grouplens-prediction-offset} and
20271 @code{grouplens-score-scale-factor}.
20272
20273 @vindex grouplens-prediction-display
20274 In either case, GroupLens gives you a few choices for how you would like
20275 to see your predictions displayed. The display of predictions is
20276 controlled by the @code{grouplens-prediction-display} variable.
20277
20278 The following are valid values for that variable.
20279
20280 @table @code
20281 @item prediction-spot
20282 The higher the prediction, the further to the right an @samp{*} is
20283 displayed.
20284
20285 @item confidence-interval
20286 A numeric confidence interval.
20287
20288 @item prediction-bar
20289 The higher the prediction, the longer the bar.
20290
20291 @item confidence-bar
20292 Numerical confidence.
20293
20294 @item confidence-spot
20295 The spot gets bigger with more confidence.
20296
20297 @item prediction-num
20298 Plain-old numeric value.
20299
20300 @item confidence-plus-minus
20301 Prediction +/- confidence.
20302
20303 @end table
20304
20305
20306 @node GroupLens Variables
20307 @subsection GroupLens Variables
20308
20309 @table @code
20310
20311 @item gnus-summary-grouplens-line-format
20312 The summary line format used in GroupLens-enhanced summary buffers. It
20313 accepts the same specs as the normal summary line format (@pxref{Summary
20314 Buffer Lines}). The default is @samp{%U%R%z%l%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23n%]%)
20315 %s\n}.
20316
20317 @item grouplens-bbb-host
20318 Host running the bbbd server. @samp{grouplens.cs.umn.edu} is the
20319 default.
20320
20321 @item grouplens-bbb-port
20322 Port of the host running the bbbd server. The default is 9000.
20323
20324 @item grouplens-score-offset
20325 Offset the prediction by this value. In other words, subtract the
20326 prediction value by this number to arrive at the effective score. The
20327 default is 0.
20328
20329 @item grouplens-score-scale-factor
20330 This variable allows the user to magnify the effect of GroupLens scores.
20331 The scale factor is applied after the offset. The default is 1.
20332
20333 @end table
20334
20335
20336 @node Advanced Scoring
20337 @section Advanced Scoring
20338
20339 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
20340 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
20341 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
20342 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
20343 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
20344
20345 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
20346 scoring patterns.
20347
20348 @menu
20349 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
20350 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
20351 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
20352 @end menu
20353
20354
20355 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
20356 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
20357
20358 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
20359 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
20360 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
20361 non-@code{nil} value.
20362
20363 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
20364 operator, and various match operators.
20365
20366 Logical operators:
20367
20368 @table @code
20369 @item &
20370 @itemx and
20371 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20372 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
20373 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
20374 @code{true}.
20375
20376 @item |
20377 @itemx or
20378 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20379 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
20380 then this operator will return @code{false}.
20381
20382 @item !
20383 @itemx not
20384 @itemx ¬
20385 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
20386 logical negation of the value of its argument.
20387
20388 @end table
20389
20390 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
20391 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
20392 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
20393 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
20394 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
20395 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
20396 the ancestry you want to go.
20397
20398 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
20399 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
20400 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
20401 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
20402 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
20403
20404
20405 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
20406 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
20407
20408 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
20409 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
20410 of parentheses.
20411
20412 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
20413 when he's talking about Gnus:
20414
20415 @example
20416 @group
20417 ((&
20418 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20419 ("subject" "Gnus"))
20420 1000)
20421 @end group
20422 @end example
20423
20424 Quite simple, huh?
20425
20426 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
20427
20428 @example
20429 ((&
20430 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20431 (|
20432 ("subject" "Gnus")
20433 ("lines" 100 >)))
20434 1000)
20435 @end example
20436
20437 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
20438 really don't want to read what he's written:
20439
20440 @example
20441 ((&
20442 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20443 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigir Logge")))
20444 -100000)
20445 @end example
20446
20447 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
20448 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
20449 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
20450 very interesting:
20451
20452 @example
20453 ((&
20454 (1-
20455 (&
20456 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
20457 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
20458 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
20459 ("body" "white.*socks"))
20460 1000)
20461 @end example
20462
20463 The possibilities are endless.
20464
20465
20466 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
20467 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
20468
20469 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
20470 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
20471 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
20472 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
20473 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
20474 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
20475 @samp{subject}) first.
20476
20477 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
20478 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
20479 something like:
20480
20481 @example
20482 ...
20483 (1-
20484 (1-
20485 ("from" "lars")))
20486 ...
20487 @end example
20488
20489 Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
20490 current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
20491
20492 @example
20493 (1-
20494 (&
20495 ("from" "Lars")
20496 ("subject" "Gnus")))
20497 @end example
20498
20499 than it is to say:
20500
20501 @example
20502 (&
20503 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
20504 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
20505 @end example
20506
20507
20508 @node Score Decays
20509 @section Score Decays
20510 @cindex score decays
20511 @cindex decays
20512
20513 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
20514 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
20515 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
20516 use them in any sensible way.
20517
20518 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
20519 @findex gnus-decay-score
20520 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
20521 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
20522 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
20523 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
20524 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
20525 The decay itself if performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function}
20526 function, which is @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the
20527 definition of that function:
20528
20529 @lisp
20530 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
20531 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
20532 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
20533 (let ((n (- score
20534 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
20535 (min (abs score)
20536 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
20537 (* (abs score)
20538 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
20539 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
20540 ;; XEmacs' floor can handle only the floating point
20541 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
20542 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
20543 (string-to-number
20544 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
20545 (floor n))))
20546 @end lisp
20547
20548 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
20549 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
20550 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
20551 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
20552
20553 @enumerate
20554 @item
20555 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
20556
20557 @item
20558 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
20559
20560 @item
20561 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
20562 score.
20563 @end enumerate
20564
20565 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
20566 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
20567 the new score, which should be an integer.
20568
20569 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
20570 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
20571
20572 @iftex
20573 @iflatex
20574 @chapter Message
20575 @include message.texi
20576 @chapter Emacs MIME
20577 @include emacs-mime.texi
20578 @chapter Sieve
20579 @include sieve.texi
20580 @chapter PGG
20581 @include pgg.texi
20582 @end iflatex
20583 @end iftex
20584
20585 @node Various
20586 @chapter Various
20587
20588 @menu
20589 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
20590 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
20591 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
20592 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
20593 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
20594 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
20595 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
20596 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
20597 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
20598 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
20599 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
20600 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
20601 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
20602 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
20603 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
20604 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
20605 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
20606 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
20607 * Thwarting Email Spam:: A how-to on avoiding unsolicited commercial email.
20608 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
20609 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
20610 @end menu
20611
20612
20613 @node Process/Prefix
20614 @section Process/Prefix
20615 @cindex process/prefix convention
20616
20617 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
20618 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
20619
20620 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
20621 command to be performed on.
20622
20623 It goes like this:
20624
20625 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
20626 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
20627 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
20628 with the current one.
20629
20630 @vindex transient-mark-mode
20631 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
20632 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
20633
20634 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
20635 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
20636 the process mark.
20637
20638 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
20639 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
20640
20641 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
20642 are avoided.
20643
20644 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
20645 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
20646 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
20647 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
20648
20649 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
20650 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
20651 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
20652 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
20653 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
20654 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
20655 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
20656 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
20657
20658 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
20659 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
20660 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
20661 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
20662 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
20663
20664
20665 @node Interactive
20666 @section Interactive
20667 @cindex interaction
20668
20669 @table @code
20670
20671 @item gnus-novice-user
20672 @vindex gnus-novice-user
20673 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
20674 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
20675 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
20676 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
20677 default.
20678
20679 @item gnus-expert-user
20680 @vindex gnus-expert-user
20681 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
20682 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing, no
20683 matter how strange.
20684
20685 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
20686 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
20687 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
20688 is @code{t} by default.
20689
20690 @item gnus-interactive-exit
20691 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
20692 Require confirmation before exiting Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
20693 default.
20694 @end table
20695
20696
20697 @node Symbolic Prefixes
20698 @section Symbolic Prefixes
20699 @cindex symbolic prefixes
20700
20701 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
20702 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
20703 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
20704 rule of 900 to the current article.
20705
20706 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
20707 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
20708 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
20709 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
20710 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
20711 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
20712 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
20713
20714 @kindex M-i (Summary)
20715 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
20716 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
20717 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
20718 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
20719 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
20720 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
20721 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
20722 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
20723
20724 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
20725 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
20726 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
20727
20728 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
20729 Interactive}.
20730
20731
20732 @node Formatting Variables
20733 @section Formatting Variables
20734 @cindex formatting variables
20735
20736 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
20737 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
20738 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
20739 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
20740 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
20741 be annoyed by.
20742
20743 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
20744 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
20745 lots of percentages everywhere.
20746
20747 @menu
20748 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
20749 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
20750 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
20751 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
20752 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
20753 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
20754 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
20755 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
20756 @end menu
20757
20758 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
20759 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
20760 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
20761 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
20762 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
20763 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
20764 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
20765 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
20766
20767 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
20768 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
20769
20770 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
20771 @findex gnus-update-format
20772 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
20773 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
20774 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
20775 examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
20776
20777
20778
20779 @node Formatting Basics
20780 @subsection Formatting Basics
20781
20782 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
20783 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
20784 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
20785
20786 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
20787 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
20788 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
20789 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
20790 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
20791 the right instead.
20792
20793 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
20794 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
20795 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
20796 less than 4 characters wide.
20797
20798 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
20799 @samp{%&user-date;}.
20800
20801
20802 @node Mode Line Formatting
20803 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
20804
20805 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
20806 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
20807 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
20808 with the following two differences:
20809
20810 @enumerate
20811
20812 @item
20813 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
20814
20815 @item
20816 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
20817 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
20818 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
20819 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
20820 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
20821 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
20822 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
20823
20824 @end enumerate
20825
20826
20827 @node Advanced Formatting
20828 @subsection Advanced Formatting
20829
20830 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
20831 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
20832 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
20833 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
20834
20835 These are the valid modifiers:
20836
20837 @table @code
20838 @item pad
20839 @itemx pad-left
20840 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
20841 length.
20842
20843 @item pad-right
20844 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
20845 length.
20846
20847 @item max
20848 @itemx max-left
20849 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
20850
20851 @item max-right
20852 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
20853 length.
20854
20855 @item cut
20856 @itemx cut-left
20857 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
20858
20859 @item cut-right
20860 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
20861
20862 @item ignore
20863 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
20864
20865 @item form
20866 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
20867 used.
20868
20869 Here's an example:
20870
20871 @lisp
20872 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
20873 @end lisp
20874
20875 @end table
20876
20877 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
20878 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
20879 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
20880 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
20881 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
20882 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
20883 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
20884
20885 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
20886 last operation, padding.
20887
20888 If you use lots of these advanced thingies, you'll find that Gnus gets
20889 quite slow. This can be helped enormously by running @kbd{M-x
20890 gnus-compile} when you are satisfied with the look of your lines.
20891 @xref{Compilation}.
20892
20893
20894 @node User-Defined Specs
20895 @subsection User-Defined Specs
20896
20897 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
20898 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
20899 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
20900 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
20901 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
20902 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
20903 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
20904 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
20905 should protect against that.
20906
20907 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
20908 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
20909
20910 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
20911 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
20912 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
20913 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
20914 inserted.
20915
20916
20917 @node Formatting Fonts
20918 @subsection Formatting Fonts
20919
20920 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
20921 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
20922 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
20923 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
20924 over it.
20925
20926 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
20927 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
20928 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
20929 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
20930 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
20931 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
20932
20933 Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
20934 special @code{balloon-help} property set to
20935 @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
20936 @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
20937 variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
20938 return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
20939 set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
20940 refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
20941 (in GNU Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
20942 XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
20943 guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
20944 paragraph.)
20945
20946 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
20947
20948 @lisp
20949 ;; @r{Create three face types.}
20950 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
20951 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
20952
20953 ;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
20954 ;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
20955 ;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
20956 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
20957 ;; @r{Set the color.}
20958 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
20959 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
20960
20961 ;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
20962 (setq gnus-group-line-format
20963 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
20964 @end lisp
20965
20966 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
20967 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
20968
20969 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
20970 mode-line variables.
20971
20972 @node Positioning Point
20973 @subsection Positioning Point
20974
20975 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
20976 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
20977 line. You can customize this behaviour in three different ways.
20978
20979 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
20980
20981 @findex gnus-goto-colon
20982 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
20983 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
20984
20985 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
20986 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
20987 put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
20988 place point there.
20989
20990
20991 @node Tabulation
20992 @subsection Tabulation
20993
20994 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
20995 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
20996 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
20997 about lining up the following text afterwards.
20998
20999 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
21000 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
21001
21002 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21003 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
21004 This is the soft tabulator.
21005
21006 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21007 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
21008 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
21009
21010
21011 @node Wide Characters
21012 @subsection Wide Characters
21013
21014 Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
21015 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
21016 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
21017
21018 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
21019 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
21020 these countries, that's not true.
21021
21022 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
21023 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
21024 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
21025 prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
21026 for Emacs.
21027
21028
21029 @node Window Layout
21030 @section Window Layout
21031 @cindex window layout
21032
21033 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
21034
21035 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
21036 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
21037 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
21038 @code{t} by default.
21039
21040 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
21041 glitches. Use at your own peril.
21042
21043 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
21044 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
21045 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
21046
21047 @lisp
21048 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)
21049 (if gnus-carpal (group-carpal 4))))
21050 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21051 (article 1.0))))
21052 @end lisp
21053
21054 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
21055 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
21056 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
21057 possible names is listed below.
21058
21059 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
21060 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example -
21061
21062 @lisp
21063 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21064 (article 1.0)))
21065 @end lisp
21066
21067 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
21068 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
21069 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
21070 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
21071 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
21072 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
21073 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
21074 size spec per split.
21075
21076 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
21077 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
21078 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e. is the third or
21079 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
21080 present) gets focus.
21081
21082 Here's a more complicated example:
21083
21084 @lisp
21085 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
21086 (summary 0.25 point)
21087 (if gnus-carpal (summary-carpal 4))
21088 (article 1.0)))
21089 @end lisp
21090
21091 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
21092 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
21093 occupy, not a percentage.
21094
21095 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
21096 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
21097 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
21098 be used as a split. This means that there will be three buffers if
21099 @code{gnus-carpal} is @code{nil}, and four buffers if @code{gnus-carpal}
21100 is non-@code{nil}.
21101
21102 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
21103
21104 @lisp
21105 (article (horizontal 1.0
21106 (vertical 0.5
21107 (group 1.0)
21108 (gnus-carpal 4))
21109 (vertical 1.0
21110 (summary 0.25 point)
21111 (summary-carpal 4)
21112 (article 1.0))))
21113 @end lisp
21114
21115 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
21116 @code{horizontal} thingie?
21117
21118 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
21119 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
21120 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
21121 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
21122 the screen is to be given to this strip.
21123
21124 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
21125 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
21126 lines from the splits.
21127
21128 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
21129 may look like:
21130
21131 @example
21132 @group
21133 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
21134 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
21135 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
21136 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
21137 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
21138 size = number | frame-params
21139 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
21140 @end group
21141 @end example
21142
21143 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
21144 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
21145 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
21146 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
21147
21148 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
21149 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
21150 @cindex window height
21151 @cindex window width
21152 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
21153 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
21154 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
21155 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
21156 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
21157 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
21158
21159 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
21160 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
21161 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
21162 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
21163
21164 @findex gnus-configure-frame
21165 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
21166 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
21167 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
21168 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
21169 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
21170 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
21171 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
21172 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
21173 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
21174 configuration list.
21175
21176 @lisp
21177 (gnus-configure-frame
21178 '(horizontal 1.0
21179 (vertical 10
21180 (group 1.0)
21181 (article 0.3 point))
21182 (vertical 1.0
21183 (article 1.0)
21184 (horizontal 4
21185 (group 1.0)
21186 (article 10)))))
21187 @end lisp
21188
21189 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
21190 @code{frame} split:
21191
21192 @lisp
21193 (gnus-configure-frame
21194 '(frame 1.0
21195 (vertical 1.0
21196 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
21197 (article 1.0))
21198 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
21199 (user-position . t)
21200 (left . -1) (top . 1))
21201 (picon 1.0))))
21202
21203 @end lisp
21204
21205 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
21206 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
21207 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
21208 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
21209 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
21210 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
21211 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
21212 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
21213 is such a plist.
21214 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
21215 be found in its default value.
21216
21217 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
21218 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
21219 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
21220 might be used:
21221
21222 @lisp
21223 (message (horizontal 1.0
21224 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
21225 (vertical 0.24
21226 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
21227 '(summary 0.5))
21228 (group 1.0))))
21229 @end lisp
21230
21231 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
21232 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
21233 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
21234
21235 @lisp
21236 (message
21237 (frame 1.0
21238 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
21239 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
21240 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
21241 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
21242 (name . "Message"))
21243 (message 1.0 point))))
21244 @end lisp
21245
21246 @findex gnus-add-configuration
21247 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
21248 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
21249 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
21250 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
21251
21252 @lisp
21253 (gnus-add-configuration
21254 '(article (vertical 1.0
21255 (group 4)
21256 (summary .25 point)
21257 (article 1.0))))
21258 @end lisp
21259
21260 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
21261 @file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
21262 Gnus has been loaded.
21263
21264 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
21265 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
21266 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
21267 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
21268 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
21269
21270 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
21271 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
21272 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
21273 windows resized.
21274
21275 @subsection Example Window Configurations
21276
21277 @itemize @bullet
21278 @item
21279 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
21280 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
21281
21282 @ifinfo
21283 @example
21284 +---+---------+
21285 | G | Summary |
21286 | r +---------+
21287 | o | |
21288 | u | Article |
21289 | p | |
21290 +---+---------+
21291 @end example
21292 @end ifinfo
21293
21294 @lisp
21295 (gnus-add-configuration
21296 '(article
21297 (horizontal 1.0
21298 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
21299 (vertical 1.0
21300 (summary 0.16 point)
21301 (article 1.0)))))
21302
21303 (gnus-add-configuration
21304 '(summary
21305 (horizontal 1.0
21306 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
21307 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
21308 @end lisp
21309
21310 @end itemize
21311
21312
21313 @node Faces and Fonts
21314 @section Faces and Fonts
21315 @cindex faces
21316 @cindex fonts
21317 @cindex colors
21318
21319 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
21320 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
21321 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
21322 interface.
21323
21324
21325 @node Compilation
21326 @section Compilation
21327 @cindex compilation
21328 @cindex byte-compilation
21329
21330 @findex gnus-compile
21331
21332 Remember all those line format specification variables?
21333 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}, @code{gnus-group-line-format}, and so
21334 on. Now, Gnus will of course heed whatever these variables are, but,
21335 unfortunately, changing them will mean a quite significant slow-down.
21336 (The default values of these variables have byte-compiled functions
21337 associated with them, while the user-generated versions do not, of
21338 course.)
21339
21340 To help with this, you can run @kbd{M-x gnus-compile} after you've
21341 fiddled around with the variables and feel that you're (kind of)
21342 satisfied. This will result in the new specs being byte-compiled, and
21343 you'll get top speed again. Gnus will save these compiled specs in the
21344 @file{.newsrc.eld} file. (User-defined functions aren't compiled by
21345 this function, though---you should compile them yourself by sticking
21346 them into the @file{~/.gnus.el} file and byte-compiling that file.)
21347
21348
21349 @node Mode Lines
21350 @section Mode Lines
21351 @cindex mode lines
21352
21353 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
21354 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
21355 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
21356 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
21357 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
21358 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
21359 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
21360 quicker.
21361
21362 @cindex display-time
21363
21364 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
21365 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
21366 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
21367 to display (e.g. the subject of the article) is often longer than the
21368 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
21369 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
21370 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
21371 additional elements on the mode line (e.g. a clock), you should modify
21372 this variable:
21373
21374 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
21375 @lisp
21376 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
21377 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
21378 (+ 21
21379 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
21380 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
21381 (length display-time-string)))))
21382 @end lisp
21383
21384 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
21385 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
21386 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
21387 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
21388 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
21389
21390
21391 @node Highlighting and Menus
21392 @section Highlighting and Menus
21393 @cindex visual
21394 @cindex highlighting
21395 @cindex menus
21396
21397 @vindex gnus-visual
21398 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
21399 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
21400 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
21401 file.
21402
21403 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
21404 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
21405
21406 @table @code
21407 @item group-highlight
21408 Do highlights in the group buffer.
21409 @item summary-highlight
21410 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
21411 @item article-highlight
21412 Do highlights in the article buffer.
21413 @item highlight
21414 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
21415 @item group-menu
21416 Create menus in the group buffer.
21417 @item summary-menu
21418 Create menus in the summary buffers.
21419 @item article-menu
21420 Create menus in the article buffer.
21421 @item browse-menu
21422 Create menus in the browse buffer.
21423 @item server-menu
21424 Create menus in the server buffer.
21425 @item score-menu
21426 Create menus in the score buffers.
21427 @item menu
21428 Create menus in all buffers.
21429 @end table
21430
21431 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
21432 buffers, you could say something like:
21433
21434 @lisp
21435 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
21436 @end lisp
21437
21438 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
21439
21440 @lisp
21441 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
21442 @end lisp
21443
21444 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
21445 in all Gnus buffers.
21446
21447 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
21448
21449 @table @code
21450 @item gnus-mouse-face
21451 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
21452 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
21453 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
21454
21455 @end table
21456
21457 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
21458
21459 @table @code
21460
21461 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
21462 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
21463 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
21464
21465 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
21466 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
21467 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
21468
21469 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
21470 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
21471 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
21472
21473 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
21474 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
21475 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
21476
21477 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
21478 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
21479 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
21480
21481 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
21482 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
21483 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
21484
21485 @end table
21486
21487
21488 @node Buttons
21489 @section Buttons
21490 @cindex buttons
21491 @cindex mouse
21492 @cindex click
21493
21494 Those new-fangled @dfn{mouse} contraptions is very popular with the
21495 young, hep kids who don't want to learn the proper way to do things
21496 these days. Why, I remember way back in the summer of '89, when I was
21497 using Emacs on a Tops 20 system. Three hundred users on one single
21498 machine, and every user was running Simula compilers. Bah!
21499
21500 Right.
21501
21502 @vindex gnus-carpal
21503 Well, you can make Gnus display bufferfuls of buttons you can click to
21504 do anything by setting @code{gnus-carpal} to @code{t}. Pretty simple,
21505 really. Tell the chiropractor I sent you.
21506
21507
21508 @table @code
21509
21510 @item gnus-carpal-mode-hook
21511 @vindex gnus-carpal-mode-hook
21512 Hook run in all carpal mode buffers.
21513
21514 @item gnus-carpal-button-face
21515 @vindex gnus-carpal-button-face
21516 Face used on buttons.
21517
21518 @item gnus-carpal-header-face
21519 @vindex gnus-carpal-header-face
21520 Face used on carpal buffer headers.
21521
21522 @item gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
21523 @vindex gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
21524 Buttons in the group buffer.
21525
21526 @item gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
21527 @vindex gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
21528 Buttons in the summary buffer.
21529
21530 @item gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
21531 @vindex gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
21532 Buttons in the server buffer.
21533
21534 @item gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
21535 @vindex gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
21536 Buttons in the browse buffer.
21537 @end table
21538
21539 All the @code{buttons} variables are lists. The elements in these list
21540 are either cons cells where the @code{car} contains a text to be displayed and
21541 the @code{cdr} contains a function symbol, or a simple string.
21542
21543
21544 @node Daemons
21545 @section Daemons
21546 @cindex demons
21547 @cindex daemons
21548
21549 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
21550 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
21551 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
21552 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
21553 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
21554
21555 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
21556 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
21557 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
21558
21559 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
21560 been idle for thirty minutes:
21561
21562 @lisp
21563 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
21564 @end lisp
21565
21566 Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
21567 Emacs is idle:
21568
21569 @lisp
21570 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
21571 @end lisp
21572
21573 This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
21574 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
21575 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
21576
21577 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
21578 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
21579 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
21580 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
21581
21582 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
21583 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
21584 @var{idle} minutes.
21585
21586 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
21587 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
21588 minutes.
21589
21590 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
21591 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
21592 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
21593
21594 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
21595 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
21596 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
21597 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
21598
21599 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
21600 your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
21601
21602 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
21603 @lisp
21604 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
21605 @end lisp
21606
21607 @findex gnus-demon-add-nocem
21608 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
21609 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
21610 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
21611 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
21612 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
21613 @code{gnus-demon-add-nocem}, @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
21614 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
21615 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
21616 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
21617 @file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
21618
21619 @findex gnus-demon-init
21620 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
21621 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
21622 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
21623 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
21624 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
21625
21626 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
21627 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
21628 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
21629 behave.
21630
21631
21632 @node NoCeM
21633 @section NoCeM
21634 @cindex nocem
21635 @cindex spam
21636
21637 @dfn{Spamming} is posting the same article lots and lots of times.
21638 Spamming is bad. Spamming is evil.
21639
21640 Spamming is usually canceled within a day or so by various anti-spamming
21641 agencies. These agencies usually also send out @dfn{NoCeM} messages.
21642 NoCeM is pronounced ``no see-'em'', and means what the name
21643 implies---these are messages that make the offending articles, like, go
21644 away.
21645
21646 What use are these NoCeM messages if the articles are canceled anyway?
21647 Some sites do not honor cancel messages and some sites just honor cancels
21648 from a select few people. Then you may wish to make use of the NoCeM
21649 messages, which are distributed in the @samp{alt.nocem.misc} newsgroup.
21650
21651 Gnus can read and parse the messages in this group automatically, and
21652 this will make spam disappear.
21653
21654 There are some variables to customize, of course:
21655
21656 @table @code
21657 @item gnus-use-nocem
21658 @vindex gnus-use-nocem
21659 Set this variable to @code{t} to set the ball rolling. It is @code{nil}
21660 by default.
21661
21662 @item gnus-nocem-groups
21663 @vindex gnus-nocem-groups
21664 Gnus will look for NoCeM messages in the groups in this list. The
21665 default is
21666 @lisp
21667 ("news.lists.filters" "news.admin.net-abuse.bulletins"
21668 "alt.nocem.misc" "news.admin.net-abuse.announce")
21669 @end lisp
21670
21671 @item gnus-nocem-issuers
21672 @vindex gnus-nocem-issuers
21673 There are many people issuing NoCeM messages. This list says what
21674 people you want to listen to. The default is
21675 @lisp
21676 ("Automoose-1" "clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca"
21677 "cosmo.roadkill" "SpamHippo" "hweede@@snafu.de")
21678 @end lisp
21679 fine, upstanding citizens all of them.
21680
21681 Known despammers that you can put in this list are listed at@*
21682 @uref{http://www.xs4all.nl/~rosalind/nocemreg/nocemreg.html}.
21683
21684 You do not have to heed NoCeM messages from all these people---just the
21685 ones you want to listen to. You also don't have to accept all NoCeM
21686 messages from the people you like. Each NoCeM message has a @dfn{type}
21687 header that gives the message a (more or less, usually less) rigorous
21688 definition. Common types are @samp{spam}, @samp{spew}, @samp{mmf},
21689 @samp{binary}, and @samp{troll}. To specify this, you have to use
21690 @code{(@var{issuer} @var{conditions} @dots{})} elements in the list.
21691 Each condition is either a string (which is a regexp that matches types
21692 you want to use) or a list on the form @code{(not @var{string})}, where
21693 @var{string} is a regexp that matches types you don't want to use.
21694
21695 For instance, if you want all NoCeM messages from Chris Lewis except his
21696 @samp{troll} messages, you'd say:
21697
21698 @lisp
21699 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" ".*" (not "troll"))
21700 @end lisp
21701
21702 On the other hand, if you just want nothing but his @samp{spam} and
21703 @samp{spew} messages, you'd say:
21704
21705 @lisp
21706 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" (not ".*") "spew" "spam")
21707 @end lisp
21708
21709 The specs are applied left-to-right.
21710
21711
21712 @item gnus-nocem-verifyer
21713 @vindex gnus-nocem-verifyer
21714 @findex mc-verify
21715 This should be a function for verifying that the NoCeM issuer is who she
21716 says she is. The default is @code{mc-verify}, which is a Mailcrypt
21717 function. If this is too slow and you don't care for verification
21718 (which may be dangerous), you can set this variable to @code{nil}.
21719
21720 If you want signed NoCeM messages to be verified and unsigned messages
21721 not to be verified (but used anyway), you could do something like:
21722
21723 @lisp
21724 (setq gnus-nocem-verifyer 'my-gnus-mc-verify)
21725
21726 (defun my-gnus-mc-verify ()
21727 (not (eq 'forged
21728 (ignore-errors
21729 (if (mc-verify)
21730 t
21731 'forged)))))
21732 @end lisp
21733
21734 This might be dangerous, though.
21735
21736 @item gnus-nocem-directory
21737 @vindex gnus-nocem-directory
21738 This is where Gnus will store its NoCeM cache files. The default is@*
21739 @file{~/News/NoCeM/}.
21740
21741 @item gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
21742 @vindex gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
21743 The number of days before removing old NoCeM entries from the cache.
21744 The default is 15. If you make it shorter Gnus will be faster, but you
21745 might then see old spam.
21746
21747 @item gnus-nocem-check-from
21748 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-from
21749 Non-@code{nil} means check for valid issuers in message bodies.
21750 Otherwise don't bother fetching articles unless their author matches a
21751 valid issuer; that is much faster if you are selective about the
21752 issuers.
21753
21754 @item gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
21755 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
21756 If non-@code{nil}, the maximum number of articles to check in any NoCeM
21757 group. NoCeM groups can be huge and very slow to process.
21758
21759 @end table
21760
21761 Using NoCeM could potentially be a memory hog. If you have many living
21762 (i. e., subscribed or unsubscribed groups), your Emacs process will grow
21763 big. If this is a problem, you should kill off all (or most) of your
21764 unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Subscription Commands}).
21765
21766
21767 @node Undo
21768 @section Undo
21769 @cindex undo
21770
21771 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
21772 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
21773 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
21774
21775 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
21776 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
21777 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
21778 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
21779 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
21780 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
21781 @code{undo} function.
21782
21783 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
21784 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
21785 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
21786 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
21787 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
21788 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
21789 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
21790 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
21791 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
21792 never be totally undoable.
21793
21794 @findex gnus-undo-mode
21795 @vindex gnus-use-undo
21796 @findex gnus-undo
21797 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
21798 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
21799 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
21800 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
21801 command.
21802
21803
21804 @node Predicate Specifiers
21805 @section Predicate Specifiers
21806 @cindex predicate specifiers
21807
21808 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
21809 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
21810 to type all that much.
21811
21812 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
21813
21814 Here's an example:
21815
21816 @lisp
21817 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
21818 gnus-article-unread-p)
21819 @end lisp
21820
21821 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
21822 functions all take one parameter.
21823
21824 @findex gnus-make-predicate
21825 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
21826 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
21827 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
21828 specifier.
21829
21830
21831 @node Moderation
21832 @section Moderation
21833 @cindex moderation
21834
21835 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
21836 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
21837 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
21838 get a copy.
21839
21840 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
21841 buffers. Put
21842
21843 @lisp
21844 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
21845 @end lisp
21846
21847 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
21848
21849 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
21850 supposed to work:
21851
21852 @enumerate
21853 @item
21854 You split your incoming mail by matching on
21855 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
21856 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
21857
21858 @item
21859 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
21860 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
21861
21862 @item
21863 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
21864 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
21865 @kbd{c} command.
21866 @end enumerate
21867
21868 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
21869
21870 @lisp
21871 (setq gnus-moderated-list
21872 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
21873 @end lisp
21874
21875
21876 @node Fetching a Group
21877 @section Fetching a Group
21878 @cindex fetching a group
21879
21880 @findex gnus-fetch-group
21881 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
21882 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
21883 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
21884 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
21885 It takes the group name as a parameter.
21886
21887
21888 @node Image Enhancements
21889 @section Image Enhancements
21890
21891 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
21892 support images yet.}, is able to display pictures and stuff, so Gnus has
21893 taken advantage of that.
21894
21895 @menu
21896 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
21897 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
21898 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
21899 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
21900 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
21901 @end menu
21902
21903
21904 @node X-Face
21905 @subsection X-Face
21906 @cindex x-face
21907
21908 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
21909 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
21910 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
21911 readers.
21912
21913 @cindex x-face
21914 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
21915 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
21916 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
21917 @iftex
21918 @iflatex
21919 \include{xface}
21920 @end iflatex
21921 @end iftex
21922 @c @anchor{X-Face}
21923
21924 Decoding an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
21925 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions has), or that you
21926 have @samp{compface} installed on your system. If either is true,
21927 Gnus will default to displaying @code{X-Face} headers.
21928
21929 The variable that controls this is the
21930 @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} variable. If this variable is a
21931 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
21932 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
21933 If the @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches
21934 the @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
21935
21936 The default action under Emacs 20 is to fork off the @code{display}
21937 program@footnote{@code{display} is from the ImageMagick package. For
21938 the @code{uncompface} and @code{icontopbm} programs look for a package
21939 like @code{compface} or @code{faces-xface} on a GNU/Linux system.} to
21940 view the face.
21941
21942 Under XEmacs or Emacs 21+ with suitable image support, the default
21943 action is to display the face before the @code{From} header. (It's
21944 nicer if XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support---that
21945 will make display somewhat faster. If there's no native @code{X-Face}
21946 support, Gnus will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using
21947 external programs from the @code{pbmplus} package and
21948 friends.@footnote{On a GNU/Linux system look for packages with names
21949 like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.})
21950
21951 (Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
21952 @code{xface}).
21953
21954 @noindent
21955 Face and variable:
21956
21957 @table @code
21958 @item gnus-x-face
21959 @vindex gnus-x-face
21960 Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
21961 foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
21962 default colors are black and white.
21963 @end table
21964
21965 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
21966 easier insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages.
21967
21968 @findex gnus-random-x-face
21969 @vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
21970 @vindex gnus-x-face-directory
21971 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
21972 @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
21973 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
21974 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
21975 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
21976 header data as a string.
21977
21978 @findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
21979 @code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
21980 @code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
21981 randomly generated data.
21982
21983 @findex gnus-x-face-from-file
21984 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
21985 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
21986 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
21987 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
21988
21989 Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
21990 like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
21991
21992 @lisp
21993 (setq message-required-news-headers
21994 (nconc message-required-news-headers
21995 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
21996 @end lisp
21997
21998 Using the last function would be something like this:
21999
22000 @lisp
22001 (setq message-required-news-headers
22002 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22003 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
22004 (gnus-x-face-from-file
22005 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
22006 @end lisp
22007
22008
22009 @node Face
22010 @subsection Face
22011 @cindex face
22012
22013 @c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces'implementations should really be harmonized.
22014
22015 @code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
22016 ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
22017 represent the author of the message.
22018
22019 @cindex face
22020 @findex gnus-article-display-face
22021 The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
22022 See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
22023 specifications.
22024
22025 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
22026 easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
22027
22028 @findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
22029 @code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
22030 726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
22031
22032 @findex gnus-face-from-file
22033 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
22034 @code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
22035 converts the file to Face format by using the
22036 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
22037
22038 Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
22039 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22040
22041 @lisp
22042 (setq message-required-news-headers
22043 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22044 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
22045 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
22046 @end lisp
22047
22048
22049 @node Smileys
22050 @subsection Smileys
22051 @cindex smileys
22052
22053 @iftex
22054 @iflatex
22055 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
22056 \input{smiley}
22057 @end iflatex
22058 @end iftex
22059
22060 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
22061 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
22062
22063 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
22064 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22065
22066 @lisp
22067 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
22068 @end lisp
22069
22070 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
22071 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
22072 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
22073 text and maps that to file names.
22074
22075 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
22076 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
22077 variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
22078 the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
22079 the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
22080 displayed.
22081
22082 The following variables customize where Smiley will look for these
22083 files:
22084
22085 @table @code
22086
22087 @item smiley-data-directory
22088 @vindex smiley-data-directory
22089 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files.
22090
22091 @item gnus-smiley-file-types
22092 @vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
22093 List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
22094
22095 @end table
22096
22097
22098 @node Picons
22099 @subsection Picons
22100
22101 @iftex
22102 @iflatex
22103 \include{picons}
22104 @end iflatex
22105 @end iftex
22106
22107 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
22108 good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
22109 over your shoulder as you read news.
22110
22111 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
22112
22113 @iftex
22114 @iflatex
22115 \margindex{}
22116 @end iflatex
22117 @end iftex
22118
22119 @quotation
22120 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
22121 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
22122 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
22123 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
22124 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
22125 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
22126 @code{GIF} formats.
22127 @end quotation
22128
22129 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
22130 For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
22131 point your Web browser at
22132 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
22133
22134 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
22135 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
22136
22137 To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
22138 @code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
22139 Picons databases.
22140
22141 The following variables offer control over where things are located.
22142
22143 @table @code
22144
22145 @item gnus-picon-databases
22146 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
22147 The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
22148 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
22149 subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
22150 "/usr/local/faces")}.
22151
22152 @item gnus-picon-news-directories
22153 @vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
22154 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
22155 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
22156
22157 @item gnus-picon-user-directories
22158 @vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
22159 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
22160 faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
22161
22162 @item gnus-picon-domain-directories
22163 @vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
22164 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
22165 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
22166 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
22167
22168 @item gnus-picon-file-types
22169 @vindex gnus-picon-file-types
22170 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
22171 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
22172
22173 @end table
22174
22175
22176 @node XVarious
22177 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
22178
22179 @table @code
22180 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
22181 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
22182 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
22183 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
22184 unusual directory structure.
22185
22186 @item gnus-xmas-logo-color-alist
22187 @vindex gnus-xmas-logo-color-alist
22188 This is an alist where the key is a type symbol and the values are the
22189 foreground and background color of the splash page glyph.
22190
22191 @item gnus-xmas-logo-color-style
22192 @vindex gnus-xmas-logo-color-style
22193 This is the key used to look up the color in the alist described above.
22194 Valid values include @code{flame}, @code{pine}, @code{moss},
22195 @code{irish}, @code{sky}, @code{tin}, @code{velvet}, @code{grape},
22196 @code{labia}, @code{berry}, @code{neutral}, and @code{september}.
22197
22198 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
22199 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
22200 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
22201 default.
22202
22203 @end table
22204
22205 @subsubsection Toolbar
22206
22207 @table @code
22208
22209 @item gnus-use-toolbar
22210 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
22211 If @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If non-@code{nil}, it should be
22212 one of @code{default-toolbar}, @code{top-toolbar}, @code{bottom-toolbar},
22213 @code{right-toolbar}, or @code{left-toolbar}.
22214
22215 @item gnus-group-toolbar
22216 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
22217 The toolbar in the group buffer.
22218
22219 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
22220 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
22221 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
22222
22223 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
22224 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
22225 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
22226
22227 @end table
22228
22229 @iftex
22230 @iflatex
22231 \margindex{}
22232 @end iflatex
22233 @end iftex
22234
22235
22236 @node Fuzzy Matching
22237 @section Fuzzy Matching
22238 @cindex fuzzy matching
22239
22240 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
22241 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
22242
22243 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
22244 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
22245 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
22246
22247 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
22248 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
22249 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
22250 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
22251 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
22252
22253
22254 @node Thwarting Email Spam
22255 @section Thwarting Email Spam
22256 @cindex email spam
22257 @cindex spam
22258 @cindex UCE
22259 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22260
22261 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
22262 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
22263 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
22264 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
22265 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
22266 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
22267 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
22268 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
22269 in the end.
22270
22271 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
22272 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
22273 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
22274 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
22275 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
22276 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
22277
22278 This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
22279
22280 @menu
22281 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
22282 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
22283 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
22284 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
22285 * Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package::
22286 * Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat::
22287 @end menu
22288
22289 @node The problem of spam
22290 @subsection The problem of spam
22291 @cindex email spam
22292 @cindex spam filtering approaches
22293 @cindex filtering approaches, spam
22294 @cindex UCE
22295 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22296
22297 First, some background on spam.
22298
22299 If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
22300 termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
22301 exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
22302 so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
22303 make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
22304 common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
22305 further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
22306 but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
22307 @emph{morons} are in common use as well.
22308
22309 Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
22310 dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
22311 example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
22312 unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
22313 their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
22314 of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
22315 be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
22316 through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
22317 requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
22318 and processing.
22319
22320 The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
22321 server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
22322 messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
22323 @samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
22324 discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
22325 lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
22326 from Bulgarian IPs.
22327
22328 This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
22329 risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
22330 etc.) or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.) from contacting
22331 you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
22332
22333 In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
22334 been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
22335 words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
22336 cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
22337
22338 Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
22339 processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
22340 @var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
22341 Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
22342 @var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
22343 database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
22344 of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
22345 of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
22346 spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
22347
22348 Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
22349 a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
22350 fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
22351 spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
22352 well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
22353 sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
22354 down for some time because of the incident.
22355
22356 The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
22357 based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
22358 the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
22359 words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
22360 analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
22361 classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
22362 run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
22363 to store the database of spam analyses. Statistical analysis on the
22364 server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
22365 user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
22366 the server that it has misclassified mail.
22367
22368 Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
22369 magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
22370 Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
22371 because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
22372 are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
22373 idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
22374 a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
22375 spam plague.
22376
22377 @node Anti-Spam Basics
22378 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
22379 @cindex email spam
22380 @cindex spam
22381 @cindex UCE
22382 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22383
22384 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
22385 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
22386
22387 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
22388 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
22389 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
22390 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
22391 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
22392 part of the mail address.)
22393
22394 @lisp
22395 (setq message-default-news-headers
22396 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
22397 @end lisp
22398
22399 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
22400 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
22401
22402 @lisp
22403 (...
22404 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
22405 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
22406 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
22407 "spam"))
22408 ...)
22409 @end lisp
22410
22411 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
22412 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
22413 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
22414 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
22415
22416 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
22417 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
22418 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
22419 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
22420 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
22421 your fancy split rule in this way:
22422
22423 @lisp
22424 (
22425 ...
22426 (to "larsi" "misc")
22427 "spam")
22428 @end lisp
22429
22430 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
22431 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
22432 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
22433 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
22434 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
22435
22436 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
22437 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
22438 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
22439 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
22440
22441 Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
22442
22443
22444 @node SpamAssassin
22445 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
22446 @cindex SpamAssassin
22447 @cindex Vipul's Razor
22448 @cindex DCC
22449
22450 The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
22451 avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
22452 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
22453 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
22454 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
22455 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
22456 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
22457
22458 Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
22459 which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
22460 the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
22461 recipes.
22462
22463 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
22464 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
22465 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
22466 Specifiers}) follow.
22467
22468 @lisp
22469 (setq mail-sources
22470 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
22471 (pop :user "jrl"
22472 :server "pophost"
22473 :postscript
22474 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
22475 @end lisp
22476
22477 Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
22478 the mail contain e.g.@: a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
22479 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
22480
22481 @lisp
22482 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
22483 ...))
22484 @end lisp
22485
22486 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
22487
22488 @lisp
22489 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
22490 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
22491 ...))
22492 @end lisp
22493
22494 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
22495 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
22496 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
22497 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
22498
22499 @lisp
22500 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
22501 ...))
22502 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
22503 (save-excursion
22504 (save-restriction
22505 (widen)
22506 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
22507 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
22508 "spam"))))
22509 @end lisp
22510
22511 Note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will not be
22512 downloaded by default. You need to set
22513 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
22514 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
22515
22516 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
22517 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
22518 spam. And here is the nifty function:
22519
22520 @lisp
22521 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
22522 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
22523 (interactive)
22524 (gnus-summary-show-raw-article)
22525 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d")
22526 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
22527 @end lisp
22528
22529 @node Hashcash
22530 @subsection Hashcash
22531 @cindex hashcash
22532
22533 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
22534 costly for each message they send. This has the obvious drawback that
22535 you cannot rely on everyone in the world using this technique,
22536 since it is not part of the Internet standards, but it may be useful
22537 in smaller communities.
22538
22539 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
22540 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
22541 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
22542 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
22543 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
22544 instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
22545 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
22546 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
22547 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
22548 one of them separately.
22549
22550 @cindex X-Hashcash
22551 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
22552 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
22553 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:}
22554 header. For more details, and for the external application
22555 @code{hashcash} you need to install to use this feature, see
22556 @uref{http://www.cypherspace.org/~adam/hashcash/}. Even more
22557 information can be found at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
22558
22559 If you wish to call hashcash for each message you send, say something
22560 like:
22561
22562 @lisp
22563 (require 'hashcash)
22564 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'mail-add-payment)
22565 @end lisp
22566
22567 The @file{hashcash.el} library can be found in the Gnus development
22568 contrib directory or at
22569 @uref{http://users.actrix.gen.nz/mycroft/hashcash.el}.
22570
22571 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
22572
22573 @table @code
22574
22575 @item hashcash-default-payment
22576 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
22577 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
22578 should consist of. By default this is 0, meaning nothing will be
22579 done. Suggested useful values include 17 to 29.
22580
22581 @item hashcash-payment-alist
22582 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
22583 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
22584 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
22585 @var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
22586 or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
22587 that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
22588 @var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
22589 (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
22590
22591 @item hashcash
22592 @vindex hashcash
22593 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed.
22594
22595 @end table
22596
22597 Currently there is no built in functionality in Gnus to verify
22598 hashcash cookies, it is expected that this is performed by your hand
22599 customized mail filtering scripts. Improvements in this area would be
22600 a useful contribution, however.
22601
22602 @node Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package
22603 @subsection Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package
22604 @cindex spam filtering
22605 @cindex spam
22606
22607 The idea behind @file{spam.el} is to have a control center for spam detection
22608 and filtering in Gnus. To that end, @file{spam.el} does two things: it
22609 filters new mail, and it analyzes mail known to be spam or ham.
22610 @dfn{Ham} is the name used throughout @file{spam.el} to indicate
22611 non-spam messages.
22612
22613 @cindex spam-initialize
22614 First of all, you @strong{must} run the function
22615 @code{spam-initialize} to autoload @code{spam.el} and to install the
22616 @code{spam.el} hooks. There is one exception: if you use the
22617 @code{spam-use-stat} (@pxref{spam-stat spam filtering}) setting, you
22618 should turn it on before @code{spam-initialize}:
22619
22620 @example
22621 (setq spam-use-stat t) ;; if needed
22622 (spam-initialize)
22623 @end example
22624
22625 So, what happens when you load @file{spam.el}?
22626
22627 First, some hooks will get installed by @code{spam-initialize}. There
22628 are some hooks for @code{spam-stat} so it can save its databases, and
22629 there are hooks so interesting things will happen when you enter and
22630 leave a group. More on the sequence of events later (@pxref{Spam
22631 ELisp Package Sequence of Events}).
22632
22633 You get the following keyboard commands:
22634
22635 @table @kbd
22636
22637 @item M-d
22638 @itemx M s x
22639 @itemx S x
22640 @kindex M-d
22641 @kindex S x
22642 @kindex M s x
22643 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
22644 @code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}.
22645
22646 Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark.
22647 Whenever you see a spam article, make sure to mark its summary line
22648 with @kbd{M-d} before leaving the group. This is done automatically
22649 for unread articles in @emph{spam} groups.
22650
22651 @item M s t
22652 @itemx S t
22653 @kindex M s t
22654 @kindex S t
22655 @findex spam-bogofilter-score
22656 @code{spam-bogofilter-score}.
22657
22658 You must have Bogofilter installed for that command to work properly.
22659
22660 @xref{Bogofilter}.
22661
22662 @end table
22663
22664 Also, when you load @file{spam.el}, you will be able to customize its
22665 variables. Try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{spam} variable
22666 group.
22667
22668 @menu
22669 * Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events::
22670 * Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail::
22671 * Spam ELisp Package Global Variables::
22672 * Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples::
22673 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
22674 * BBDB Whitelists::
22675 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
22676 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
22677 * Blackholes::
22678 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
22679 * Bogofilter::
22680 * ifile spam filtering::
22681 * spam-stat spam filtering::
22682 * SpamOracle::
22683 * Extending the Spam ELisp package::
22684 @end menu
22685
22686 @node Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events
22687 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events
22688 @cindex spam filtering
22689 @cindex spam filtering sequence of events
22690 @cindex spam
22691
22692 You must read this section to understand how @code{spam.el} works.
22693 Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
22694
22695 There are two @emph{contact points}, if you will, between
22696 @code{spam.el} and the rest of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and
22697 leaving a group.
22698
22699 Getting new mail is done in one of two ways. You can either split
22700 your incoming mail or you can classify new articles as ham or spam
22701 when you enter the group.
22702
22703 Splitting incoming mail is better suited to mail backends such as
22704 @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap} where new mail appears in a single file
22705 called a @dfn{Spool File}. See @xref{Spam ELisp Package Filtering of
22706 Incoming Mail}.
22707
22708 For backends such as @code{nntp} there is no incoming mail spool, so
22709 an alternate mechanism must be used. This may also happen for
22710 backends where the server is in charge of splitting incoming mail, and
22711 Gnus does not do further splitting. The @code{spam-autodetect} and
22712 @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameters (accessible with
22713 @kbd{G c} and @kbd{G p} as usual), and the corresponding variables
22714 @code{gnus-spam-autodetect-methods} and
22715 @code{gnus-spam-autodetect-methods} (accessible with @kbd{M-x
22716 customize-variable} as usual).
22717
22718 When @code{spam-autodetect} is used, it hooks into the process of
22719 entering a group. Thus, entering a group with unseen or unread
22720 articles becomes the substitute for checking incoming mail. Whether
22721 only unseen articles or all unread articles will be processed is
22722 determined by the @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages}. When set
22723 to @code{t}, unread messages will be rechecked.
22724
22725 @code{spam-autodetect} grants the user at once more and less control
22726 of spam filtering. The user will have more control over each group's
22727 spam methods, so for instance the @samp{ding} group may have
22728 @code{spam-use-BBDB} as the autodetection method, while the
22729 @samp{suspect} group may have the @code{spam-use-blacklist} and
22730 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods enabled. Every article detected to
22731 be spam will be marked with the spam mark @samp{$} and processed on
22732 exit from the group as normal spam. The user has less control over
22733 the @emph{sequence} of checks, as he might with @code{spam-split}.
22734
22735 When the newly split mail goes into groups, or messages are
22736 autodetected to be ham or spam, those groups must be exited (after
22737 entering, if needed) for further spam processing to happen. It
22738 matters whether the group is considered a ham group, a spam group, or
22739 is unclassified, based on its @code{spam-content} parameter
22740 (@pxref{Spam ELisp Package Global Variables}). Spam groups have the
22741 additional characteristic that, when entered, any unseen or unread
22742 articles (depending on the @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam}
22743 variable) will be marked as spam. Thus, mail split into a spam group
22744 gets automatically marked as spam when you enter the group.
22745
22746 So, when you exit a group, the @code{spam-processors} are applied, if
22747 any are set, and the processed mail is moved to the
22748 @code{ham-process-destination} or the @code{spam-process-destination}
22749 depending on the article's classification. If the
22750 @code{ham-process-destination} or the @code{spam-process-destination},
22751 whichever is appropriate, are @code{nil}, the article is left in the
22752 current group.
22753
22754 If a spam is found in any group (this can be changed to only non-spam
22755 groups with @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only}), it is
22756 processed by the active @code{spam-processors} (@pxref{Spam ELisp
22757 Package Global Variables}) when the group is exited. Furthermore, the
22758 spam is moved to the @code{spam-process-destination} (@pxref{Spam
22759 ELisp Package Global Variables}) for further training or deletion.
22760 You have to load the @code{gnus-registry.el} package and enable the
22761 @code{spam-log-to-registry} variable if you want spam to be processed
22762 no more than once. Thus, spam is detected and processed everywhere,
22763 which is what most people want. If the
22764 @code{spam-process-destination} is @code{nil}, the spam is marked as
22765 expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
22766
22767 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
22768 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
22769
22770 If a ham mail is found in a ham group, as determined by the
22771 @code{ham-marks} parameter, it is processed as ham by the active ham
22772 @code{spam-processor} when the group is exited. With the variables
22773 @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
22774 @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} the behavior can be further
22775 altered so ham found anywhere can be processed. You have to load the
22776 @code{gnus-registry.el} package and enable the
22777 @code{spam-log-to-registry} variable if you want ham to be processed
22778 no more than once. Thus, ham is detected and processed only when
22779 necessary, which is what most people want. More on this in
22780 @xref{Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples}.
22781
22782 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
22783 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
22784
22785 If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
22786 as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
22787 50 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
22788
22789 @node Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail
22790 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail
22791 @cindex spam filtering
22792 @cindex spam filtering incoming mail
22793 @cindex spam
22794
22795 To use the @file{spam.el} facilities for incoming mail filtering, you
22796 must add the following to your fancy split list
22797 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}:
22798
22799 @example
22800 (: spam-split)
22801 @end example
22802
22803 Note that the fancy split may be called @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
22804 @code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on whether you use the nnmail or
22805 nnimap back ends to retrieve your mail.
22806
22807 Also, @code{spam-split} will not modify incoming mail in any way.
22808
22809 The @code{spam-split} function will process incoming mail and send the
22810 mail considered to be spam into the group name given by the variable
22811 @code{spam-split-group}. By default that group name is @samp{spam},
22812 but you can customize @code{spam-split-group}. Make sure the contents
22813 of @code{spam-split-group} are an @emph{unqualified} group name, for
22814 instance in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server} the value
22815 @samp{spam} will turn out to be @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The
22816 value @samp{nnimap+server:spam}, therefore, is wrong and will
22817 actually give you the group
22818 @samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam} which may or may not
22819 work depending on your server's tolerance for strange group names.
22820
22821 You can also give @code{spam-split} a parameter,
22822 e.g. @code{spam-use-regex-headers} or @code{"maybe-spam"}. Why is
22823 this useful?
22824
22825 Take these split rules (with @code{spam-use-regex-headers} and
22826 @code{spam-use-blackholes} set):
22827
22828 @example
22829 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
22830 (any "ding" "ding")
22831 (: spam-split)
22832 ;; @r{default mailbox}
22833 "mail")
22834 @end example
22835
22836 Now, the problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the
22837 ding folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam
22838 detected by SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through,
22839 when it's sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to
22840 the ding list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the
22841 invocation of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
22842
22843 You can let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, but all other
22844 @code{spam-split} rules (including a second invocation of the
22845 regex-headers check) will be after the ding rule:
22846
22847 @example
22848 nnimap-split-fancy
22849 '(|
22850 ;; @r{all spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
22851 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
22852 (any "ding" "ding")
22853 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
22854 (: spam-split)
22855 ;; @r{default mailbox}
22856 "mail")
22857 @end example
22858
22859 This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
22860 your particular needs, and to target the results of those checks to a
22861 particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
22862 spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
22863 mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
22864 blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
22865 spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
22866
22867 You should still have specific checks such as
22868 @code{spam-use-regex-headers} set to @code{t}, even if you
22869 specifically invoke @code{spam-split} with the check. The reason is
22870 that when loading @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done
22871 depending on what @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. This
22872 is usually not critical, though.
22873
22874 @emph{Note for IMAP users}
22875
22876 The boolean variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body} needs to be
22877 set, if you want to split based on the whole message instead of just
22878 the headers. By default, the nnimap back end will only retrieve the
22879 message headers. If you use @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
22880 @code{spam-check-ifile}, or @code{spam-check-stat} (the splitters that
22881 can benefit from the full message body), you should set this variable.
22882 It is not set by default because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and
22883 that is not an appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user.
22884
22885 @xref{Splitting in IMAP}.
22886
22887 @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
22888 statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
22889 don't.}
22890
22891 @node Spam ELisp Package Global Variables
22892 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Global Variables
22893 @cindex spam filtering
22894 @cindex spam filtering variables
22895 @cindex spam variables
22896 @cindex spam
22897
22898 @vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
22899 The concepts of ham processors and spam processors are very important.
22900 Ham processors and spam processors for a group can be set with the
22901 @code{spam-process} group parameter, or the
22902 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. Ham processors take
22903 mail known to be non-spam (@emph{ham}) and process it in some way so
22904 that later similar mail will also be considered non-spam. Spam
22905 processors take mail known to be spam and process it so similar spam
22906 will be detected later.
22907
22908 The format of the spam or ham processor entry used to be a symbol,
22909 but now it is a @sc{cons} cell. See the individual spam processor entries
22910 for more information.
22911
22912 @vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
22913 Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
22914 one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
22915 @code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
22916 groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
22917 @code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
22918 by customizing the corresponding variable
22919 @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
22920 parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
22921 also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
22922 classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
22923 groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
22924 @code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
22925 considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
22926 default.
22927
22928 @vindex gnus-spam-mark
22929 @cindex $
22930 In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
22931 they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
22932 group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
22933 unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
22934 thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
22935 will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
22936 @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
22937 should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
22938 buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
22939 @samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
22940 @kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
22941 group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
22942 processor which will study them as spam samples.
22943
22944 Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
22945 @code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
22946 and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
22947 @samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
22948 low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
22949 are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
22950 use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
22951 should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
22952
22953 @defvar ham-marks
22954 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
22955 marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
22956 deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
22957 that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
22958 useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
22959 recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
22960 indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
22961 happy for you.
22962 @end defvar
22963
22964 @defvar spam-marks
22965 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
22966 marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
22967 the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
22968 you really want to.
22969 @end defvar
22970
22971 When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
22972 @code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
22973 to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
22974 explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
22975 @samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
22976 spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
22977 and nothing else.
22978
22979 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
22980 When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
22981 marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
22982 not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
22983 @strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
22984 determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
22985 parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
22986 variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
22987 names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
22988 customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
22989 group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
22990 the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
22991 parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
22992 @code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
22993 set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
22994
22995 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
22996 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
22997
22998 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
22999 expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
23000 group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
23001
23002 When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
23003 a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
23004
23005 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
23006 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
23007 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
23008 to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
23009 to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
23010
23011 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
23012 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
23013 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
23014 or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
23015 you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
23016 it there.
23017
23018 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
23019 When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
23020 @strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
23021 the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
23022 @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
23023 regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
23024 customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
23025 gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
23026 Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
23027 @code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
23028 articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
23029 that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
23030 group buffer then you need it here as well.
23031
23032 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
23033 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
23034
23035 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
23036 expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
23037 training} groups.
23038
23039 @vindex spam-log-to-registry
23040 The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
23041 this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
23042 variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
23043 what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
23044 multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
23045 entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
23046
23047 @vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
23048 Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
23049 be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
23050 @code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
23051
23052 @vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
23053 Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
23054 out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
23055 like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
23056 in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
23057 from the mail server.
23058
23059 @vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
23060 When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
23061 only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
23062 spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
23063
23064 @node Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples
23065 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples
23066 @cindex spam filtering
23067 @cindex spam filtering configuration examples
23068 @cindex spam configuration examples
23069 @cindex spam
23070
23071 @subsubheading Ted's setup
23072
23073 From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
23074 @example
23075 ;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
23076 ;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
23077 (gnus-registry-initialize)
23078 (spam-initialize)
23079
23080 ;; @r{I like @kbd{C-s} for marking spam}
23081 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map "\C-s" 'gnus-summary-mark-as-spam)
23082
23083 (setq
23084 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
23085 spam-use-BBDB t
23086 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
23087 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
23088 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
23089 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23090 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
23091 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
23092 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
23093 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
23094 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
23095 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
23096 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
23097 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
23098 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
23099 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
23100 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
23101 (any "ding" "ding")
23102 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
23103 (: spam-split)
23104 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23105 "mail"))
23106
23107 ;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
23108
23109 ;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
23110 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
23111 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
23112 ;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
23113
23114 ((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23115
23116 ;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
23117 ;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
23118 ((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
23119 ;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
23120 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23121
23122 ;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
23123 ((spam-autodetect . t))
23124
23125 ;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
23126
23127 ;; @r{this is a spam group}
23128 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
23129
23130 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
23131 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
23132 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
23133
23134 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
23135
23136 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
23137 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
23138
23139 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
23140 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
23141 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
23142 (ham-marks
23143 (gnus-ticked-mark))
23144 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
23145 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
23146 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
23147
23148 ;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
23149 ;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
23150 ;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
23151
23152 @end example
23153
23154 @subsubheading Using @file{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
23155 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
23156
23157 My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
23158 the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
23159 @samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
23160 i.e. to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
23161 positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
23162 @samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
23163 the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
23164 options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
23165 @samp{training.spam} folders.
23166
23167 With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
23168 does most of the job for me:
23169
23170 @lisp
23171 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
23172 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
23173 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
23174 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23175 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
23176 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
23177 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
23178 @end lisp
23179
23180 @itemize
23181
23182 @item @b{The Spam folder:}
23183
23184 In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
23185 (i.e. legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
23186 bogofilter or DCC).
23187
23188 Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
23189 messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
23190 positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark (@code{ham-marks},
23191 @ref{Spam ELisp Package Global Variables}). On group exit, those
23192 messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want to have
23193 the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter) and
23194 deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
23195
23196 The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
23197 false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
23198 have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e. chars) makes finding
23199 other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
23200 (@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
23201 an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
23202
23203 @item @b{Ham folders:}
23204
23205 In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
23206 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
23207 mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
23208 @samp{training.ham}.
23209 @end itemize
23210
23211 @subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
23212
23213 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
23214
23215 With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
23216 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
23217 groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
23218
23219 @lisp
23220 ("^gmane\\."
23221 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
23222 @end lisp
23223
23224 Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
23225 because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
23226 through my local news server (leafnode). I.e. the article numbers are
23227 not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
23228 the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
23229
23230 @node Blacklists and Whitelists
23231 @subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
23232 @cindex spam filtering
23233 @cindex whitelists, spam filtering
23234 @cindex blacklists, spam filtering
23235 @cindex spam
23236
23237 @defvar spam-use-blacklist
23238
23239 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
23240 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
23241 will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
23242 filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
23243 be spammers.
23244
23245 @end defvar
23246
23247 @defvar spam-use-whitelist
23248
23249 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
23250 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
23251 whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
23252 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
23253 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
23254
23255 @end defvar
23256
23257 @defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
23258
23259 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
23260 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
23261 unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
23262
23263 @end defvar
23264
23265 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
23266
23267 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23268 customizing the group parameters or the
23269 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23270 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23271 spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
23272
23273 @emph{WARNING}
23274
23275 Instead of the obsolete
23276 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
23277 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
23278 the same way, we promise.
23279
23280 @end defvar
23281
23282 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
23283
23284 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23285 customizing the group parameters or the
23286 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23287 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23288 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
23289 whitelist. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
23290 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23291
23292 @emph{WARNING}
23293
23294 Instead of the obsolete
23295 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
23296 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
23297 the same way, we promise.
23298
23299 @end defvar
23300
23301 Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
23302 consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
23303 sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
23304 blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
23305 use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
23306
23307 Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
23308 legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
23309 non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
23310 Emacs regular expression syntax.
23311
23312 The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
23313 @code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
23314 the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
23315 directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
23316 @code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
23317 @file{blacklist} respectively.
23318
23319 @node BBDB Whitelists
23320 @subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
23321 @cindex spam filtering
23322 @cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
23323 @cindex BBDB, spam filtering
23324 @cindex spam
23325
23326 @defvar spam-use-BBDB
23327
23328 Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
23329 Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
23330 addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
23331 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
23332 not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
23333 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
23334 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
23335
23336 @end defvar
23337
23338 @defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
23339
23340 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
23341 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
23342 unless the sender is in the BBDB. Use with care. Only sender
23343 addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
23344 classified as spammers.
23345
23346 @end defvar
23347
23348 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
23349
23350 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23351 customizing the group parameters or the
23352 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23353 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23354 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
23355 BBDB. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
23356 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23357
23358 @emph{WARNING}
23359
23360 Instead of the obsolete
23361 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
23362 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
23363 the same way, we promise.
23364
23365 @end defvar
23366
23367 @node Gmane Spam Reporting
23368 @subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
23369 @cindex spam reporting
23370 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
23371 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
23372 @cindex spam
23373
23374 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
23375
23376 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23377 customizing the group parameters or the
23378 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23379 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
23380 articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
23381 HTTP request.
23382
23383 Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
23384
23385 @emph{WARNING}
23386
23387 Instead of the obsolete
23388 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
23389 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
23390 same way, we promise.
23391
23392 @end defvar
23393
23394 @defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
23395
23396 This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
23397 running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
23398 numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
23399 @code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
23400 @code{spam-report.el} will use the @code{X-Report-Spam} header that
23401 Gmane provides.
23402
23403 @end defvar
23404
23405 @node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
23406 @subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
23407 @cindex spam filtering
23408 @cindex hashcash, spam filtering
23409 @cindex spam
23410
23411 @defvar spam-use-hashcash
23412
23413 Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
23414 Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
23415 instead of the sender address. You must have the @code{hashcash.el}
23416 package loaded for @code{spam-use-hashcash} to work properly.
23417 Messages without a hashcash payment token will be sent to the next
23418 spam-split rule. This is an explicit filter, meaning that unless a
23419 hashcash token is found, the messages are not assumed to be spam or
23420 ham.
23421
23422 @end defvar
23423
23424 @node Blackholes
23425 @subsubsection Blackholes
23426 @cindex spam filtering
23427 @cindex blackholes, spam filtering
23428 @cindex spam
23429
23430 @defvar spam-use-blackholes
23431
23432 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
23433 blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
23434 when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
23435 holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
23436 list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
23437 contains outdated servers.
23438
23439 The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
23440 @file{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
23441 you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
23442 this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
23443 possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
23444 use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
23445
23446 @end defvar
23447
23448 @defvar spam-blackhole-servers
23449
23450 The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
23451
23452 @end defvar
23453
23454 @defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
23455
23456 A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
23457 blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
23458
23459 @end defvar
23460
23461 @defvar spam-use-dig
23462
23463 Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
23464 The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
23465
23466 @end defvar
23467
23468 Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
23469 ham processor for blackholes.
23470
23471 @node Regular Expressions Header Matching
23472 @subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
23473 @cindex spam filtering
23474 @cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
23475 @cindex spam
23476
23477 @defvar spam-use-regex-headers
23478
23479 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
23480 message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
23481 option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
23482 @code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
23483 Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
23484 message is spam or ham, respectively.
23485
23486 @end defvar
23487
23488 @defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
23489
23490 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
23491 the message, positively identify it as spam.
23492
23493 @end defvar
23494
23495 @defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
23496
23497 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
23498 the message, positively identify it as ham.
23499
23500 @end defvar
23501
23502 Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
23503 There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
23504
23505 @node Bogofilter
23506 @subsubsection Bogofilter
23507 @cindex spam filtering
23508 @cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
23509 @cindex spam
23510
23511 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter
23512
23513 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
23514 speedy Bogofilter.
23515
23516 With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
23517 articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
23518 should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
23519 category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
23520 for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
23521 the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
23522
23523 Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
23524 threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
23525 documentation.
23526
23527 If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
23528 processing will be turned off.
23529
23530 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
23531
23532 @end defvar
23533
23534 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
23535
23536 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
23537 speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
23538 similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
23539 must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
23540 procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
23541 installation documents for details.
23542
23543 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
23544
23545 @end defvar
23546
23547 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
23548 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23549 customizing the group parameters or the
23550 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23551 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
23552 will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
23553
23554 @emph{WARNING}
23555
23556 Instead of the obsolete
23557 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
23558 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
23559 the same way, we promise.
23560 @end defvar
23561
23562 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
23563 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23564 customizing the group parameters or the
23565 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23566 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
23567 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
23568 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
23569 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23570
23571 @emph{WARNING}
23572
23573 Instead of the obsolete
23574 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
23575 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
23576 the same way, we promise.
23577 @end defvar
23578
23579 @defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
23580
23581 This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
23582 is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
23583 database directory.
23584
23585 @end defvar
23586
23587 The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
23588 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
23589 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
23590 variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
23591 used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
23592 Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
23593
23594 @node ifile spam filtering
23595 @subsubsection ifile spam filtering
23596 @cindex spam filtering
23597 @cindex ifile, spam filtering
23598 @cindex spam
23599
23600 @defvar spam-use-ifile
23601
23602 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
23603 statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
23604
23605 @end defvar
23606
23607 @defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
23608
23609 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
23610 the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
23611 sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
23612
23613 @end defvar
23614
23615 @defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
23616
23617 This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
23618 The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
23619 the default value of @samp{spam}.
23620 @end defvar
23621
23622 @defvar spam-ifile-database-path
23623
23624 This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
23625 default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
23626
23627 @end defvar
23628
23629 The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
23630 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
23631 @code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
23632 should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
23633 functionality.
23634
23635 @node spam-stat spam filtering
23636 @subsubsection spam-stat spam filtering
23637 @cindex spam filtering
23638 @cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
23639 @cindex spam-stat
23640 @cindex spam
23641
23642 @xref{Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat}.
23643
23644 @defvar spam-use-stat
23645
23646 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use
23647 spam-stat.el, an Emacs Lisp statistical analyzer.
23648
23649 @end defvar
23650
23651 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
23652 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23653 customizing the group parameters or the
23654 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23655 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
23656 articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
23657
23658 @emph{WARNING}
23659
23660 Instead of the obsolete
23661 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
23662 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
23663 the same way, we promise.
23664 @end defvar
23665
23666 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
23667 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23668 customizing the group parameters or the
23669 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23670 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
23671 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
23672 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
23673 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23674
23675 @emph{WARNING}
23676
23677 Instead of the obsolete
23678 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
23679 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
23680 the same way, we promise.
23681 @end defvar
23682
23683 This enables @file{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
23684 @file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
23685 which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
23686 A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
23687 @code{spam-split} are provided.
23688
23689 @node SpamOracle
23690 @subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
23691 @cindex spam filtering
23692 @cindex SpamOracle
23693 @cindex spam
23694
23695 An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
23696 statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
23697 installed separately.
23698
23699 There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
23700 mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
23701 then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
23702 mail as a spam mail or not.
23703
23704 One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
23705 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
23706 the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
23707
23708 The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Filtering Spam
23709 Using The Spam ELisp Package}) call SpamOracle.
23710
23711 @vindex spam-use-spamoracle
23712 To enable SpamOracle usage by @file{spam.el}, set the variable
23713 @code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
23714 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy} as described in
23715 the section @xref{Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package}. In
23716 this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is filtered using
23717 SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be moved to
23718 @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham messages stay
23719 in @samp{INBOX}:
23720
23721 @example
23722 (setq spam-use-spamoracle t
23723 spam-split-group "Junk"
23724 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
23725 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
23726 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
23727 @end example
23728
23729 @defvar spam-use-spamoracle
23730 Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
23731 SpamOracle.
23732 @end defvar
23733
23734 @defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
23735 Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
23736 user's PATH. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
23737 can be customized.
23738 @end defvar
23739
23740 @defvar spam-spamoracle-database
23741 By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
23742 store its analyses. This is controlled by the variable
23743 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
23744 the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
23745 database to live somewhere special, set
23746 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
23747 @end defvar
23748
23749 SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
23750 message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
23751 false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns the
23752 characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
23753 (training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
23754 SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary buffer
23755 and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using @file{spam.el}'s
23756 spam- and ham-processors, which is much more convenient. For a
23757 detailed description of spam- and ham-processors, @xref{Filtering Spam
23758 Using The Spam ELisp Package}.
23759
23760 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
23761 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23762 customizing the group parameter or the
23763 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
23764 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
23765 sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
23766
23767 @emph{WARNING}
23768
23769 Instead of the obsolete
23770 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
23771 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
23772 the same way, we promise.
23773 @end defvar
23774
23775 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
23776 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23777 customizing the group parameter or the
23778 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
23779 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
23780 @emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
23781 messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam} or
23782 @emph{unclassified} groups.
23783
23784 @emph{WARNING}
23785
23786 Instead of the obsolete
23787 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
23788 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
23789 the same way, we promise.
23790 @end defvar
23791
23792 @emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
23793 classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
23794 messages.
23795 @example
23796 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
23797 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
23798 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
23799 @end example
23800 For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
23801 ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
23802 (e.g. because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
23803 the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
23804 processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
23805 SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
23806
23807 @node Extending the Spam ELisp package
23808 @subsubsection Extending the Spam ELisp package
23809 @cindex spam filtering
23810 @cindex spam elisp package, extending
23811 @cindex extending the spam elisp package
23812
23813 Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
23814 incoming mail, provide the following:
23815
23816 @enumerate
23817
23818 @item
23819 Code
23820
23821 @lisp
23822 (defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
23823 "True if blackbox should be used.")
23824 @end lisp
23825
23826 Add
23827 @lisp
23828 (spam-use-blackbox . spam-check-blackbox)
23829 @end lisp
23830 to @code{spam-list-of-checks}.
23831
23832 Add
23833 @lisp
23834 (gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox ham spam-use-blackbox)
23835 (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox spam spam-use-blackbox)
23836 @end lisp
23837
23838 to @code{spam-list-of-processors}.
23839
23840 Add
23841 @lisp
23842 (spam-use-blackbox spam-blackbox-register-routine
23843 nil
23844 spam-blackbox-unregister-routine
23845 nil)
23846 @end lisp
23847
23848 to @code{spam-registration-functions}. Write the register/unregister
23849 routines using the bogofilter register/unregister routines as a
23850 start, or other restister/unregister routines more appropriate to
23851 Blackbox.
23852
23853 @item
23854 Functionality
23855
23856 Write the @code{spam-check-blackbox} function. It should return
23857 @samp{nil} or @code{spam-split-group}, observing the other
23858 conventions. See the existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for
23859 examples of what you can do, and stick to the template unless you
23860 fully understand the reasons why you aren't.
23861
23862 Make sure to add @code{spam-use-blackbox} to
23863 @code{spam-list-of-statistical-checks} if Blackbox is a statistical
23864 mail analyzer that needs the full message body to operate.
23865
23866 @end enumerate
23867
23868 For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
23869
23870 @enumerate
23871
23872 @item
23873 Code
23874
23875 Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
23876 provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
23877
23878 Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
23879 variables. Instead the form @code{'(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
23880 @code{'(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
23881 processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
23882
23883 @lisp
23884 (defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
23885 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
23886 Only applicable to spam groups.")
23887
23888 (defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
23889 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
23890 Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
23891
23892 @end lisp
23893
23894 @item
23895 Gnus parameters
23896
23897 Add
23898 @lisp
23899 (const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
23900 (const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
23901 @end lisp
23902 to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
23903 sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
23904 variable customization.
23905
23906 Add
23907 @lisp
23908 (variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
23909 @end lisp
23910 to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
23911 @code{gnus.el}.
23912
23913 @end enumerate
23914
23915
23916 @node Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat
23917 @subsection Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat
23918 @cindex Paul Graham
23919 @cindex Graham, Paul
23920 @cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
23921 @cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
23922 @cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
23923
23924 Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
23925 statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
23926 Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
23927 filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
23928 the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
23929 always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
23930 on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
23931 this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
23932 that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
23933 or not.
23934
23935 The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
23936 with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
23937 either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
23938 collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
23939 word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
23940 non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
23941 probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
23942 than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
23943
23944 Gnus supports this kind of filtering. But it needs some setting up.
23945 First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
23946 non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
23947 collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
23948 this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
23949
23950 @menu
23951 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
23952 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
23953 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
23954 @end menu
23955
23956 @node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
23957 @subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
23958
23959 Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
23960 create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
23961 one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
23962 for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
23963 need several hundred emails in both collections.
23964
23965 Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
23966 creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
23967 per mail. Use the following:
23968
23969 @defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
23970 Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
23971 is treated as one spam mail.
23972 @end defun
23973
23974 @defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
23975 Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
23976 file is treated as one non-spam mail.
23977 @end defun
23978
23979 Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
23980 directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds
23981 the the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
23982 @code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
23983 @file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds the the group
23984 @samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
23985
23986 When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
23987 locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
23988 to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
23989 @file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
23990 @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
23991
23992 @defvar spam-stat
23993 This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
23994 dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
23995 collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
23996 word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
23997 @end defvar
23998
23999 If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
24000 reset the dictionary.
24001
24002 @defun spam-stat-reset
24003 Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
24004 @end defun
24005
24006 When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
24007 be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
24008 (instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
24009 can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
24010 not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
24011 only non-spam mails.
24012
24013 @defun spam-stat-reduce-size
24014 Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
24015 to update the dictionary incrementally.
24016 @end defun
24017
24018 @defun spam-stat-save
24019 Save the dictionary.
24020 @end defun
24021
24022 @defvar spam-stat-file
24023 The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
24024 @file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
24025 @end defvar
24026
24027 @node Splitting mail using spam-stat
24028 @subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
24029
24030 In order to use @code{spam-stat} to split your mail, you need to add the
24031 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24032
24033 @lisp
24034 (require 'spam-stat)
24035 (spam-stat-load)
24036 @end lisp
24037
24038 This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
24039 created.
24040
24041 Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
24042 determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
24043 the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
24044 use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
24045
24046 In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
24047 @samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
24048 spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
24049 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
24050
24051 @lisp
24052 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24053 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24054 "mail.misc"))
24055 @end lisp
24056
24057 @defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
24058 The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
24059 @end defvar
24060
24061 If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
24062 the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
24063 expression are considered potential spam.
24064
24065 @lisp
24066 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24067 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24068 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24069 "mail.misc"))
24070 @end lisp
24071
24072 If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
24073 creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
24074 consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
24075 non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
24076 mails, when creating the dictionary!
24077
24078 @lisp
24079 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24080 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24081 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24082 "mail.misc"))
24083 @end lisp
24084
24085 You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
24086 HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
24087 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
24088 @samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
24089 nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
24090 dictionary!
24091
24092 @lisp
24093 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24094 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
24095 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24096 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24097 "mail.misc"))
24098 @end lisp
24099
24100
24101 @node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24102 @subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24103
24104 The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
24105
24106 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
24107 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
24108 Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24109 @end defun
24110
24111 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
24112 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
24113 mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24114 @end defun
24115
24116 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
24117 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
24118 mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
24119 already been processed as non-spam.
24120 @end defun
24121
24122 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
24123 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
24124 normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
24125 been processed as spam.
24126 @end defun
24127
24128 @defun spam-stat-save
24129 Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
24130 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
24131 @end defun
24132
24133 @defun spam-stat-load
24134 Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
24135 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
24136 @end defun
24137
24138 @defun spam-stat-score-word
24139 Return the spam score for a word.
24140 @end defun
24141
24142 @defun spam-stat-score-buffer
24143 Return the spam score for a buffer.
24144 @end defun
24145
24146 @defun spam-stat-split-fancy
24147 Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
24148 spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
24149 @end defun
24150
24151 Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
24152 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24153
24154 @lisp
24155 (require 'spam-stat)
24156 (spam-stat-load)
24157 @end lisp
24158
24159 Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
24160
24161 @smallexample
24162 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
24163 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24164 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24165 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24166 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
24167 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
24168 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24169 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24170 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
24171 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24172 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
24173 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
24174 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24175 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24176 @end smallexample
24177
24178 Here is how you would create your dictionary:
24179
24180 @smallexample
24181 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
24182 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24183 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24184 Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
24185 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
24186 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24187 @end smallexample
24188
24189 @node Other modes
24190 @section Interaction with other modes
24191
24192 @subsection Dired
24193 @cindex dired
24194
24195 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provided some useful functions for dired
24196 buffers. It is enabled with
24197 @lisp
24198 (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
24199 @end lisp
24200
24201 @table @kbd
24202 @item C-c C-m C-a
24203 @findex gnus-dired-attach
24204 Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
24205 You will be prompted for a message buffer.
24206
24207 @item C-c C-m C-l
24208 @findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
24209 Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
24210 (@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
24211 buffer.
24212
24213 @item C-c C-m C-p
24214 @findex gnus-dired-print
24215 Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
24216 there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
24217 @end table
24218
24219 @node Various Various
24220 @section Various Various
24221 @cindex mode lines
24222 @cindex highlights
24223
24224 @table @code
24225
24226 @item gnus-home-directory
24227 @vindex gnus-home-directory
24228 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
24229 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
24230
24231 @item gnus-directory
24232 @vindex gnus-directory
24233 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
24234 this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
24235 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
24236
24237 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
24238 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
24239 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
24240 @file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
24241
24242 @item gnus-default-directory
24243 @vindex gnus-default-directory
24244 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
24245 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
24246 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
24247 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
24248 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
24249 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
24250
24251 @item gnus-verbose
24252 @vindex gnus-verbose
24253 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
24254 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
24255 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
24256 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
24257 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
24258
24259 @item gnus-verbose-backends
24260 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
24261 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
24262 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
24263
24264 @item nnheader-max-head-length
24265 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
24266 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
24267 as little as possible. This variable (default 4096) specifies
24268 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
24269 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
24270 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
24271 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
24272 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
24273 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
24274
24275 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
24276 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
24277 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
24278 read when doing the operation described above.
24279
24280 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24281 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24282 @cindex file names
24283 @cindex invalid characters in file names
24284 @cindex characters in file names
24285 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
24286 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
24287 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
24288
24289 @lisp
24290 @group
24291 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24292 '((?: . ?_)))
24293 @end group
24294 @end lisp
24295
24296 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
24297 Windows (phooey) systems.
24298
24299 @item gnus-hidden-properties
24300 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
24301 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
24302 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
24303 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
24304
24305 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
24306 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
24307 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
24308 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
24309 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
24310
24311 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
24312 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
24313 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
24314
24315 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
24316 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
24317
24318 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
24319 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
24320 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
24321 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
24322 group).
24323
24324 @acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
24325
24326
24327 @end table
24328
24329 @node The End
24330 @chapter The End
24331
24332 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
24333 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
24334
24335 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
24336
24337 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
24338
24339 @quotation
24340 @strong{Te Deum}
24341
24342 @sp 1
24343 Not because of victories @*
24344 I sing,@*
24345 having none,@*
24346 but for the common sunshine,@*
24347 the breeze,@*
24348 the largess of the spring.
24349
24350 @sp 1
24351 Not for victory@*
24352 but for the day's work done@*
24353 as well as I was able;@*
24354 not for a seat upon the dais@*
24355 but at the common table.@*
24356 @end quotation
24357
24358
24359 @node Appendices
24360 @chapter Appendices
24361
24362 @menu
24363 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
24364 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
24365 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
24366 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
24367 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
24368 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
24369 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
24370 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
24371 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
24372 @end menu
24373
24374
24375 @node XEmacs
24376 @section XEmacs
24377 @cindex XEmacs
24378 @cindex installing under XEmacs
24379
24380 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
24381 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
24382 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
24383 @samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
24384 @samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print}, @samp{w3},
24385 @samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
24386
24387
24388 @node History
24389 @section History
24390
24391 @cindex history
24392 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
24393 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
24394
24395 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
24396 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
24397 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
24398 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
24399 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
24400
24401 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
24402 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
24403 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
24404 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
24405 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
24406 appropriate name, don't you think?)
24407
24408 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
24409 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
24410 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
24411 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
24412
24413 @menu
24414 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
24415 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
24416 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
24417 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
24418 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
24419 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
24420 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
24421 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
24422 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
24423 @end menu
24424
24425
24426 @node Gnus Versions
24427 @subsection Gnus Versions
24428 @cindex ding Gnus
24429 @cindex September Gnus
24430 @cindex Red Gnus
24431 @cindex Quassia Gnus
24432 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
24433 @cindex Oort Gnus
24434 @cindex No Gnus
24435 @cindex Gnus versions
24436
24437 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
24438 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
24439 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
24440
24441 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
24442 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
24443
24444 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
24445 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
24446
24447 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
24448 If was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
24449
24450 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
24451 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
24452 1999.
24453
24454 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun.
24455
24456 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name --
24457 ``(ding) Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
24458 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'' -- don't panic. Don't let it know
24459 that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly. Whatever you do, don't
24460 run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of its reach. Find a proper
24461 released version of Gnus and snuggle up to that instead.
24462
24463
24464 @node Other Gnus Versions
24465 @subsection Other Gnus Versions
24466 @cindex Semi-gnus
24467
24468 In addition to the versions of Gnus which have had their releases
24469 coordinated by Lars, one major development has been Semi-gnus from
24470 Japan. It's based on a library called @acronym{SEMI}, which provides
24471 @acronym{MIME} capabilities.
24472
24473 These Gnusae are based mainly on Gnus 5.6 and Pterodactyl Gnus.
24474 Collectively, they are called ``Semi-gnus'', and different strains are
24475 called T-gnus, ET-gnus, Nana-gnus and Chaos. These provide powerful
24476 @acronym{MIME} and multilingualization things, especially important for
24477 Japanese users.
24478
24479
24480 @node Why?
24481 @subsection Why?
24482
24483 What's the point of Gnus?
24484
24485 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
24486 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
24487 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
24488 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
24489 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
24490 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
24491 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
24492 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
24493 keep track of millions of people who post?
24494
24495 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
24496 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
24497 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
24498 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
24499 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
24500 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
24501 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
24502 every one of you to explore and invent.
24503
24504 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
24505 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
24506
24507
24508 @node Compatibility
24509 @subsection Compatibility
24510
24511 @cindex compatibility
24512 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
24513 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
24514 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
24515
24516 Our motto is:
24517 @quotation
24518 @cartouche
24519 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
24520 @end cartouche
24521 @end quotation
24522
24523 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
24524 their names.
24525
24526 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
24527 Articles}.
24528
24529 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
24530 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
24531 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
24532 important variables have their values copied into their global
24533 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
24534 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
24535
24536 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
24537 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
24538 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
24539 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
24540 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
24541 peculiar results.
24542
24543 @cindex hilit19
24544 @cindex highlighting
24545 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
24546 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
24547 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
24548 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
24549 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
24550 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
24551 Away!
24552
24553 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
24554 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
24555 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
24556 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
24557
24558 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
24559 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
24560 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
24561 to stop doing it the old way.
24562
24563 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
24564
24565 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
24566 @findex gnus-bug
24567 @cindex reporting bugs
24568 @cindex bugs
24569 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
24570 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
24571 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
24572
24573 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
24574 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
24575 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
24576 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
24577 up at you.
24578
24579
24580 @node Conformity
24581 @subsection Conformity
24582
24583 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
24584 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
24585 with, of course.
24586
24587 @table @strong
24588
24589 @item RFC (2)822
24590 @cindex RFC 822
24591 @cindex RFC 2822
24592 There are no known breaches of this standard.
24593
24594 @item RFC 1036
24595 @cindex RFC 1036
24596 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
24597
24598 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
24599 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
24600 We do have some breaches to this one.
24601
24602 @table @emph
24603
24604 @item X-Newsreader
24605 @itemx User-Agent
24606 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
24607 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
24608 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
24609 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
24610 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
24611 @end table
24612
24613 @item USEFOR
24614 @cindex USEFOR
24615 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
24616 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
24617 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
24618 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
24619
24620 @item MIME - RFC 2045-2049 etc
24621 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
24622 All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
24623
24624 @item Disposition Notifications - RFC 2298
24625 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
24626
24627 @item PGP - RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
24628 @cindex RFC 1991
24629 @cindex RFC 2440
24630 RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
24631 published as an informational RFC. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
24632 called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
24633 non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
24634 encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
24635 decryption).
24636
24637 @item PGP/MIME - RFC 2015/3156
24638 RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
24639 1991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RF 1991/2440 format.
24640 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
24641
24642 @item S/MIME - RFC 2633
24643 RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
24644
24645 @item IMAP - RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
24646 RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
24647 (@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
24648 authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
24649 lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
24650 protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
24651 integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
24652 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
24653
24654 @end table
24655
24656 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
24657 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
24658 know.
24659
24660
24661 @node Emacsen
24662 @subsection Emacsen
24663 @cindex Emacsen
24664 @cindex XEmacs
24665 @cindex Mule
24666 @cindex Emacs
24667
24668 Gnus should work on:
24669
24670 @itemize @bullet
24671
24672 @item
24673 Emacs 20.7 and up.
24674
24675 @item
24676 XEmacs 21.1 and up.
24677
24678 @end itemize
24679
24680 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
24681 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
24682 Emacs versions.
24683
24684 There are some vague differences between Gnus on the various
24685 platforms---XEmacs features more graphics (a logo and a toolbar)---but
24686 other than that, things should look pretty much the same under all
24687 Emacsen.
24688
24689
24690 @node Gnus Development
24691 @subsection Gnus Development
24692
24693 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
24694 discussion on the @samp{ding@@gnus.org} mailing list, where people
24695 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
24696 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
24697 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
24698 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
24699 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
24700 have names like ``Red Gnus'' and ``Quassia Gnus''.
24701
24702 After futzing around for 50-100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
24703 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
24704 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.6.32'' instead. Normal people are
24705 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
24706 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup.
24707
24708 @cindex Incoming*
24709 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
24710 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae.
24711 In particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{nil} in
24712 alpha Gnusae and @code{t} in released Gnusae. This is to prevent
24713 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
24714
24715 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
24716 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
24717 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
24718 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
24719 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
24720 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
24721 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
24722 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
24723 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
24724 can't be assumed to do so.
24725
24726
24727
24728 @node Contributors
24729 @subsection Contributors
24730 @cindex contributors
24731
24732 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
24733 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
24734 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
24735 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
24736 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
24737 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
24738 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
24739 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
24740 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
24741 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
24742
24743 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
24744 wrong show.
24745
24746 @itemize @bullet
24747
24748 @item
24749 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
24750
24751 @item
24752 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el, webmail.el,
24753 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
24754 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
24755 functionality and stuff.
24756
24757 @item
24758 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
24759 well as numerous other things).
24760
24761 @item
24762 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
24763
24764 @item
24765 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
24766
24767 @item
24768 Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
24769
24770 @item
24771 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
24772
24773 @item
24774 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
24775 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
24776
24777 @item
24778 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
24779
24780 @item
24781 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section
24782 (@pxref{GroupLens}).
24783
24784 @item
24785 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
24786
24787 @item
24788 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
24789
24790 @item
24791 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bugs detections and fixes.
24792
24793 @item
24794 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
24795
24796 @item
24797 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
24798 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
24799
24800 @item
24801 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
24802
24803 @item
24804 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
24805
24806 @item
24807 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
24808
24809 @item
24810 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
24811 .newsrc files.
24812
24813 @item
24814 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
24815
24816 @item
24817 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
24818
24819 @item
24820 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
24821
24822 @item
24823 François Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
24824 well as autoconf support.
24825
24826 @end itemize
24827
24828 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
24829 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
24830
24831 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
24832
24833 Christopher Davis,
24834 Andrew Eskilsson,
24835 Kai Grossjohann,
24836 Kevin Greiner,
24837 Jesper Harder,
24838 Paul Jarc,
24839 Simon Josefsson,
24840 David KÃ¥gedal,
24841 Richard Pieri,
24842 Fabrice Popineau,
24843 Daniel Quinlan,
24844 Michael Shields,
24845 Reiner Steib,
24846 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
24847 Jack Vinson,
24848 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
24849 and
24850 Teodor Zlatanov.
24851
24852 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
24853
24854 Jari Aalto,
24855 Adrian Aichner,
24856 Vladimir Alexiev,
24857 Russ Allbery,
24858 Peter Arius,
24859 Matt Armstrong,
24860 Marc Auslander,
24861 Miles Bader,
24862 Alexei V. Barantsev,
24863 Frank Bennett,
24864 Robert Bihlmeyer,
24865 Chris Bone,
24866 Mark Borges,
24867 Mark Boyns,
24868 Lance A. Brown,
24869 Rob Browning,
24870 Kees de Bruin,
24871 Martin Buchholz,
24872 Joe Buehler,
24873 Kevin Buhr,
24874 Alastair Burt,
24875 Joao Cachopo,
24876 Zlatko Calusic,
24877 Massimo Campostrini,
24878 Castor,
24879 David Charlap,
24880 Dan Christensen,
24881 Kevin Christian,
24882 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
24883 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
24884 Laura Conrad,
24885 Michael R. Cook,
24886 Glenn Coombs,
24887 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
24888 Neil Crellin,
24889 Frank D. Cringle,
24890 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
24891 Andre Deparade,
24892 Ulrik Dickow,
24893 Dave Disser,
24894 Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
24895 Joev Dubach,
24896 Michael Welsh Duggan,
24897 Dave Edmondson,
24898 Paul Eggert,
24899 Mark W. Eichin,
24900 Karl Eichwalder,
24901 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
24902 Michael Ernst,
24903 Luc Van Eycken,
24904 Sam Falkner,
24905 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
24906 Sigbjorn Finne,
24907 Sven Fischer,
24908 Paul Fisher,
24909 Decklin Foster,
24910 Gary D. Foster,
24911 Paul Franklin,
24912 Guy Geens,
24913 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
24914 David S. Goldberg,
24915 Michelangelo Grigni,
24916 Dale Hagglund,
24917 D. Hall,
24918 Magnus Hammerin,
24919 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
24920 Raja R. Harinath,
24921 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
24922 P. E. Jareth Hein,
24923 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
24924 Scott Hofmann,
24925 Marc Horowitz,
24926 Gunnar Horrigmo,
24927 Richard Hoskins,
24928 Brad Howes,
24929 Miguel de Icaza,
24930 François Felix Ingrand,
24931 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
24932 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
24933 Lee Iverson,
24934 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
24935 Rajappa Iyer,
24936 Andreas Jaeger,
24937 Adam P. Jenkins,
24938 Randell Jesup,
24939 Fred Johansen,
24940 Gareth Jones,
24941 Greg Klanderman,
24942 Karl Kleinpaste,
24943 Michael Klingbeil,
24944 Peter Skov Knudsen,
24945 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
24946 Petr Konecny,
24947 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
24948 Thor Kristoffersen,
24949 Jens Lautenbacher,
24950 Martin Larose,
24951 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
24952 Joerg Lenneis,
24953 Carsten Leonhardt,
24954 James LewisMoss,
24955 Christian Limpach,
24956 Markus Linnala,
24957 Dave Love,
24958 Mike McEwan,
24959 Tonny Madsen,
24960 Shlomo Mahlab,
24961 Nat Makarevitch,
24962 Istvan Marko,
24963 David Martin,
24964 Jason R. Mastaler,
24965 Gordon Matzigkeit,
24966 Timo Metzemakers,
24967 Richard Mlynarik,
24968 Lantz Moore,
24969 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
24970 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
24971 Hrvoje Niksic,
24972 Andy Norman,
24973 Fred Oberhauser,
24974 C. R. Oldham,
24975 Alexandre Oliva,
24976 Ken Olstad,
24977 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
24978 Hideki Ono, @c Ono
24979 Ettore Perazzoli,
24980 William Perry,
24981 Stephen Peters,
24982 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
24983 Ulrich Pfeifer,
24984 Matt Pharr,
24985 Andy Piper,
24986 John McClary Prevost,
24987 Bill Pringlemeir,
24988 Mike Pullen,
24989 Jim Radford,
24990 Colin Rafferty,
24991 Lasse Rasinen,
24992 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
24993 Joe Reiss,
24994 Renaud Rioboo,
24995 Roland B. Roberts,
24996 Bart Robinson,
24997 Christian von Roques,
24998 Markus Rost,
24999 Jason Rumney,
25000 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
25001 Jay Sachs,
25002 Dewey M. Sasser,
25003 Conrad Sauerwald,
25004 Loren Schall,
25005 Dan Schmidt,
25006 Ralph Schleicher,
25007 Philippe Schnoebelen,
25008 Andreas Schwab,
25009 Randal L. Schwartz,
25010 Danny Siu,
25011 Matt Simmons,
25012 Paul D. Smith,
25013 Jeff Sparkes,
25014 Toby Speight,
25015 Michael Sperber,
25016 Darren Stalder,
25017 Richard Stallman,
25018 Greg Stark,
25019 Sam Steingold,
25020 Paul Stevenson,
25021 Jonas Steverud,
25022 Paul Stodghill,
25023 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
25024 Kurt Swanson,
25025 Samuel Tardieu,
25026 Teddy,
25027 Chuck Thompson,
25028 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
25029 Philippe Troin,
25030 James Troup,
25031 Trung Tran-Duc,
25032 Jack Twilley,
25033 Aaron M. Ucko,
25034 Aki Vehtari,
25035 Didier Verna,
25036 Vladimir Volovich,
25037 Jan Vroonhof,
25038 Stefan Waldherr,
25039 Pete Ware,
25040 Barry A. Warsaw,
25041 Christoph Wedler,
25042 Joe Wells,
25043 Lee Willis,
25044 and
25045 Lloyd Zusman.
25046
25047
25048 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
25049 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
25050 (550kB and counting).
25051
25052 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
25053 sure.
25054
25055 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
25056 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
25057
25058
25059 @node New Features
25060 @subsection New Features
25061 @cindex new features
25062
25063 @menu
25064 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
25065 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
25066 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
25067 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
25068 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
25069 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
25070 @end menu
25071
25072 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
25073 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
25074 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
25075
25076 @node ding Gnus
25077 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
25078
25079 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
25080
25081 @itemize @bullet
25082
25083 @item
25084 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
25085 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
25086
25087 @item
25088 Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
25089 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
25090
25091 @item
25092 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
25093
25094 @item
25095 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
25096 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
25097 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
25098
25099 @item
25100 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
25101 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
25102 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
25103 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
25104
25105 @item
25106 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
25107 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25108
25109 @item
25110 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
25111 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
25112 (@pxref{The Active File}).
25113
25114 @item
25115 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
25116 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
25117
25118 @item
25119 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
25120 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
25121 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
25122
25123 @item
25124 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
25125 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
25126 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
25127
25128 @item
25129 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
25130 cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
25131
25132 @item
25133 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
25134 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
25135
25136 @item
25137 You can grep through a subset of groups and create a group from the
25138 results (@pxref{Kibozed Groups}).
25139
25140 @item
25141 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
25142 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25143
25144 @item
25145 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
25146 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
25147
25148 @item
25149 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
25150 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
25151
25152 @item
25153 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
25154
25155 @item
25156 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
25157 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
25158
25159 @item
25160 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
25161 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
25162
25163 @item
25164 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
25165 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
25166
25167 @item
25168 Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
25169
25170 @item
25171 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
25172 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
25173
25174 @item
25175 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
25176 Articles}).
25177
25178 @item
25179 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
25180 Buttons}).
25181
25182 @item
25183 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
25184 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
25185
25186 @item
25187 You can click on buttons instead of using the keyboard
25188 (@pxref{Buttons}).
25189
25190 @end itemize
25191
25192
25193 @node September Gnus
25194 @subsubsection September Gnus
25195
25196 @iftex
25197 @iflatex
25198 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
25199 @end iflatex
25200 @end iftex
25201
25202 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
25203
25204 @itemize @bullet
25205
25206 @item
25207 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
25208 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
25209 now obsolete.
25210
25211 @item
25212 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
25213 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
25214 Threading}).
25215
25216 @lisp
25217 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
25218 @end lisp
25219
25220 @item
25221 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
25222 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
25223
25224 @item
25225 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
25226 referred.
25227
25228 @item
25229 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions (@pxref{GroupLens}).
25230
25231 @item
25232 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
25233
25234 @item
25235 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
25236
25237 @lisp
25238 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
25239 @end lisp
25240
25241 @item
25242 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
25243 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
25244
25245 @lisp
25246 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
25247 @end lisp
25248
25249 @item
25250 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
25251 Groups}).
25252
25253 @item
25254 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
25255 Topics}).
25256
25257 @lisp
25258 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
25259 @end lisp
25260
25261 @item
25262 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
25263
25264 @item
25265 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
25266 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
25267
25268 @lisp
25269 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
25270 @end lisp
25271
25272 @item
25273 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
25274 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
25275
25276 @item
25277 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
25278
25279 @item
25280 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
25281 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
25282 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
25283
25284 @item
25285 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets
25286 (@pxref{SOUP}).
25287
25288 @item
25289 The Gnus cache is much faster.
25290
25291 @item
25292 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
25293 Groups}).
25294
25295 @item
25296 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
25297 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
25298
25299 @item
25300 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
25301 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
25302
25303 @item
25304 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
25305 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
25306
25307 @item
25308 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
25309 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
25310 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
25311
25312 @item
25313 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
25314 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
25315
25316 @item
25317 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
25318
25319 @item
25320 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
25321
25322 @item
25323 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
25324
25325 @item
25326 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
25327
25328 @item
25329 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
25330 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
25331
25332 @item
25333 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
25334 Layout}).
25335
25336 @item
25337 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
25338 @iftex
25339 @iflatex
25340 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
25341 @end iflatex
25342 @end iftex
25343
25344 @item
25345 Gnus can make use of NoCeM files to weed out spam (@pxref{NoCeM}).
25346
25347 @lisp
25348 (setq gnus-use-nocem t)
25349 @end lisp
25350
25351 @item
25352 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25353
25354 @lisp
25355 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
25356 @end lisp
25357
25358 @item
25359 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
25360
25361 @item
25362 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
25363
25364 @item
25365 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
25366 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
25367
25368 @lisp
25369 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
25370 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
25371 @end lisp
25372
25373 @item
25374 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
25375 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
25376
25377 @lisp
25378 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
25379 @end lisp
25380
25381 @item
25382 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
25383 buffer to allow easier treatment.
25384
25385 @item
25386 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
25387
25388 @item
25389 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
25390 Articles}).
25391
25392 @lisp
25393 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
25394 @end lisp
25395
25396 @item
25397 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
25398 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
25399
25400 @lisp
25401 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
25402 @end lisp
25403
25404 @item
25405 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
25406 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
25407
25408 @item
25409 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
25410 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
25411
25412 @lisp
25413 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
25414 @end lisp
25415
25416 @item
25417 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
25418
25419 @item
25420 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
25421
25422 @item
25423 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
25424
25425 @end itemize
25426
25427
25428 @node Red Gnus
25429 @subsubsection Red Gnus
25430
25431 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
25432
25433 @iftex
25434 @iflatex
25435 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
25436 @end iflatex
25437 @end iftex
25438
25439 @itemize @bullet
25440
25441 @item
25442 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
25443
25444 @item
25445 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
25446 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
25447
25448 @item
25449 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
25450 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
25451 Scoring}).
25452
25453 @item
25454 Article washing status can be displayed in the
25455 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
25456
25457 @item
25458 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
25459
25460 @item
25461 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
25462 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
25463
25464 @lisp
25465 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
25466 @end lisp
25467
25468 @item
25469 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
25470 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
25471 been added.
25472
25473 @item
25474 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extendable (@pxref{Document
25475 Server Internals}).
25476
25477 @item
25478 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
25479 Parameters}).
25480
25481 @item
25482 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
25483
25484 @item
25485 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
25486 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
25487
25488 @item
25489 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
25490 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
25491 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
25492
25493 @item
25494 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
25495 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
25496
25497 @item
25498 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
25499 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
25500
25501 @item
25502 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
25503 (@pxref{Undo}).
25504
25505 @item
25506 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
25507 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
25508
25509 @item
25510 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
25511 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
25512
25513 @lisp
25514 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
25515 @end lisp
25516
25517 @item
25518 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
25519
25520 @lisp
25521 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
25522 @end lisp
25523
25524 @item
25525 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
25526 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
25527
25528 @item
25529 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
25530 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
25531
25532 @item
25533 A new command for reading collections of documents
25534 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
25535 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
25536
25537 @item
25538 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
25539 Marks}).
25540
25541 @item
25542 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
25543 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
25544
25545 @item
25546 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
25547 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
25548 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
25549
25550 @item
25551 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
25552 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
25553 Sorting}).
25554
25555 @item
25556 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
25557 Groups}).
25558
25559 @item
25560 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
25561 Commands}).
25562 @iftex
25563 @iflatex
25564 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
25565 @end iflatex
25566 @end iftex
25567
25568 @item
25569 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
25570 Variables}).
25571
25572 @item
25573 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
25574 Mail}).
25575
25576 @item
25577 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
25578 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
25579
25580 @item
25581 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
25582
25583 @end itemize
25584
25585
25586 @node Quassia Gnus
25587 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
25588
25589 New features in Gnus 5.6:
25590
25591 @itemize @bullet
25592
25593 @item
25594 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
25595 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
25596 @xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
25597
25598 @item
25599 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
25600 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
25601 group, which is created automatically.
25602
25603 @item
25604 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
25605 values.
25606
25607 @item
25608 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-ID's.
25609
25610 @item
25611 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
25612 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
25613
25614 @item
25615 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
25616 @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
25617
25618 @item
25619 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
25620
25621 @item
25622 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
25623 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
25624
25625 @item
25626 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
25627
25628 @item
25629 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
25630 details.
25631
25632 @item
25633 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
25634 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
25635
25636 @item
25637 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
25638 control over simplification.
25639
25640 @item
25641 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
25642
25643 @item
25644 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
25645 limit.
25646
25647 @item
25648 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
25649
25650 @item
25651 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
25652
25653 @item
25654 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
25655 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
25656 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
25657
25658 @item
25659 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
25660 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
25661
25662 @item
25663 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
25664 text---@kbd{W d}.
25665
25666 @item
25667 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
25668 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
25669
25670 @item
25671 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
25672 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
25673
25674 @item
25675 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
25676 has been added.
25677
25678 @item
25679 A history of where mails have been split is available.
25680
25681 @item
25682 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
25683
25684 @item
25685 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
25686 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
25687
25688 @item
25689 A new function for citing in Message has been
25690 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
25691
25692 @item
25693 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
25694
25695 @item
25696 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
25697 been added.
25698
25699 @item
25700 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
25701 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
25702
25703 @item
25704 The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
25705 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
25706
25707 @item
25708 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
25709
25710 @item
25711 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
25712
25713 @end itemize
25714
25715 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
25716 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
25717
25718 New features in Gnus 5.8:
25719
25720 @itemize @bullet
25721
25722 @item
25723 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
25724 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
25725
25726 If you used procmail like in
25727
25728 @lisp
25729 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
25730 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
25731 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
25732 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
25733 @end lisp
25734
25735 this now has changed to
25736
25737 @lisp
25738 (setq mail-sources
25739 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
25740 :suffix ".in")))
25741 @end lisp
25742
25743 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
25744
25745 @item
25746 Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
25747 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
25748
25749 @item
25750 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
25751 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
25752
25753 @item
25754 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
25755 called to position point.
25756
25757 @item
25758 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
25759 summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
25760
25761 @item
25762 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
25763 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
25764
25765 @item
25766 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
25767 subtly different manner.
25768
25769 @item
25770 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
25771 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
25772 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
25773
25774 @item
25775 Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
25776
25777 @end itemize
25778
25779 @node Oort Gnus
25780 @subsubsection Oort Gnus
25781 @cindex Oort Gnus
25782
25783 New features in Gnus 5.10:
25784
25785 @itemize @bullet
25786
25787 @item
25788 @kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
25789 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
25790 region if the region is active.
25791
25792 @item
25793 @code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
25794 using @kbd{G M}.
25795
25796 @item
25797 In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
25798 Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
25799
25800 @item
25801 The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
25802 @xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
25803
25804 @item
25805 Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
25806
25807 If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
25808 release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
25809 this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
25810 @file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
25811 read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
25812 @file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
25813 later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
25814 isn't save in general.
25815
25816 @item
25817 Article Buttons
25818
25819 More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
25820 pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
25821 variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
25822 appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
25823
25824 @item
25825 Dired integration
25826
25827 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
25828 bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
25829 using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
25830 entry.
25831
25832 @item
25833 Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
25834
25835 @item
25836 Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
25837
25838 @item
25839 Picons
25840
25841 The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
25842 the previous options have been removed or renamed.
25843
25844 Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
25845 newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
25846 @xref{Picons}.
25847
25848 @item
25849 If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
25850 boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
25851
25852 @item
25853 Retrieval of charters and control messages
25854
25855 There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
25856 control messages (@kbd{H C}).
25857
25858 @item
25859 Delayed articles
25860
25861 You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
25862 buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
25863 for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
25864
25865 @item
25866 If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
25867 decompressed when activated.
25868
25869 @item
25870 If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
25871 the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
25872
25873 @item
25874 Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
25875
25876 @item
25877 The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
25878 article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
25879
25880 @item
25881 Warn about email replies to news
25882
25883 Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
25884 the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
25885 you.
25886
25887 @item
25888 If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
25889 non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
25890 built.
25891
25892 @item
25893 The new @code{recent} mark @samp{.} indicates newly arrived messages (as
25894 opposed to old but unread messages).
25895
25896 @item
25897 The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
25898 Gcc articles as read.
25899
25900 @item
25901 The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
25902
25903 @item
25904 Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
25905 related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
25906
25907 @item
25908 The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
25909 in English. @xref{Article Date}.
25910
25911 @item
25912 The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
25913 @xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
25914
25915 @item
25916 diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
25917 @code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
25918
25919 @item
25920 @acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
25921
25922 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
25923 @acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GNUTLS. The old
25924 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} support via (external third party)
25925 @file{ssl.el} and OpenSSL still works.
25926
25927 @item
25928 New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
25929
25930 Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
25931 first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
25932 @file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, iff you want
25933 to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
25934 the second parameter.
25935
25936 @file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
25937 automatic recognition of XEmacs and GNU Emacs, generates
25938 @file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
25939 generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
25940 process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
25941 back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
25942 install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
25943 complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
25944 cycle used under Unix systems.
25945
25946 The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} superfluous, so it has
25947 been removed.
25948
25949 @item
25950 Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
25951
25952 Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
25953 Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
25954 send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
25955 Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
25956 and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
25957 controls this.
25958
25959 @item
25960 Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
25961
25962 Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
25963 mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
25964 though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
25965 @code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
25966 citations.
25967
25968 @item
25969 @code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
25970
25971 If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
25972 not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
25973 which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
25974 what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
25975
25976 This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
25977 consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
25978 message cited below.
25979
25980 @item
25981 The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
25982
25983 @item
25984 The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
25985
25986 Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
25987 the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
25988 enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
25989 variable in @file{~/.emacs} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
25990 variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
25991 parameters, a'la:
25992 @lisp
25993 (setq gnus-parameters
25994 '(("mail\\..*"
25995 (gnus-show-threads nil)
25996 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
25997 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
25998 (to-group . "\\1"))))
25999 @end lisp
26000
26001 @item
26002 Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc) are now iconized for Emacs too.
26003
26004 Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.emacs} to
26005 disable it.
26006
26007 @item
26008 Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
26009
26010 Earlier it was generated iff the user configurable email address was
26011 different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
26012 algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
26013 only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
26014 cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
26015 see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
26016 default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
26017 @code{message-required-news-headers}, and
26018 @code{message-required-mail-headers}.
26019
26020 @item
26021 Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
26022
26023 Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
26024 subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
26025 M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
26026 @kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
26027 appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
26028 followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
26029
26030 @item
26031 References and X-Draft-Headers are no longer generated when you start
26032 composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
26033 @code{nil}.
26034
26035 @item
26036 Improved anti-spam features.
26037
26038 Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
26039 using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
26040 methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
26041 for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
26042 are also new. @xref{Thwarting Email Spam}.
26043
26044 @item
26045 Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers.
26046
26047 @item
26048 Face headers handling.
26049
26050 @item
26051 In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
26052 and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
26053
26054 @item
26055 Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
26056
26057 @item
26058 Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
26059
26060 The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
26061 be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
26062 @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
26063 @code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
26064 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook}. (called after getting new
26065 mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
26066 want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
26067 you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
26068 when getting new mail, remove the function.
26069
26070 @item
26071 Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
26072
26073 To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
26074 are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
26075 variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
26076 contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
26077 you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
26078 into two groups) you must change it to return the list
26079 @code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
26080 incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
26081 was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
26082 was inserted directly.
26083
26084 @item
26085 @file{~/News/overview/} not used.
26086
26087 As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
26088 directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
26089 hierarchy.
26090
26091 @item
26092 @code{gnus-agent}
26093
26094 The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
26095 and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
26096 @code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
26097 only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
26098 default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
26099 enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
26100 of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
26101 unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
26102 @kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
26103 the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
26104 @kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
26105 behaviour of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
26106 nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
26107 is not needed any more.
26108
26109 @item
26110 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}
26111
26112 The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
26113 %s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
26114 @code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
26115 changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
26116 recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
26117 groups.
26118
26119 @item
26120 @file{deuglify.el} (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article})
26121
26122 A new file from Raymond Scholz @email{rscholz@@zonix.de} for deuglifying
26123 broken Outlook (Express) articles.
26124
26125 @item
26126 @code{(require 'gnus-load)}
26127
26128 If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
26129 @code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
26130 lisp directory into load-path.
26131
26132 File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
26133 some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
26134
26135 @item
26136 @code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
26137
26138 A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
26139
26140 @item
26141 @code{message-insinuate-rmail}
26142
26143 Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
26144 mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
26145 compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
26146 enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
26147
26148 @item
26149 @code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
26150
26151 The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
26152 @lisp
26153 (define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
26154 'bbdb-complete-name)
26155 @end lisp
26156
26157 @item
26158 Externalizing and deleting of attachments.
26159
26160 If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
26161 @code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
26162 local files as external parts.
26163
26164 The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
26165 on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
26166 external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
26167 @acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
26168 that support editing.
26169
26170 @item
26171 @code{gnus-default-charset}
26172
26173 The default value is determined from the
26174 @code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
26175 @code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
26176 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
26177
26178 @item
26179 @code{gnus-posting-styles}
26180
26181 Add a new format of match like
26182 @lisp
26183 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
26184 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
26185 @end lisp
26186 The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
26187 @lisp
26188 (header "to" "larsi.*org"
26189 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
26190 @end lisp
26191
26192 @item
26193 @code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
26194
26195 @samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
26196 added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
26197 need add those two headers too.
26198
26199 @item
26200 Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
26201
26202 If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
26203 in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
26204 gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
26205
26206 @item
26207 Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
26208 composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
26209 Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
26210 versions.
26211
26212 @item
26213 Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
26214
26215 This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
26216
26217 @item
26218 Gnus supports Maildir groups.
26219
26220 Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
26221
26222 @item
26223 Printing capabilities are enhanced.
26224
26225 Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
26226 Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
26227 printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
26228
26229 @item
26230 Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
26231
26232 In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
26233 the valid values.
26234
26235 @item
26236 Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
26237
26238 This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
26239 used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
26240 superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
26241 you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
26242 system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
26243 security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
26244 will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
26245 The behaviour can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
26246
26247 @item
26248 Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
26249
26250 Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
26251 complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
26252 buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
26253 generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
26254 manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
26255
26256 @item
26257 Extended format specs.
26258
26259 Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
26260 @code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
26261 format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
26262 @samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
26263 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
26264 escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
26265
26266 @item
26267 @kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
26268
26269 It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
26270 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
26271 out other articles.
26272
26273 @item Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
26274
26275 If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
26276 s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
26277 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
26278 result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
26279
26280 @item
26281 Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
26282
26283 This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
26284 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
26285 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
26286
26287 @item
26288 The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
26289
26290 This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
26291 separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
26292 makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
26293 sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within e.g. a department. It
26294 works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
26295 file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
26296 nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
26297 another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
26298 @file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
26299 The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
26300 @code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
26301
26302 @item
26303 The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
26304 been renamed to ``Gnus''.
26305
26306 @item
26307 The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
26308 renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
26309 related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
26310 message, Message Manual}).
26311
26312 @item
26313 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
26314 @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
26315
26316 The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
26317 instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
26318 variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
26319 @lisp
26320 ("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
26321 @end lisp
26322
26323 @item
26324 Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
26325 2015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630-2633).
26326
26327 It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
26328 additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
26329 Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
26330 messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
26331
26332 @item
26333 Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
26334
26335 @item
26336 @acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
26337 C-m}.
26338
26339 This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
26340 @code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
26341
26342 @item
26343 The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to symbol @code{best}.
26344
26345 The behaviour for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
26346 convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
26347 used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
26348 invalidate the digital signature.
26349 @end itemize
26350
26351 @iftex
26352
26353 @page
26354 @node The Manual
26355 @section The Manual
26356 @cindex colophon
26357 @cindex manual
26358
26359 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
26360 either @code{texi2dvi}
26361 @iflatex
26362 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
26363 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
26364 @end iflatex
26365 to get what you hold in your hands now.
26366
26367 The following conventions have been used:
26368
26369 @enumerate
26370
26371 @item
26372 This is a @samp{string}
26373
26374 @item
26375 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
26376
26377 @item
26378 This is a @file{file}
26379
26380 @item
26381 This is a @code{symbol}
26382
26383 @end enumerate
26384
26385 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
26386 mean:
26387
26388 @lisp
26389 (setq flargnoze "yes")
26390 @end lisp
26391
26392 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
26393
26394 @lisp
26395 (setq flumphel 'yes)
26396 @end lisp
26397
26398 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
26399 ever get them confused.
26400
26401 @iflatex
26402 @c @head
26403 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
26404 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
26405 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
26406 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
26407 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
26408 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
26409 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
26410 @end iflatex
26411
26412 @end iftex
26413
26414
26415 @node On Writing Manuals
26416 @section On Writing Manuals
26417
26418 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
26419 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
26420 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
26421 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
26422 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
26423 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code goes
26424 hand in hand.
26425
26426 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
26427 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
26428 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
26429 started with Gnus.
26430
26431 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
26432 reference manual as source material. It would look quite differently.
26433
26434
26435 @page
26436 @node Terminology
26437 @section Terminology
26438
26439 @cindex terminology
26440 @table @dfn
26441
26442 @item news
26443 @cindex news
26444 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
26445 News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
26446 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
26447 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
26448 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
26449
26450 @item mail
26451 @cindex mail
26452 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
26453 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
26454 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
26455 not posting, and replying is not following up.
26456
26457 @item reply
26458 @cindex reply
26459 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
26460
26461 @item follow up
26462 @cindex follow up
26463 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
26464 are reading.
26465
26466 @item back end
26467 @cindex back end
26468 Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
26469 difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
26470 commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
26471 messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
26472 architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
26473 ``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
26474 @key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
26475 Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
26476 ``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
26477 number 4711''.
26478
26479 So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
26480 end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
26481 accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
26482 layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
26483 ``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
26484 file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
26485
26486 Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
26487 done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
26488 access the articles.
26489
26490 However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
26491 would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
26492 method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
26493 confusing.
26494
26495 @item native
26496 @cindex native
26497 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
26498 default, way of getting news.
26499
26500 @item foreign
26501 @cindex foreign
26502 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same time.
26503 These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends for getting
26504 news.
26505
26506 @item secondary
26507 @cindex secondary
26508 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and being
26509 foreign, but they mostly act like they are native.
26510
26511 @item article
26512 @cindex article
26513 A message that has been posted as news.
26514
26515 @item mail message
26516 @cindex mail message
26517 A message that has been mailed.
26518
26519 @item message
26520 @cindex message
26521 A mail message or news article
26522
26523 @item head
26524 @cindex head
26525 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.) is
26526 put.
26527
26528 @item body
26529 @cindex body
26530 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
26531 body.
26532
26533 @item header
26534 @cindex header
26535 A line from the head of an article.
26536
26537 @item headers
26538 @cindex headers
26539 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
26540 collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
26541
26542 @item @acronym{NOV}
26543 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
26544 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
26545 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
26546 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
26547 normal @sc{head} format.
26548
26549 @item level
26550 @cindex levels
26551 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1-9). The ones
26552 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
26553 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1-5 are considered
26554 @dfn{subscribed}; 6-7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
26555 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
26556 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
26557
26558 @item killed groups
26559 @cindex killed groups
26560 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
26561 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
26562
26563 @item zombie groups
26564 @cindex zombie groups
26565 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
26566
26567 @item active file
26568 @cindex active file
26569 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
26570 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
26571 is rather large, as you might surmise.
26572
26573 @item bogus groups
26574 @cindex bogus groups
26575 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
26576 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
26577 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
26578
26579 @item activating
26580 @cindex activating groups
26581 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
26582 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
26583 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
26584
26585 @item spool
26586 @cindex spool
26587 News servers store their articles locally in one fashion or other.
26588 One old-fashioned storage method is to have just one file per
26589 article. That's called a ``traditional spool''.
26590
26591 @item server
26592 @cindex server
26593 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
26594
26595 @item select method
26596 @cindex select method
26597 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
26598 server settings.
26599
26600 @item virtual server
26601 @cindex virtual server
26602 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
26603 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
26604 whole is a virtual server.
26605
26606 @item washing
26607 @cindex washing
26608 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
26609 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
26610 original.
26611
26612 @item ephemeral groups
26613 @cindex ephemeral groups
26614 @cindex temporary groups
26615 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
26616 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
26617 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
26618
26619 @item solid groups
26620 @cindex solid groups
26621 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
26622 group buffer are solid groups.
26623
26624 @item sparse articles
26625 @cindex sparse articles
26626 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
26627 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
26628
26629 @item threading
26630 @cindex threading
26631 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
26632 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
26633
26634 @item root
26635 @cindex root
26636 @cindex thread root
26637 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
26638 articles in the thread.
26639
26640 @item parent
26641 @cindex parent
26642 An article that has responses.
26643
26644 @item child
26645 @cindex child
26646 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
26647
26648 @item digest
26649 @cindex digest
26650 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
26651 specified by RFC 1153.
26652
26653 @item splitting
26654 @cindex splitting, terminolgy
26655 @cindex mail sorting
26656 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
26657 The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
26658 incorrectly called mail filtering.
26659
26660 @end table
26661
26662
26663 @page
26664 @node Customization
26665 @section Customization
26666 @cindex general customization
26667
26668 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
26669 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
26670 for some quite common situations.
26671
26672 @menu
26673 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
26674 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
26675 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
26676 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
26677 @end menu
26678
26679
26680 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
26681 @subsection Slow/Expensive NNTP Connection
26682
26683 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
26684 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
26685 Gnus has to get from the @acronym{NNTP} server.
26686
26687 @table @code
26688
26689 @item gnus-read-active-file
26690 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
26691 entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
26692 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
26693 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
26694 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
26695
26696 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
26697 This one has to be @code{nil}. If not, grabbing article headers from
26698 the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast. Not all @acronym{NNTP} servers
26699 support @sc{xover}; Gnus will detect this by itself.
26700 @end table
26701
26702
26703 @node Slow Terminal Connection
26704 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
26705
26706 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
26707 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
26708 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
26709
26710 @table @code
26711
26712 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
26713 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
26714 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
26715 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
26716 horizontal and vertical recentering.
26717
26718 @item gnus-visible-headers
26719 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
26720 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
26721 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
26722 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
26723
26724 Set this hook to all the available hiding commands:
26725 @lisp
26726 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
26727 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
26728 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
26729 @end lisp
26730
26731 @item gnus-use-full-window
26732 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
26733 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
26734 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
26735 want to read them anyway.
26736
26737 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
26738 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
26739 hidden initially.
26740
26741
26742 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
26743 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
26744 lines, which might save some time.
26745 @end table
26746
26747
26748 @node Little Disk Space
26749 @subsection Little Disk Space
26750 @cindex disk space
26751
26752 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
26753 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
26754
26755 @table @code
26756
26757 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
26758 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
26759 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
26760 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
26761 default.
26762
26763 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
26764 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
26765 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
26766 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
26767 default.
26768
26769 @item gnus-save-killed-list
26770 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
26771 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
26772 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
26773 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
26774
26775 @end table
26776
26777
26778 @node Slow Machine
26779 @subsection Slow Machine
26780 @cindex slow machine
26781
26782 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
26783 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
26784
26785 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
26786 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
26787
26788 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
26789 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
26790 summary buffer faster.
26791
26792
26793 @page
26794 @node Troubleshooting
26795 @section Troubleshooting
26796 @cindex troubleshooting
26797
26798 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
26799 problems, really.
26800
26801 Ahem.
26802
26803 @enumerate
26804
26805 @item
26806 Make sure your computer is switched on.
26807
26808 @item
26809 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
26810 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
26811 Gnus will work.
26812
26813 @item
26814 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
26815 like @samp{Gnus v5.10.6} you have the right files loaded. Otherwise
26816 you have some old @file{.el} files lying around. Delete these.
26817
26818 @item
26819 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
26820 @acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
26821
26822 @item
26823 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
26824 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
26825 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
26826 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
26827 something like that.
26828 @end enumerate
26829
26830 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
26831
26832 @cindex bugs
26833 @cindex reporting bugs
26834
26835 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
26836 @findex gnus-bug
26837 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
26838 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
26839 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
26840 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
26841
26842 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
26843 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
26844 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
26845 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
26846 time.
26847
26848 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
26849 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
26850 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
26851 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
26852 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
26853 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
26854
26855 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
26856 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
26857 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
26858 the bug report.
26859
26860 @cindex patches
26861 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
26862 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
26863
26864 @cindex edebug
26865 If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
26866 in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
26867 edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
26868 (@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
26869 Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
26870 you discover some weird behaviour when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
26871 step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
26872 the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
26873 then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
26874 return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
26875 placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
26876 evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
26877 @kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
26878 @kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
26879
26880 @cindex elp
26881 @cindex profile
26882 @cindex slow
26883 Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
26884 manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
26885 can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
26886 slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
26887 helps isolating the real problem areas).
26888
26889 A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP. The profiler is
26890 (or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
26891 there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
26892 part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g. @kbd{M-x
26893 elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
26894 RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
26895 @kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
26896 time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
26897 longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
26898 output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
26899 profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
26900 elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
26901 complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
26902 work perfectly.
26903
26904 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
26905 @cindex ding mailing list
26906 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
26907 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
26908 @email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
26909 @email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
26910
26911
26912 @page
26913 @node Gnus Reference Guide
26914 @section Gnus Reference Guide
26915
26916 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
26917 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
26918 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
26919 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
26920 it.
26921
26922 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
26923 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
26924 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
26925 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
26926 and general methods of operation.
26927
26928 @menu
26929 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
26930 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
26931 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
26932 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
26933 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
26934 * Group Info:: The group info format.
26935 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
26936 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
26937 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
26938 @end menu
26939
26940
26941 @node Gnus Utility Functions
26942 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
26943 @cindex Gnus utility functions
26944 @cindex utility functions
26945 @cindex functions
26946 @cindex internal variables
26947
26948 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
26949 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
26950 Below is a list of the most common ones.
26951
26952 @table @code
26953
26954 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
26955 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
26956 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
26957
26958 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
26959 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
26960 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
26961
26962 @item gnus-group-real-name
26963 @findex gnus-group-real-name
26964 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
26965 name.
26966
26967 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
26968 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
26969 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
26970 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
26971
26972 @item gnus-get-info
26973 @findex gnus-get-info
26974 Returns the group info list for @var{group}.
26975
26976 @item gnus-group-unread
26977 @findex gnus-group-unread
26978 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
26979 unknown.
26980
26981 @item gnus-active
26982 @findex gnus-active
26983 The active entry for @var{group}.
26984
26985 @item gnus-set-active
26986 @findex gnus-set-active
26987 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
26988
26989 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
26990 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
26991 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
26992 exit.
26993
26994 @item gnus-continuum-version
26995 @findex gnus-continuum-version
26996 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
26997 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
26998 versions.
26999
27000 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
27001 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
27002 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
27003
27004 @item gnus-news-group-p
27005 @findex gnus-news-group-p
27006 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
27007
27008 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
27009 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
27010 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
27011
27012 @item gnus-server-to-method
27013 @findex gnus-server-to-method
27014 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
27015
27016 @item gnus-server-equal
27017 @findex gnus-server-equal
27018 Says whether two virtual servers are equal.
27019
27020 @item gnus-group-native-p
27021 @findex gnus-group-native-p
27022 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
27023
27024 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
27025 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
27026 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
27027
27028 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
27029 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
27030 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
27031
27032 @item gnus-group-find-parameter
27033 @findex gnus-group-find-parameter
27034 Returns the parameter list of @var{group}. If given a second parameter,
27035 returns the value of that parameter for @var{group}.
27036
27037 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
27038 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
27039 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
27040
27041 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
27042 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
27043 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
27044
27045 @item gnus-check-backend-function
27046 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
27047 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
27048 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
27049
27050 @lisp
27051 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
27052 @result{} t
27053 @end lisp
27054
27055 @item gnus-read-method
27056 @findex gnus-read-method
27057 Prompts the user for a select method.
27058
27059 @end table
27060
27061
27062 @node Back End Interface
27063 @subsection Back End Interface
27064
27065 Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
27066 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
27067 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
27068 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
27069 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
27070 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
27071
27072 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
27073 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
27074 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
27075 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
27076 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
27077 been opened, the function should fail.
27078
27079 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
27080 name. Take this example:
27081
27082 @lisp
27083 (nntp "odd-one"
27084 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
27085 (nntp-port-number 4324))
27086 @end lisp
27087
27088 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
27089 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
27090
27091 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
27092 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
27093 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
27094
27095 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
27096 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
27097 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
27098
27099 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
27100 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
27101 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
27102 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
27103 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
27104 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
27105 return value.
27106
27107 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
27108 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
27109 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server''
27110 ---they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
27111 more.
27112
27113 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
27114 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
27115 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
27116 possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
27117 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
27118 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
27119 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
27120 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
27121 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
27122 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
27123
27124 The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
27125 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
27126 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
27127 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
27128 the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
27129 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
27130 of numbers as long as possible.
27131
27132 Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
27133 Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
27134 @file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
27135
27136 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
27137 @code{nnchoke}.
27138
27139 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
27140
27141 @menu
27142 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
27143 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
27144 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
27145 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
27146 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
27147 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
27148 @end menu
27149
27150
27151 @node Required Back End Functions
27152 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
27153
27154 @table @code
27155
27156 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
27157
27158 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
27159 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
27160 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
27161 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
27162
27163 The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
27164 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
27165 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
27166 of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
27167
27168 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
27169 headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
27170 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
27171 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
27172 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
27173 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
27174 number, do maximum fetches.
27175
27176 Here's an example HEAD:
27177
27178 @example
27179 221 1056 Article retrieved.
27180 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
27181 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
27182 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
27183 Subject: Re: Something very droll
27184 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
27185 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
27186 Lines: 26
27187 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
27188 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
27189 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
27190 .
27191 @end example
27192
27193 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
27194 these in the data buffer.
27195
27196 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
27197
27198 @example
27199 headers = *head
27200 head = error / valid-head
27201 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
27202 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
27203 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
27204 header = <text> eol
27205 @end example
27206
27207 @cindex BNF
27208 (The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
27209
27210 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
27211 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
27212 separated by tabs.
27213
27214 @example
27215 nov-buffer = *nov-line
27216 nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
27217 field = <text except TAB>
27218 @end example
27219
27220 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
27221 @pxref{Headers}.
27222
27223
27224 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
27225
27226 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
27227 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
27228
27229 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
27230 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
27231 server. In fact, it should do so.
27232
27233 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
27234 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
27235
27236
27237 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
27238
27239 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
27240 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
27241 reason.
27242
27243 There should be no data returned.
27244
27245
27246 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
27247
27248 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
27249 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
27250 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
27251 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
27252
27253 There should be no data returned.
27254
27255
27256 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
27257
27258 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
27259 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
27260 non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
27261 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
27262
27263 There should be no data returned.
27264
27265
27266 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
27267
27268 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
27269
27270 There should be no data returned.
27271
27272
27273 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
27274
27275 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
27276 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
27277 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
27278 it would be nice if that were possible.
27279
27280 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
27281 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
27282 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
27283 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
27284 into its article buffer.
27285
27286 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
27287 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
27288 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
27289 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
27290 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
27291 on successful article retrieval.
27292
27293
27294 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST)
27295
27296 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
27297 making @var{group} the current group.
27298
27299 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
27300 the current group.
27301
27302 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
27303
27304 @example
27305 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
27306 @end example
27307
27308 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
27309 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
27310 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
27311 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
27312 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
27313 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
27314 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
27315 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
27316 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
27317 highest as 0.
27318
27319 @example
27320 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
27321 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
27322 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
27323 @end example
27324
27325
27326 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
27327
27328 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
27329 a no-op on most back ends.
27330
27331 There should be no data returned.
27332
27333
27334 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
27335
27336 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
27337 @emph{all}.
27338
27339 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
27340
27341 @example
27342 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
27343 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
27344 @end example
27345
27346 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
27347 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
27348 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
27349 and the highest as 0.
27350
27351 @example
27352 active-file = *active-line
27353 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
27354 name = <string>
27355 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
27356 @end example
27357
27358 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
27359 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
27360 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
27361
27362
27363 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
27364
27365 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
27366 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
27367 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
27368 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
27369 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
27370 clear if the posting could not be completed.
27371
27372 There should be no result data from this function.
27373
27374 @end table
27375
27376
27377 @node Optional Back End Functions
27378 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
27379
27380 @table @code
27381
27382 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
27383
27384 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
27385 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
27386 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
27387
27388 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
27389 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
27390 former is in the same format as the data from
27391 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
27392 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
27393
27394 @example
27395 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
27396 @end example
27397
27398
27399 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
27400
27401 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
27402 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
27403 the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
27404 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
27405 should return a non-@code{nil} value.
27406
27407 There should be no result data from this function.
27408
27409
27410 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
27411
27412 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
27413 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
27414 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
27415 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
27416 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
27417 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
27418 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
27419 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
27420
27421 There should be no result data from this function.
27422
27423
27424 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
27425
27426 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
27427 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc) internally, and store them in
27428 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
27429 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
27430 propagate the mark information to the server.
27431
27432 @var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
27433
27434 @example
27435 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
27436 @end example
27437
27438 @var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
27439 @var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
27440 marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
27441 marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
27442 @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
27443 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend},
27444 @code{forward} and @code{recent}, but your back end should, if
27445 possible, not limit itself to these.
27446
27447 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
27448 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
27449 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
27450 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
27451
27452 An example action list:
27453
27454 @example
27455 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
27456 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
27457 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
27458 @end example
27459
27460 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
27461 mark on (currently not used for anything).
27462
27463 There should be no result data from this function.
27464
27465 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
27466
27467 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
27468 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
27469 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
27470 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
27471 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
27472
27473 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
27474 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
27475 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
27476 expirable.
27477
27478 There should be no result data from this function.
27479
27480
27481 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
27482
27483 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
27484 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
27485 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
27486 the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
27487 @var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
27488 it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
27489 total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
27490 local if that's practical.
27491
27492 There should be no result data from this function.
27493
27494
27495 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
27496
27497 The result data from this function should be a description of
27498 @var{group}.
27499
27500 @example
27501 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
27502 name = <string>
27503 description = <text>
27504 @end example
27505
27506 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
27507
27508 The result data from this function should be the description of all
27509 groups available on the server.
27510
27511 @example
27512 description-buffer = *description-line
27513 @end example
27514
27515
27516 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
27517
27518 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
27519 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
27520 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
27521 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
27522 in the active buffer format.
27523
27524 It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
27525 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
27526 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
27527 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
27528 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
27529 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
27530 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
27531
27532
27533 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
27534
27535 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
27536
27537 There should be no return data.
27538
27539
27540 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
27541
27542 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
27543 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
27544 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
27545 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
27546 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
27547 they are.
27548
27549 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
27550 able to delete.
27551
27552 There should be no result data returned.
27553
27554
27555 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
27556
27557 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
27558 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
27559
27560 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
27561 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
27562 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
27563 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
27564 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
27565 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
27566
27567 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
27568 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
27569 optimizations.
27570
27571 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
27572 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
27573
27574 There should be no data returned.
27575
27576
27577 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
27578
27579 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
27580 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
27581 this function in short order.
27582
27583 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
27584 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
27585
27586 The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
27587 article for that group.
27588
27589 There should be no data returned.
27590
27591
27592 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
27593
27594 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
27595 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
27596
27597 There should be no data returned.
27598
27599
27600 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
27601
27602 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
27603 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
27604 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
27605
27606 There should be no data returned.
27607
27608
27609 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
27610
27611 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
27612 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
27613
27614 There should be no data returned.
27615
27616 @end table
27617
27618
27619 @node Error Messaging
27620 @subsubsection Error Messaging
27621
27622 @findex nnheader-report
27623 @findex nnheader-get-report
27624 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
27625 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
27626 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
27627 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
27628 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
27629 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
27630
27631 @lisp
27632 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
27633
27634 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
27635 @end lisp
27636
27637 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
27638 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
27639 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
27640 takes one argument---the server symbol.
27641
27642 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
27643 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
27644 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
27645
27646
27647 @node Writing New Back Ends
27648 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
27649
27650 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
27651 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
27652 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
27653 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
27654 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
27655 editing articles.
27656
27657 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
27658 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
27659 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
27660
27661 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
27662 package called @code{nnoo}.
27663
27664 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
27665 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
27666 following macros:
27667
27668 @table @code
27669
27670 @item nnoo-declare
27671 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
27672 parameters. For instance:
27673
27674 @lisp
27675 (nnoo-declare nndir
27676 nnml nnmh)
27677 @end lisp
27678
27679 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
27680 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
27681
27682 @item defvoo
27683 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
27684 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
27685 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
27686
27687 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
27688 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
27689 a function in those back ends.
27690
27691 @lisp
27692 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
27693 "Where nndir will look for groups."
27694 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
27695 @end lisp
27696
27697 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
27698 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
27699 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
27700
27701 @item nnoo-define-basics
27702 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
27703 have.
27704
27705 @lisp
27706 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
27707 @end lisp
27708
27709 @item deffoo
27710 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
27711 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
27712 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
27713
27714 @item nnoo-map-functions
27715 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
27716 functions from the parent back ends.
27717
27718 @lisp
27719 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
27720 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
27721 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
27722 @end lisp
27723
27724 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
27725 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
27726 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
27727 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
27728
27729 @item nnoo-import
27730 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
27731 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
27732 haven't already been defined.
27733
27734 @lisp
27735 (nnoo-import nndir
27736 (nnmh
27737 nnmh-request-list
27738 nnmh-request-newgroups)
27739 (nnml))
27740 @end lisp
27741
27742 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
27743 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
27744 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
27745 defined now.
27746
27747 @end table
27748
27749 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
27750
27751 @lisp
27752 ;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
27753 ;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,96 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
27754
27755 ;;; @r{Code:}
27756
27757 (require 'nnheader)
27758 (require 'nnmh)
27759 (require 'nnml)
27760 (require 'nnoo)
27761 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
27762
27763 (nnoo-declare nndir
27764 nnml nnmh)
27765
27766 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
27767 "Where nndir will look for groups."
27768 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
27769
27770 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
27771 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
27772 nnml-nov-is-evil)
27773
27774 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
27775 nil
27776 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
27777 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
27778 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
27779
27780 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
27781 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
27782
27783 ;;; @r{Interface functions.}
27784
27785 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
27786
27787 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
27788 (setq nndir-directory
27789 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
27790 server))
27791 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
27792 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
27793 (push `(nndir-current-group
27794 ,(file-name-nondirectory
27795 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
27796 defs)
27797 (push `(nndir-top-directory
27798 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
27799 defs)
27800 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
27801
27802 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
27803 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
27804 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
27805 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
27806 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
27807
27808 (nnoo-import nndir
27809 (nnmh
27810 nnmh-status-message
27811 nnmh-request-list
27812 nnmh-request-newgroups))
27813
27814 (provide 'nndir)
27815 @end lisp
27816
27817
27818 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
27819 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
27820
27821 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
27822 @findex gnus-declare-backend
27823 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
27824 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
27825 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
27826
27827 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
27828 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
27829
27830 Here's an example:
27831
27832 @lisp
27833 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
27834 @end lisp
27835
27836 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
27837
27838 The abilities can be:
27839
27840 @table @code
27841 @item mail
27842 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
27843 @item post
27844 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
27845 @item post-mail
27846 This back end supports both mail and news.
27847 @item none
27848 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
27849 different.
27850 @item respool
27851 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
27852 articles and groups.
27853 @item address
27854 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
27855 true for almost all back ends.
27856 @item prompt-address
27857 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
27858 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
27859 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
27860 @end table
27861
27862
27863 @node Mail-like Back Ends
27864 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
27865
27866 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
27867 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
27868 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
27869 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
27870
27871 @lisp
27872 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
27873 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
27874 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
27875 @end lisp
27876
27877 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
27878 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
27879 mail.
27880
27881 This function takes four parameters.
27882
27883 @table @var
27884 @item method
27885 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
27886 the call.
27887
27888 @item exit-function
27889 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
27890
27891 @item temp-directory
27892 Where the temporary files should be stored.
27893
27894 @item group
27895 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
27896 performed for one group only.
27897 @end table
27898
27899 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
27900 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
27901 find the article number assigned to this article.
27902
27903 The function also uses the following variables:
27904 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
27905 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
27906 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
27907 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
27908 this:
27909
27910 @example
27911 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
27912 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
27913 @end example
27914
27915
27916 @node Score File Syntax
27917 @subsection Score File Syntax
27918
27919 Score files are meant to be easily parseable, but yet extremely
27920 mallable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
27921 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
27922
27923 Here's a typical score file:
27924
27925 @lisp
27926 (("summary"
27927 ("win95" -10000 nil s)
27928 ("Gnus"))
27929 ("from"
27930 ("Lars" -1000))
27931 (mark -100))
27932 @end lisp
27933
27934 BNF definition of a score file:
27935
27936 @example
27937 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
27938 element = rule / atom
27939 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
27940 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
27941 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
27942 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
27943 quote = <ascii 34>
27944 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
27945 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
27946 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
27947 date-header = "date"
27948 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
27949 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
27950 score = "nil" / <integer>
27951 date = "nil" / <natural number>
27952 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
27953 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
27954 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
27955 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
27956 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
27957 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
27958 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
27959 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
27960 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
27961 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
27962 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
27963 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
27964 exclude-files / read-only / touched
27965 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
27966 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
27967 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
27968 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
27969 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
27970 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
27971 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
27972 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
27973 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
27974 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
27975 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
27976 eval = "eval" space <form>
27977 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
27978 @end example
27979
27980 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
27981 discarded.
27982
27983 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
27984 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
27985 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
27986 one looong line, then that's ok.
27987
27988 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
27989 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27990
27991
27992 @node Headers
27993 @subsection Headers
27994
27995 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
27996 corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
27997 almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
27998 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
27999
28000 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
28001 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
28002 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
28003 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
28004 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
28005 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
28006 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
28007
28008 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
28009 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
28010 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
28011 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
28012 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
28013
28014 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
28015 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
28016
28017
28018 @node Ranges
28019 @subsection Ranges
28020
28021 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
28022 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
28023
28024 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
28025 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
28026 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
28027 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
28028
28029 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
28030 sequence.
28031
28032 @example
28033 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
28034 @end example
28035
28036 is transformed into
28037
28038 @example
28039 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
28040 @end example
28041
28042 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
28043 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
28044
28045 @example
28046 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
28047 @end example
28048
28049 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
28050 is slightly tricky:
28051
28052 @example
28053 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
28054 @end example
28055
28056 and
28057
28058 @example
28059 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
28060 @end example
28061
28062 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
28063
28064 @example
28065 (1 2 3 4 5)
28066 @end example
28067
28068 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
28069 also valid:
28070
28071 @example
28072 (1 . 5)
28073 @end example
28074
28075 and is equal to the previous range.
28076
28077 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
28078 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
28079 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
28080 range handling.)
28081
28082 @example
28083 range = simple-range / normal-range
28084 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
28085 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
28086 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
28087 number *[ " " contents ]
28088 @end example
28089
28090 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
28091 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
28092 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
28093 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
28094 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
28095 sequences.)
28096
28097
28098 @node Group Info
28099 @subsection Group Info
28100
28101 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
28102 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
28103 describes the group.
28104
28105 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
28106 second is a more complex one:
28107
28108 @example
28109 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
28110
28111 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
28112 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
28113 (nnml "")
28114 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
28115 @end example
28116
28117 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
28118 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
28119 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
28120 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
28121 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
28122 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
28123 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
28124 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
28125 this section is about.
28126
28127 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
28128 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
28129 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
28130
28131 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
28132
28133 @example
28134 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
28135 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
28136 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28137 group = quote <string> quote
28138 ralevel = rank / level
28139 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
28140 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
28141 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
28142 read = range
28143 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
28144 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
28145 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
28146 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
28147 @end example
28148
28149 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
28150 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
28151 in pseudo-BNF.
28152
28153 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
28154 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
28155
28156 @table @code
28157 @item gnus-info-group
28158 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
28159 @findex gnus-info-group
28160 @findex gnus-info-set-group
28161 Get/set the group name.
28162
28163 @item gnus-info-rank
28164 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
28165 @findex gnus-info-rank
28166 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
28167 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
28168
28169 @item gnus-info-level
28170 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
28171 @findex gnus-info-level
28172 @findex gnus-info-set-level
28173 Get/set the group level.
28174
28175 @item gnus-info-score
28176 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
28177 @findex gnus-info-score
28178 @findex gnus-info-set-score
28179 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
28180
28181 @item gnus-info-read
28182 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
28183 @findex gnus-info-read
28184 @findex gnus-info-set-read
28185 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
28186
28187 @item gnus-info-marks
28188 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
28189 @findex gnus-info-marks
28190 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
28191 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
28192
28193 @item gnus-info-method
28194 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
28195 @findex gnus-info-method
28196 @findex gnus-info-set-method
28197 Get/set the group select method.
28198
28199 @item gnus-info-params
28200 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
28201 @findex gnus-info-params
28202 @findex gnus-info-set-params
28203 Get/set the group parameters.
28204 @end table
28205
28206 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
28207 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
28208
28209 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
28210 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
28211 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
28212 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
28213
28214
28215 @node Extended Interactive
28216 @subsection Extended Interactive
28217 @cindex interactive
28218 @findex gnus-interactive
28219
28220 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
28221 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
28222 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
28223
28224 @lisp
28225 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
28226 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
28227 ...
28228 )
28229 @end lisp
28230
28231 The best thing to do would have been to implement
28232 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
28233 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
28234 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
28235 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
28236 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
28237 @code{interactive}.
28238
28239 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
28240 adds a few more.
28241
28242 @table @samp
28243 @item y
28244 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
28245 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
28246 variable.
28247
28248 @item Y
28249 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
28250 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
28251 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
28252
28253 @item A
28254 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
28255 function.
28256
28257 @item H
28258 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
28259 function.
28260
28261 @item g
28262 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
28263 function.
28264
28265 @end table
28266
28267
28268 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
28269 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
28270 @cindex XEmacs
28271 @cindex Emacsen
28272
28273 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
28274 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
28275 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
28276
28277 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
28278 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
28279 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
28280 Gnus, that's very useful.
28281
28282 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
28283 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
28284 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
28285 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
28286 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
28287 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
28288 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
28289 following function:
28290
28291 @lisp
28292 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
28293 (start-itimer
28294 "gnus-run-at-time"
28295 `(lambda ()
28296 (,function ,@@args))
28297 time repeat))
28298 @end lisp
28299
28300 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
28301 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
28302 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
28303 all over.
28304
28305 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
28306 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
28307 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
28308
28309 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
28310 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
28311 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
28312
28313
28314 @node Various File Formats
28315 @subsection Various File Formats
28316
28317 @menu
28318 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
28319 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
28320 @end menu
28321
28322
28323 @node Active File Format
28324 @subsubsection Active File Format
28325
28326 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
28327 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
28328 in each group.
28329
28330 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
28331
28332 @example
28333 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
28334 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
28335 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
28336 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
28337 no.general 1000 900 y
28338 @end example
28339
28340 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
28341
28342 @example
28343 active = *group-line
28344 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
28345 group = <non-white-space string>
28346 spc = " "
28347 high-number = <non-negative integer>
28348 low-number = <positive integer>
28349 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
28350 @end example
28351
28352 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
28353 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
28354
28355
28356 @node Newsgroups File Format
28357 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
28358
28359 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
28360 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
28361 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
28362 the user.
28363
28364 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
28365 Here's the definition:
28366
28367 @example
28368 newsgroups = *line
28369 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
28370 group = <non-white-space string>
28371 tab = <TAB>
28372 description = <string>
28373 @end example
28374
28375
28376 @page
28377 @node Emacs for Heathens
28378 @section Emacs for Heathens
28379
28380 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
28381 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
28382 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
28383 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
28384 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
28385 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
28386 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
28387 cat instead.
28388
28389 @menu
28390 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
28391 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
28392 @end menu
28393
28394
28395 @node Keystrokes
28396 @subsection Keystrokes
28397
28398 @itemize @bullet
28399 @item
28400 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
28401
28402 @item
28403 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
28404 @end itemize
28405
28406 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
28407 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
28408 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
28409 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
28410 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
28411 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
28412
28413 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
28414 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
28415 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
28416 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
28417 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
28418 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
28419 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
28420
28421 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
28422 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
28423 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
28424 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
28425 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
28426 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
28427 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
28428
28429 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
28430 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
28431 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
28432 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
28433 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
28434 it.
28435
28436
28437
28438 @node Emacs Lisp
28439 @subsection Emacs Lisp
28440
28441 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
28442 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
28443 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
28444 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
28445
28446 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
28447 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
28448 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
28449 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
28450 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
28451 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
28452 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{.emacs} file
28453 to customize Gnus.
28454
28455 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
28456 write the following:
28457
28458 @lisp
28459 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
28460 @end lisp
28461
28462 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
28463 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
28464 you can go and fill your @file{.emacs} file with lots of these to change
28465 how Gnus works.
28466
28467 If you have put that thing in your @file{.emacs} file, it will be read
28468 and @code{eval}ed (which is lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
28469 start Emacs. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
28470 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
28471 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
28472
28473 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
28474 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
28475 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
28476
28477 Some pitfalls:
28478
28479 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
28480 that means:
28481
28482 @lisp
28483 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
28484 @end lisp
28485
28486 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server} to
28487 @samp{nntp.ifi.uio.no}'', that means:
28488
28489 @lisp
28490 (setq gnus-nntp-server "nntp.ifi.uio.no")
28491 @end lisp
28492
28493 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
28494 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
28495
28496 @page
28497 @include gnus-faq.texi
28498
28499 @node Index
28500 @chapter Index
28501 @printindex cp
28502
28503 @node Key Index
28504 @chapter Key Index
28505 @printindex ky
28506
28507 @summarycontents
28508 @contents
28509 @bye
28510
28511 @iftex
28512 @iflatex
28513 \end{document}
28514 @end iflatex
28515 @end iftex
28516
28517 @c Local Variables:
28518 @c mode: texinfo
28519 @c coding: iso-8859-1
28520 @c End:
28521
28522 @ignore
28523 arch-tag: c9fa47e7-78ca-4681-bda9-9fef45d1c819
28524 @end ignore